You are on page 1of 369

KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE

& RESEARCH

NURSING EDUCATION FILE

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

NURSING EDUCATION
1
INDEX

Sl.No. Content Page No.


1. Curriculum Construction:
Framing of Philosophy, Aims, Objectivesi9k3[*

Syllabus/Course Plan

Master Rotation Plan

Unit Plan

Lesson Plan

Clinical Rotation Plan

2. Micro Teaching:

3. Teaching Method in Class Room:

Lecture

Demonstration

Laboratory

Simulation

Seminars

Symposium

Panel Discussion

Problem Based Learning

Role Play

Computer Assisted Learning

2
4. Clinical Teaching Method:

Nursing Clinic

Nursing Rounds

Case Analysis

Process Recording

Group Health Teaching

5. Preparation of AV Aids:
Slides

OHP

Transparencies

Flash Card

Power Point

ASSIGNMENT ON COMPUTER APPLICATIONS IN


NURSING

6. Annotated Bibliography:

1 Annotated Bibliography (Research)

2 Annotated Bibliography (Journals)

3 Annotated Bibliography (Articles)

7. Evaluation Tools:

1. Preparation of question paper


a. Blue Print table of specification construct administer &
evaluate question paper:

3
Objective type question paper

Essay type question paper

2. Construct, Administer & evaluate clinical evaluation


a. Rating scale

b. Check list

c. Attitude test

d. OSCE

e. Differential scale

f. Summated scales

g. Anecdotal records

3. Observe & Practice

a. Non Standardised test

b. Intelligence test

c. Aptitude test

d. Personality test

e. Physical and mental disability

f. Sociometry

8. Item Analysis

9. Conduct continuing education workshop

10. Critical evaluation of an institutional nursing education


programme

4
5
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

Curriculum
Construction
SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON

6
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

AIMS AND OBJECTIVES


M.SC. NURSING

SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON-

7
Philosophy
National Health Policy(NHP) 2002 emphasizes the need to prepare nurses to function in
super-speciality areas who are required in tertiary care institutions, entrusting some limited
public health functions to nurses after providing adequate training, and increase the ratio of
degree holding vis a vis diploma holding nurses. It is observed that there is an acute
shortage of nursing faculty in under graduate and post graduate nursing programme in India
Indian Nursing Council believes that: Post Graduate programme is essential to prepare
nurses to improve the quality of nursing education and practice in India. . Post graduate
programme in nursing builds upon and extends competence acquired at the graduate levels,
emphasizes application of relevant theories into nursing practice, education, administration
and development of research skills. The programme prepares nurses for leadership position
in nursing and health fields who can function as nurse specialists, consultants, educators,
administrators and researchers in a wide variety of professional settings in meeting the
National priorities and the changing needs of the society. This programme provides the
basis for the post masteral programme in nursing. Further the programme encourages
accountability and commitment to life long learning which fosters improvement of quality

Aim

The aim of the postgraduate program in nursing is to prepare graduates to assume


responsibilities as nurse specialists, consultants, educators, administrators in a wide variety
of professional settings

Objectives

On Completion of the two year M.Sc Nursing programme, the graduate will be able to:-

1. Utilize/apply the concepts, theories and principles of nursing science


2. Demonstrate advance competence in practice of nursing
3. Practice as a nurse specialist.
4. Demonstrate leadership qualities and function effectively as nurse
educator and manager.
5. Demonstrate skill in conducting nursing research, interpreting and
utilizing the findings from health related research.

6. Demonstrate the ability to plan and effect change in nursing practice and
in the health care delivery system.
7. Establish collaborative relationship with members of other disciplines
8. Demonstrate interest in continued learning for personal and professional
advancement.

8
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

COURSE PLAN OF
MSC NURSING 1ST YEAR

SUBJECT :NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

9
COURSE PLANNING
INTRODUCTION
Curriculum planning in nursing is a complex process involving many
groups of people like faculty, community leaders, subject experts, consumers.
Students employees of the prospective graduates educationalist and
psychologist.
Many factors affects curriculum development such as needs and interest
of learners social and cultural factors.
The curriculum is the overall plan for providing learning experiences for
students for achieving certain goals. The curriculum based on needs and interest
of student concerned, physiology of the college and faculty and is a systematic
way to achieve certain specific goals.
OBJECTIVES:
After completion of the practical the student should be able to
• Spell out the sequence in planning a curriculum .
• Enumerate the conc8erns of the course plan for a subject.
• Prepare a course plan for a subject.
• To teach basic nursing students .
SEQUENCES OF PLANNING
In order to understa8nd when does a course fit in with in the curriculum.
We should explain the sequence in planning curriculum. A curriculum is
planned in various stages including;8888
1) Planning a curriculum as a whole.
2) Planning a various course.
3) Units.
4) Lessons for each courses.
SEQUENCE IN PLANNING A CURRICULUM
1) Planning
10
• Curriculum - over all goals .
• Objectives.
• Learning experiences .
• Evaluation .
2) Planning various courses .
• Goals
• Objectives
• Learning experiences .
• Evaluation
3) Unit planning
• Objectives
• Learning experience
• Evaluation
DEFINITION OF COURSE
It is a serious of studies leading to graduation of degree as in the case of
basic B.Sc Nursing course regarding completion of several short courses.
LEVELS OF COURSE PLANNING
• University level .
• Institutional level.
• Instructional level.
PURPOSE
The teacher plan the unit of work and the lesson for each course, linking
it previous learning of the students without planning there will be little unity
and cohesion in what is being learned.
Students participation in planning the course is to be encouraged by the
teacher and entire teaching and learning is based on sound education and
psychological principles.
STRUCTURED OF THE COURSE PLAN
• In planning course 2 distinct areas of planning are involved.

11
• Identifying the course of elements around which specific learning are to be
organized.
• Selection of specific organizing centers on which the learner interest and needs
are focused.

OUTLINE FOR A COURSE PLAN


A course plan should contain
• Objectives
• Specification for the level of learner
• Placement in the curriculum.
• Resources of material needed for the course
• Unit plan
• Evaluation measure
• Bibliography

1. OBJECTIVES
These may be general for the entire course. There may be central
objective of all units in the course which leads to the attainment of general
objective for the course.

2. SPECIFICATION FOR THE LEVEL OF LEARNER


The started objectives should be according to the level of the learners.
This will include the information regarding the level of the students. (1 st year,
2nd year, so on). The requisites for the course and experience the students should
have had prior to the starting of the course .It should also specify at what stage
student should begin course learning eg; first year , 2nd year .

3. RESOURCE MATERIALS NEEDED FO THE COURSE

12
The teacher who prepares the lesson plan, the course outline will be guide
by the content in selecting resource material, books journals, A.V aids which
can used in teaching the course, must be suggested in resource.

4. UNIT PLAN
The course plan can be divided in to appropriate unit. Each unit specify
its objectives and teaching learning activities.

5. EVALUATION MEASURES
Course plan should include the evaluation method should be used such as
written test, practical examination, class examination and quizzes .

BIBLIOGRAPHY
Course plan must provide a list of books for objectives by teachers and
students. The students can do reading on their from the list of books provided
for reference.

13
MEDICAL SURGICAL NURSING
COURSE PLAN
M.Sc NURSING – I YEAR

Time allotted : Required hrs. Planned


Hrs.
Theory : 150 160
Practical : 650 650
Total hrs. : 800 810

COURSE DESCRIPTION:
This course is common for the students undergoing clinical speciality – II in neuro science
nursing/cardiovascular & thoracic nursing / critical care nursing / oncology nursing /
orthopaedic and rehabilitation nursing / nephro & urology nursing, gastroenterology nursing/
geriatric nursing. It is designed to assist students in developing expertise and in depth
knowledge in the field of medical surgical nursing. It will help students to appreciate the
patient as a holistic individual and develop skill to function as a specialized Medical surgical
nurse. It will further enable the student to function as educator, manager and researcher in the
field of Medical surgical nursing.

OBJECTIVES:
At the end of the course the students will be able to:
1. Appreciate the trends & issues in the field of Medical – Surgical Nursing as a
speciality.
2. Apply concepts & theories related to health promotion.
3. Appreciate the client as a holistic individual.
4. Perform physical, psychosocial assessment of Medical – Surgical patients.
5. Apply Nursing process in 8providing care to patients.
6. Integrate the concept of family centered nursing care with associated disorder such as
genetic, congenital and long – term illness.
7. Recognize and manage emergencies with Medical Surgical patients.
8. Describe various recent technologies & treatment modilities in the management of
critically ill patients.
9. Appreciate the legal & ethical issues relevant to Medical Surgical Nursing.
10. Prepare a design for layout and management of Medical Surgical units.
11. Appreciate the role of alternative systems of Medicine in care of patients.
12. Incorporate evidence based Nursing practice and identify the areas of research in the
field of Meical Surgical Nursing
13. Recognize the role of Nurse Pracitioner as a member of the Medial Surgical health
team.
14. Teach Medical Surgical nursing to undergraduate nursing students & in-service
nurses.

14
Unit Content Hours Method of teaching Faculty Clinical posting
responsible

I Introduction 5hrs. Discussion, self study, review Nil


classes

II Health assessment of patients 20hrs. Demonstration, discussion, Medical ward


clinical teaching

III Care in hosptial setting 5hrs. Discussion, self study, review Nil
classes

IV Management of patients which disorders 12hrs. Seminar, discussion lecture, Surgical ward
of GI tract review classes

V Management of patients with disorders 16hrs. Seminar, discussion lecture, Neuro Medicine & neuro
of nervous system review classes surgery ward

VI Management of patients with disorders 16hrs. Seminar, discussion, self study Medicine ward
of respiratory system
VII Management of patients with disorders 21hrs. Seminar, discussion clinical Cardiac medicine, cardiac
of cardiovascular system presentation synopsis surgery CCU,CTVS,

15
ICU, Cardiac OPD
VIII Management of patients with disorders 5hrs. Seminar,self study discussion Medicine ward
of blood
IX Management of patients with disorders 10hrs. Seminar discussion clinical Oncology ward (surgical)
of genitor urinary system presentation

X Management of patients with disorders 18hrs. Seminar, discussion, lectur, Medical ward
of endocrine system self study

XI Management of patients with disorders 8hrs. Seminar discussion lecture Ortho ward
of musculo skeletal system

XII Management of patients with disorders 5hrs. Lecture, seminar, discussion Medical ward, skin, oPD,
of intergumentary system emergency ward visit to
burns ward

XIII Management of patients with disorders 5hrs. Seminar, discussion, self Eye, ENT ward
of eye and ENT study, teaching practice

XIV Management of patients with disorders 3hrs. Teaching practice, self study Gynaecology ward
of reproductive system
XV Geriatric nursing 3hrs. Seminar, discussion Visist to old age home

16
XVI Care of patients with communicable and 3hrs. Seminar, self study Snehadan posting
sexually transmitted diseases

XVII Emergency, trauma and multi – system 5hrs. Seminar, discussion Emergency ward, OPD
organ failure

17
NURSING RESEARCH – RESEARCH METHODOLOGIES
COURSE PLAN

Placement: 1st year


Hours of Instruction

Total : 250hrs.
Theory : 150hrs
Practical : 100 hrs.

COURSE DESCRIPTION:
The course is designed to assist the students to acquire an understanding of the
research methodology and statistical methods as a basis for identifying research
problem, planning & implementing a research plan. It will further enable the
students evaluate research studies and utilize research findings to improve
quality of nursing practice, education and management.

GENERALOBJECTIVES:
At the end of the course the student acquires in depth understandingof research
methodology appreciate its importanceand develop skill in conducting research.

18
Unit Content Hours T P Method of teaching Faculty
responsible
I Introduction 10hrs. Discussion, self study,
review classes
II Review of literature 5hrs. 5hrs Discussion,
presentations,review
classes, synopsis
preparation
III Research approaches and designs 12hrs. Discussion,review classes,
synopsis
IV Research problem 10hrs. 5hrs discussion lecture, review
classes, problem
presentation
V Developing theoretical/ 20hrs. Seminar, discussion
conceptual framework lecture, review classes
VI Sampling 6hrs. Seminar, discussion, self
study
VII Tools and methods of data 20hrs. 10hrs Seminar,
collection discussion ,synopsis
VIII Implementing research plan 5hrs. Seminar, self
study ,discussion

19
IX Analysis and interpretation of data 10hrs 10hrs. Seminar ,discussion,
analysis presentation

X Reporting and utilizing research 10hrs. Seminar, discussion,


findings lecture, self study

XI Critical analysis of research 3hrs 8hrs Seminar,discussion ,lecture


reports and articles

XII Developing and presenting 4hrs 7hrs Lecture, seminar,


research proposal discussion

20
BIOSTATISTICSCOURSE PLAN

Placement:1st year
Hours of Instruction

Theory50 Hours
Practical50 Hours
Total100 Hours

COURSE DESCRIPTION:
At the end of the course, the students will be able to develop an understanding
of the statistical methods and apply them in conducting research studies in
nursing.
GENERAL OBJECTIVES:
At the end of the course the students will be able to: 1. Discuss the basic
concepts and scope of statistics related to health and Nursing. 2. Organize
tabulate and present data meaningfully. 3. Use descriptive statistics to analyze
the data. 4. Describe the probable methods to predict and interpret results. 5.
Use various inferential statistical methods to predict and interpret results 6.
Draw conclusions of the study and predict statistical significance of the results.
7. Establish reliability and scoring methods of the tool developed. 8. Describe
vital health statistics and their use in health related research. 9. Explain the basic
concepts related to statistics. 10. Use statistical packages by use of computers
for data analysis.

21
Unit Content Hours TP Method of teaching Faculty responsible

I Introduction 7hrs. 4hrs Lecture cum discussion Vijay Kumar Sir

II Measures of central tendency 4hrs. 4hrs Lecture cum discussion Vijay Kumar Sir

III Measures of variability 4hrs. 5hrs Lecture cum discussion Vijay Kumar Sir

IV Normal Distribution 3hrs. 2hrs Lecture cum discussion Vijay Kumar Sir

V Measures of relationship 6hrs. 8hrs Lecture cum discussion Vijay Kumar Sir

VI Designs and meaning 5hrs. 2hrs Lecture cum discussion Vijay Kumar Sir

VII Significance of statistic and significance of difference between 8hrs. 10hrs Lecture cum discussion Vijay Kumar Sir
two statistics (Testing of hypothesis).
VIII Use of statistical methods in psychology and education 5hrs. 5hrs Lecture cum discussion Vijay Kumar Sir

IX Application of statistics in health 4hrs 2hrs. Lecture cum discussion Vijay Kumar Sir

X Use of computers for data analysis 4hrs. 8hrs Lecture cum discussion Vijay Kumar Sir

22
NURSING EDUCATION

Time Allotted:
Theory: 150 hours
Practical: 150 hours
Total: 300hrs

Course Description:
This course is designed to assist students to develop a broad understanding of
fundamental principles, concepts, trends and issues related to education and
nursing education. Further, it would provide opportunity to students to
understand appreciate and acquire skills in teaching and evaluation, curriculum
development, implementation, maintenance of standards and accreditation of
various nursing educational programs.
General objectives:
On completion of each unit students will be able to understand the fundamental
concept related to nursing education and its application.

23
Unit Content Hours T P Method of teaching Faculty
responsible
I Introduction 10hrs. Discussion, self study, review
classes
II Teaching – learning process 30hrs. 40hrs Discussion, class
presentations,seminars, review
classes, teaching practice
III Measurement and evaluation 10hrs. Discussion,lecture, review
classes,
IV Standardized and non – standardized tests 12hrs. 10hrs Discussion, lecture, review
classes, presentations.
V Administration, scoring and reporting 8hrs. 5hrs Seminar, discussion lecture,
review classes, item analysis
and presentation
VI Standardized tools 12hrs. 6hrs Seminar, discussion, self study

VII Nursing educational programs 5hrs. 6hrs Seminar,Lecture cum


discussion
VIII Continuing education in nursing 12hrs. 25 Seminar, self study ,discussion

IX Curriculum development 10hrs 10hrs. Seminar ,discussion,

24
presentation
X Teacher preparation 8hrs. 4hrs Seminar, discussion, lecture,
self study
XI Guidance and counseling 10hrs 5hrs Seminar,lecture cum
Discussion,
XII Administration of nursing curriculum 15hrs 10hrs Lecture cum discussion
seminar,
XIII Management of nursing educational 10hrs Lecture cum discussion,
institutions seminar,
XIV Standards and accreditation 5hrs 5hrs Assignment and discussion

25
ADVANCE NURSING PRACTICE

Time Allotted:
Theory: 150 hours
Practical: 200 hours
Total: 350hrs

Course Description:
This course is designed to develop an understanding of concepts and constructs
of theoretical basis of advance nursing practice and critically analyze different
theories of nursing and other disciplines.

General objectives:
On completion of each unit students will be able to understand the fundamental
concept related to advance nursing practice and its application.

26
Unit Content Hours Method of teaching Faculty
responsible
I Nursing as a profession 10hrs. Lecture cum Discussion, self study, review classes

II Health care delivery 5hrs. Discussion, class presentations,seminars, review classes,

III Genetics 10hrs. Lecture cum Discussion,lecture, review classes,

IV Epidemiology 10hrs. Lecture cum Discussion, lecture, review classes, presentations.

V Bio- psycho social pathology 20hrs. Seminar, Lecture cum discussion review classes, and
assignment
VI Philosophy and theories of nursing 20hrs. Theory presentation and discussion

VII Nursing process approach 10hrs. Seminar,presentation and discussion

VIII Psychological aspects and human 30hrs. Seminar, self study ,discussion and assignment
relations

IX Nursing practice 10hrs Seminar ,discussion, presentation

X Computer applications for patient care 25hrs. Seminar, discussion, lecture, self study
delivery system and nursing practice

27
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

MASTER ROTATION
PLAN

SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON

28
Master Rotation Plan
'Overall plan of rotation of all students in a particular educational programme,
showing the placement of the students belo
nging to total program (4 years in B.Sc. (N) and 3 and half years in GNM
courses) includes both theory and practice denoting the study block, clinical
blocks, team nursing, examinations, vacation, co-curricular activities etc.
It is prepared well in advance for the whole year so that it gives a
complete and clear picture about students placement either in theory or clinical
field during an academic session. For each year, it can be prepared separately
and for total program one can be prepared so that every faculty will be aware of
students' postings. Teachers should follow the respective University or Board
syllabus as a guideline for preparing either master rotation plan or clinical
rotation plan.
Purposes
• Availability of an advance plan before implementation of curricular
activities during an academic year for the entire program
• All concerned are aware of the placement of students in clinical fields
• Coordination becomes more effective when theory, practice correlates
and integrity exists
• Helps the students and teachers to prepare themselves for working in the
areas
• Any modifications are required based on situations concerned,
collaboration between the faculty and service staff can be made for
smooth running of organizational activities and meeting the objectives of
educational programe
• Assessment of curricular program is more effective

29
• The faculty members and nursing service staff are in a position to make
tentative advance plans for their leave or vacation without jeopardizing
the teaching-learning activities.
Principles to be Followed While Preparing Master Rotation Plan
Plan in accordance with the concerned curriculum plan/syllabus for the
entire course/program Plan in advance for all students in all years of program.
Plan the activities by following maxims of teaching
Post the students based on university syllabus and availability of
concerned required specialities Select areas that can provide expected learning
experience Plan to build on previous experiences
Acquaint the clinical staff/clinical supervisor with clinical objectives and
rotation plan Provide each clinical experience of same duration to all the
students Rotate each student through each learning experience or block Plan for
all students to enter and leave at the same time schedule.
Staff Involvement in Curriculum Planning
Curriculum committee consisting of members who actively participate in
the development or construction of a curriculum for their school. The members
may be drawn from various disciplines i.e., Teaching Faculty in Nursing
Educational Institution. Curriculum committee main responsibility is to
organize all learning experiences planned by individual tutors into an integrated
whole. A learning experience is something in which the student actively
participates and brings change in his/her behavior. The individual teachers
analyze their own subjects in order to help and contribute to the correlation of
teaching with other subjects. The school administrator has to explain/orient all
the staff about the philosophy, objectives of the organization; responsibilities of
each staff. When there is an appreciation and common understanding among the
staff members of the school, there is bound to be a greater appreciation by their
service, staff has to plan scheduling of classes and field work clinical

30
experience of the students. Teachers will maintain harmonious curriculum in
order to meet the national health.

The school should keep a close connection with the clinical fields
(hospital and community) wherever possible continuity of service should be
maintained by the schoolin these fields, which will bring in cooperation,
understanding and a sense of appreciation of the program offered. A better
organization and planning of learning experience will be the resultant effect.
Faculties are accountable for implementing the program that enables the
students to learn. Its goal is always concerned with fostering of ability of their
students in carrying out of the necessary service to the society in the future.
The important aspects of curriculum planning are: the selection and
organization of learning experience for the students who are undergoing a
program. The careful selection of the experiences and their organization is built
on the student's past knowledge and previous experience and according to the
levels of the students. Progress in complexity to higher levels of learning and
comprehension in the practice of nursing, is the aim. It should exhibit an inner
relatedness among the various subjects and also their relationship to the clinical
instruction and practice of nursing.
PLANNING AND ORGANIZATION OF CLINICAL EXPERIENCE
Introduction
Planning of clinical experience is a component of learning experience at
basic level. The syllabi formulated by University/Board will acts as a guideline
for fulfilling the minimum requirements.
To bring change in human behavior, the learning experience must be
organized as to have cumulative effect. Clinical experience is an integral part of
learning where the student will be actively participate to otain skills in clinical
practice by applying the principle of 'learning by doing'. The time, the student
spends and learns in the clinical fields is an important and integral part of the

31
total school program. The teacher's responsibility is to provide conducive
environment for the expected desired behavior.
The faculty has to plan the clinical experience, keeping the objectives in
view so that it will provide the needed learning at a particular stage in the
course so that the student will be posted in right clinical area at the right time.
The teacher has to orient the students why they are posted in the particular
clinical area; so the teacher has to complete the theoretical component early,
before posting the students in the clinical area. Teacher has to inform to the
students about the postings early, what are the requirements they have to fulfil
in postings, what type of desired learned behavior they have to develop,
everything she/he has to explain judicious decision making and greater efforts
are need to plan the clinical experience as well as plan for supervision and better
learning. The clinical experience and rotation plan should be well-organized and
interrelated to achieve the effectiveness in the overall objectives of nursing
program. One of the objectives of school of nursing is, 'understanding of the
psychosomatic and social factors that affect the client and ability and inclination
to aid the patient in adjustment to and possibly in improvement of the health
status'.
Factors to be considered while providing Clinical Facilities
• Philosophy and objectives of an organization (School Philosophy) and an
educational program
• Health care delivery system
• Nursing Philosophy—Nursing Theories and Models—Clinical Nurse
practitioner—Functions of the nurse
• Levels of prevention, Health promotion, curative and Rehabilitation
activities
• Methods of delivering Nursing care
• Legislation establishing independent nursing regimens and independent
practice

32
• Standards for practice—structural process outcome and evaluation tools
• Availability of infrastructure i.e., community—sub centers, primary
health centers, CHC, hospitals with speciality facilities/institutions-
general hospitals, specialties, number of patients in a clinical setting and
student strength
• Health agencies like Rehabilitation centers, Hospitals, Nursing homes,
Clinics, subcenter and primary health center
• Equipments and supplies
• Clinical Instructors availability
• Budget
• Field visits.

Principles in selection of learning experiences in Clinical area

• Learning experience should provide an opportunity for students to


practice the type of behavior implied in the objective
• Students must have time and opportunity to analyse the problems of
specific patients, recognizing the emotional and social problems, which
affect the physical status and interrelationships of various aspects of
health
• Provide learning situations to assist in making and carrying out plans for
the present and continued regimen of care
• The activities sought must be within the range of possibility for the
students concerned
• Students should acquire mastery of essential information and basic
concepts for effective health teaching.
Organization of Clinical Learning Experiences
Objectives can be attained only by learning experience through
reinforcement and repetition. An effectively organized educational program
provides opportunity for fulfillment of 4 important criteria.

33
1. Continuity: The relationship existing between the different levels of the
same subject and skills required. It refers to the vertical relation of major
curriculum events.
2. Sequence: It emphasizes the importance of having each successive
experience build upon the preceding one, but go more broadly and deeply
into the matters involved.
3. Integration: The horizontal relationship of curriculum experience.
4. Correlation: The theory has to be correlated to practice, e.g. to develop
skill in mechanical ventilation, the students need to have knowledge of
physiology of respiration, anatomy of the respiratory tract and in practical
experience, the learner should have the opportunity u operate a ventilator,
observation of a client who is on ventilator, documentation and reporting
of the progress, etc. For example: A student is taught Basic
nursing/Nursing Foundation in the first year, but the same subject is
continued in the 2nd and 3rd years in greater depth like Medical-Surgical
Nursing and other specialities sequence is the placement of the content in
a gradual progress from simple to complex and comprehensive. Sequence
goes beyond continuity.
Teacher has to provide the opportunity for the students to teach the clients
in each successive clinical experience, student has to assume an increasingly
broader responsibility for recognizing the local health problem and making
contacts with other individuals or agencies for putting efforts in the solution of
the problem.
Some questions has to be answered before planning clinical experiences
of educational value:
• What is the background of the student, when he comes to the professional
education?
• What experiences he should receive to meet the objectives?

34
• How long students can be posted (duration of clinical experience as per
norms—INC and University or Board?
• What experience does the ward can offer to the student?
• What is the student expected to gain from clinical experience?
Learning experience should be consistent with the philosophy of the
school and lead to the achievement of terminal goal of the program. The teacher
should clearly understand the philosophy of institution, program and concerned
hospitals where students will be posted. The teachers has to state behavioral
objectives to get desirable knowledge, skills and attitude and select those
experiences, which are appropriate in achieving the stated objectives. Learning
experience should provide opportunity for the development of independent
thinking, good judgment, self-discipline and integrity of purpose.
Planning Clinical Assignments
The students' future competence as a Nurse Practitioner depends to a
large extent upon the quality of instruction provided during clinical practice
periods. Responsibility for planning the clinical assignments rests squarely with
the clinical supervisors, e.g. assigning clinical responsibility, planning for ward-
teaching, health-talk, case presentation, bedside clinic/ward clinic, ward
conferences, etc. recognize what else must be dealt within the situation, besides
the particular experience being planned.

Orientation of Students to the Clinical Area


The clinical supervisor has to orient the students to the clinical area, staff
and objectives, expectations from the student, assignments to be completed,
duration of posting, activities to be performed and adhering to the clinical
rotation plan etc.
Matching the Right Student with the Right Client
The teacher has to identify the ability of students when planning their
clinical assignments. The less able student should be helped to move toward the

35
level of performance expected of all students in the group i.e., posting the
students in clinical area based upon their clinical requirement, e.g. Posting III
year B.Sc. (N) student in ENT ward to render nursing care for the clients with
ENT disorders.
Planning for Continuity of Care
The first day of learning experience, the student has to assess the client,
observe the client clinical findings and collect the history, document the history,
reviews the chart of the client, formulate/identify the Nursing diagnosis and
plan the care by utilizing the principles and steps of Nursing Process. On the
second day, he can provide complete care and meet holistic needs. By the 3rd
day, he may help the client and his relatives to gain knowledge about client's
condition and needed assistance by family (the activities which family has to
carry out in rendering care to the client to attain optimum health), which
includes implementation of Nursing care activities as per long-term goals, short-
term goals.
Providing adequate Clinical Supervision
The teacher has to supervise the student's tasks in the clinical area as
Nursing is practice discipline , strict clinical supervisory practice is essential,
while posting the students in clinical areas, INC norms related to teacher student
ratio has to be followed strictly to teach effectively.
Coordinating Classroom Teaching and Clinical learning
It is facilitated by formulating units of study, which are sufficiently broad
reasonably they can find suitable clients for students' assignments.
Recording Results to Help with the Planning of Future Clinical
Assignments
The teacher should maintain the records and document students'
performance in clinical area. Cumulative records has to be maintained, which
has to be submitted at the time of pre finals and final examinations, The

36
documentation should meet the purposes of the course and reflect the strengths
and weaknesses of each student.

37
MONTHS October November December January February March April
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
WEEKS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6

DAYS

144hr
Hrs/month 68hrs 136hrs 68hrs 136hrs 182hrs 130hrs s
3 3 2 3 2 3 3 3 3 2 3 2 4 4 4 4 4 4 3
Hrs/week   4 4 2 4 4 4 4 4     4 8 4 8 8 8 8 8 8 8   4    
1

partial block
Medical Surgical Nursing
2
3

II Sessional exam
I Sessional exam

Teaching Block
4
Orientation

vacation

vacation
Clinical
5
Teaching Block
6
7

nutrition
8
9
10
1
Theory   34 x 8 = 272hrs.   34x4=136hrs     8    
1
Practical   48X 6= 288hrs   6    

38
Theory Practical
Sl.No Subject
Prescribed Allotted Prescribed Allotted

1 Nursing Foundation 45hrs 52hrs    

2 Nutrition And Dietitics 30hrs 36hrs 15hrs 16hrs

3 Biochemistry 30hrs 35hrs    

4 Biophysics 30hrs 35hrs    

5 Psychology 60hrs 68hrs 15hrs  

6 Microbiology 60hrs 68hrs 30hrs  

7 Maternity Nursing 60hrs 66hrs 240hrs 240hrs

8 Child Health Nursing 60hrs 66hrs 240hrs 240hrs

9 Medical Surgical Nursing 90hrs 98hrs 270hrs 288hrs

10 English 60hrs 66hrs    

  Revision   54hrs    

  TOTAL 525 hrs 644hrs 810hrs 838hrs

39
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

UNIT
PLAN
OF MSC NURSING
1ST YEAR
SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

40
MSC NURSING 1ST YEAR
ADVANCE NURSING PRACTICE
UNIT PLAN

Unit – I
NURSING AS A PROFESSION
GENERAL OBJECTIVES:
The students will be able to understand the history of development of nursing profession and the ethical, legal, political & economic aspects of health care delivery
and nursing practice.

Specific objectives Content Time Teaching Evaluation Teacher Reference


Learning responsible
activity

The student will be able  History of development of 10 Hrs Review cum Tests R1, P 1026-1040
to: - Nursing as a profession discussion
R2, P7
- Characteristics
 Illustrate historical Assignment
- Criteria of the profession R3, P106
development of
- Is nursing a profession Debate
Nursing profession R4, P1-33
 Describe the
characteristics and R12, P-64
criteria of profession R5, P1-35
 Perspective of nursing
 Explain the
profession
perspective of Nursing
profession R6,P10
 Describe the code of  Code of ethics
ethics Assignment R7, P48-55, 94-101
 Explain the code of
 Code of professional
41
professional conduct conduct
 Discuss autonomy and  Autonomy and
Panel discussion
accountability accountability
assertiveness in  Assertiveness
nursing practice  Visibility of nurse

 Explain legal  Legal considerations and Debate


considerations and issues in nursing
issues in nursing
 Identify the role of Assignment
regulatory bodies  Role of regulatory bodies
 Recognizethe  Profession 1 organizations
professional & unions self defence
organization and - Individual and collective
unions bargaining
Symposium
 Educational preparations
- Continuing educations
 Discuss the - Career opportunities Presentation
educational - Professional advancement
preparations - Role and scope of nursing
education

- Role of research, Presentation


leadership and
management

 Quality assurance in
 Explain the role of
nursing
research, leadership
and management in
42
nursing profession  Futuristic nursing
- Immovations in nursing
Covered under
- Scope and trends
 Describe the quality nursing
assurance in nursing education

 Discuss the future of


Presentation
nursing

Symposium

43
Unit – II
HEALTH CARE DELIVERY
GENERAL OBJECTIVES:

The students will be able to understand the health care delivery system and appreciate and apply the knowledge of health care delivery system in the care of
individual and community.

Specific objectives Content Time Teaching Evaluation Teacher Reference


Learning responsible
activity

The student are able to:  Health care delivery 6 Hrs Seminars Test R1, P10-15
system :
 Define health care R2, P153
 Definition
delivery system
 Health care delivery R7, P301,319,325
 To differentiate
 Health care environment
primary, Secondary and R4, P323-343, 360-
tertiary health care 387, 267-289
services
 Identify the constraints
 Constraints
of health care delivery
system  Planning process
 Describe the planning  Policies

44
process of health care  Political process visa versa
delivery nursing profession
 Explain about national,
District, State and local
level of health care  Health care delivery
delivery system system:
 Identify the major stoke - National
holders in the health - State
care system - District
 Recognize the health - Local
care delivery concerns,
national health and  Patterns of nursing care Assignment
family welfare delivery in India
programme,  Major stoke holders in the
intersectorial co- health care system
ordination and role of - Government
non-governmental - Non government
agencies industry and other
 Explain information professional
education and  Health care delivery :
communication in - Concerns Seminars
HCDS - National health & family
 Discuss about welfare programme
telemedicine - Intersectorial co-
 Explain information ordination
education and - Role of non-
communication in governmental agencies
HCDS  Information education and
 Discuss about communication Independent
telemedicine  Telemedicine study

45
Unit – III
GENETICS
GENERAL OBJECTIVES:
The students will be able to understand the concept of genetics, appreciate and apply this knowledge in the care individual an family

Specific objectives Content Time Teaching Evaluation Teacher Reference


Learning responsible
activity

The student will be able Review of cell ular division 12 Hrs Lecturer cum Unit tests R1, P639-659
to: discussion
- Mutation an dlaw of R8, P566
 Define terminology inheritance
R9,P675
related to genetics - Human
 Describe mutation and Genome project
law of inheritance
- Thegenomic era
 Identify approaches to
 Basic concept of:
common genetic
- Genes
disorder
Chronosomes & DNA
 Recognize the
methods used for - Approaches to common
genetic testing genetic disorders
 Discuss the ethical  Genetic testing :

46
Legal and - Basis of genetic diagnosis
psychosocial issues in - Presymptamatic and
genetic testing predisposition testing
 Describe the role of - Prenatal diagnosis and Presentation
nurse in genetic screening
counselling and  Ethical, legal and
practical application of psychosocial issuesin
genetic counselling genetic testing
 Practical application of
genetic counselling & role
of nurse

Unit – IV
EPIDEMIOLOGY
GENERAL OBJECTIVE:
The students will be able to understand and gains knowledge regarding epidemiology and apply epidemiological approaches in clinical practice.

Specific objectives Content Time Teaching Evaluation Teacher Reference


Learning responsible
activity

 Identify the scope and Epidemiology: 10 Hrs Lecturer cum Unit tests R9, P44-54,56-
various approaches in discussion 124,302,115,347
 Scope
epidemiology
- Epidemiological approach
and their screening
 Assess the application  Application of
of epidemiology in epidemiology
health care delivery - In health care delivery
 Discuss the role of - Health surveillance
nurse - Health information

47
 Role of nurse

Unit – V
BIO-PSYCO SOCIAL PATHOLOGY
GENERAL OBJECTIVE:
The students are able to understand and gains in depth knowledge in patho-physiological aspects of illness and applied in the ca… of individual and families.

Specific objectives Content Time Teaching Evaluation Teacher Reference


Learning responsible
activity

 Describe the  Pathophysilogy and 24 Hrs Presentation Unit tests R10,-P42- 479,
pathophysiology and psychodynamics of disease 2154,37,228, 817-
psychodynamics of condition 863,1367,387-403,
disease causation  Life process 155,166,1069-
 Haemostatic Mechanism, 1084,337-412,1087-
biological and psycho Presentations 1129,811,863-864,
 Explain the etiology, social dynamics in cum discussion 696, 197-223, 31-
pathophysiology and causation of disease 322
management of
 Life style
common problems R2, P169-181, 265-
 Common problems:
286, 833-834
 Oxygen insufficiency
 Fluid and electrolyte R9, P659, 645
imbalance
 Nutritional problems Presentation
 Hemorrhages and shock
48
 Altered body temperature
 Unconsciousness
 Pain
 Sleep pattern and its
disturbances
 Treatment aspects:
- Pharmacological
- Pre and post operative
care aspects
- CPR Presentation Assignments
- End of life care cum discussion
 Infection
- Prevention
- Standard safety measures
- Bio –medical waste
Independent
management
study
 Role of nurse
- Evidence based nursing Assignment
practice
Presentations
 Innovations in nursing
Assignment

Covered under
unit – 1

49
Unit – VI
PHILOSOPHY AND THEORIES OF NURSING
GENERAL OBJECTIVE:
The students are able to understand and gains in depth knowledge regarding concepts and theories, principles models, approaches relevant to nursing and utilize in
the practiceof nursing.

Specific objectives Content Time Teaching Evaluation Teacher Reference


Learning activity responsible

 Understand the Philosophy and theories of 24 Seminar cum Tests R12,P97,182


philosophy of nursing : Hrs discussion
R4, P55-75
nursing and acquire
Nursing philosophy by,
an acceptable one by R2, P410-471
comparing views  Virginia Henderson
given by various R7,P98
 Imogene king
nursing authors  Betty Newman Assignments R10,P4-6,31-32
 Describevalues,  Sr Callista Roy
conceptual models R13,P95
 Values and conceptual models
and approaches R14,P30-47
- Approaches
relevant to nursing
 Nursing theories
 Discuss the nursing R15,P25-42
- Nigtingales
theories by various
- Henderson’s peplau’s,
theorists and select
Abdellas, Orems
the appropriate one
- Johnson’s
50
to the practice of - Kings Seminar
nursing - Neuman’s, Roy & others
 Explain various  Models
health models - Healthbelief models Lecture cum Essay
nursing - Health promotion models discussion questions
- Communication
Unit – VII
NURSING PROCESS APPROCH
GENERAL OBJECTIVE:
The students are able to understand nursing process and appreciate its importance and identify the health needs of the client using nursing process, provide holistic
and competent nursing care following nursing process approach.

Specific objectives Content Time Teaching Evaluation Teacher Reference


Learning responsible
activity

 Define nursing process  Nursing process: 12 Hrs Seminar cum Tests R2,P243,249,209,
 Enlist the components - Definition discussion assignments
599,314,270,287,
of nursing process - Components of nursing
 Discuss the methods of process 331,227
collection , analysis and  Health assessment
- Illness status of the R10,P12,14,100-106
utilization of data
relevant to nursing patients (individual, family R15,P11,25-92
process & community)
 Identify the approaches - Identification of health
to nursing assessment problems
 Enlist the assessment Nursing assessment:
tools and techniques - Assessment of health
 Mention the purpose, problems
types and sources of - Assessment of tools and Seminar cum
51
data techniques discussion
 Discuss the methods of - History taking
data collection - Validation of assessment
- Purpose and types of data
- Sources of data
- Methods of data collection
- Structuring data
- Data analysis

 Define nursing Nursing diagnosis:


diagnosis
 Illustrate the - Definition
evolution of nursing - Evolution
diagnosis - Types of Nursing
 Identify the types of diagnosis
nursing diagnosis - Formulating and writing
 Formulate nursing nursing diagnosis
diagnosis  NANDALIST
 Identify common  Common errors in writing
Seminar cum
errors in writing nursing diagnosis
discussion
nursing diagnosis  Differentiating from
 Differentiate nursing medical diagnosis
diagnosis from
medical diagnosis
 Define planning
Test
identify setting
priorities
 Identify nursing goals
or expected outcomes
 Formulate objectives
 Discuss steps in  Planning
planning - Setting priorities

52
 Write nursing care - Nursing goals
plans - Types of goals
 Write nursing care - Development of objectives
plans - Steps in planning
 Describe the type of - Writing nursing care plans
nursing intervention
 Validate and
document nursing
care plan
 Modify nursing care
plan

 Implementation
 Define evaluation - Types of nursing Seminar cum
 Discuss the principles intervention discussion
of evaluation - Methods of
 Explain the steps in implementation
evaluation process - Validating nursing care
 Describe the plan
guidlines and goals - Documenting the nursing
of evaluation care plan
 Identify common - Review of care plan
problems - Ongoing data collection
 Modify and rewrite  Evaluation
the nursing care plan - Definition
- Principles
- Steps in evaluation process
- Collect data about the
clients response, compare
in with the goal
- Guidelines and goals of
evaluation
53
- Common problems related
to evaluating nursing care
Seminar cum
- Modify the careplan
discussion

Seminar cum
discussion

Unit – VIII
Psychological aspects and human relations
GENERAL OBJECTIVE:
The students are able to understand the psychological aspects and human relations and appreciate and apply this knowledge in the care of individual and family.

Specific objectives Content Time Teaching Evaluation Teacher Reference


Learning responsible
activity

 Define human  Human behaviour 34 Hrs Seminar Tests R4,P394,267-89


behaviour - Life process and growth &
R1,P128-59, 30-
 Explain growth and development
47,638-818
development including - Personality development
personality - Defense mechanism R12, VOL-I, 393,
development  Communication Lecture cum Assignment
447, 983,527
 Define communication - Interpersonal relationships discussion
 Discuss the importance - Individual and group R10,P558-76,595-
of communication in - Group dynamics 608
nursing practice - Organizational behaviour
 Identify basic human  Basic human needs
needs based on the - Growth and development
developmental age  Sexuality and sexual Seminar
 Identify the psycho  Stress and adaptation
physiological aspects of - Crisis and its intervention
54
stress and adaptation - Coping with loss, death
 Discuss the occurrence and grief
of crisis & crisis
intervention
 Describe problems of
loss of death
 Recognize principles Seminar
and techniques of - Principles and techniques
counselling of counselling

Unit –IX
Nursing Practice
GENERAL OBJECTIVE:The students are able to understand the trends in nursing practice appreciate its importance and apply this knowledge in the care of
individual and family

Specific objectives Content Time Teaching Evaluation Teacher Reference


Learning responsible
activity

 Explain recent trends Nursing practice: 10 Hrs Covered under Test R10,P634,22-23,8-
and scope of nursing unit one (Panel assignments 12,25 R12,P117
- Frame work
 Describe the alternative discussion)
- Scope and trends R9,P751
modalitiesof care
- Alternative modalities of
 Discuss the alternative R1,P976-1026
care
systems of health and
- Alternative systems of
complimentary
health and complimentary
therapies
therapies
 Perform extended and
 Extended and expanded role
expanded role of
55
nursing of nurse
 Provide promotive, - Promotive, preventive,
Symposium
preventive, curative curative and restorative
and restorative health healthcare delivery system
care to individual and in communityand
family insituations
 Explain about health - Health promotionand
promotion and primary primary health care
health care - Independent practice issues Seminar
 Enumerate practice and Independent nurse
collaboration issues midwifery fractioned
 Discuss the models of  Collaboration issues
prevention - Models within & outside
 Describe family, home nursing
nursing and trans
cultural nursing
 Models of prevention
 Identify gender
 Family nursing Covered under
sensitive issues and
 Home nursing unit one
women empowerment
 Tran’s cultural nursing
 Explain disaster
nursing
 Discuss geriatric  Gender sensitive issues &
consideration in womenempowerment
nursing

 Disaster nursing
Seminar cum
discussion
 Geriatric considerations in
nursing

56
Unit – X
COMPUTER APPLICATION FOR PATIENT CARE DELIVERY SYSTEMAND NURSING PRACTICE
GENERAL OBJECTIVE:
The students are able to use computer in patient care delivery system & nursing practice

Specific objectives Content Time Teaching Learning Evaluation Teacher Reference


activity responsible

 Use computers in Computer application 25 Hrs Lecturercum Unit test R1,P103


teaching, nursing discussion
 Use of computer in R4, P343-61
practice
- Teaching
 Describe windows, Ms
- Learning
Office, Excel and
- Research
Power point
- Nursing
 Discuss the practical
 Software
use of internetand
 Windows
literature search
 MS Office
 Identify the statistical
 Excel

 Power point
 package
 Internet, Literature search
 Explain hospital
management  Statistical package
information system  Hospital management
information systems

M.SC NURSNG 1ST YEAR


NURSING EDUCATION – UNIT PLAN
Time Allotted:

57
Theory: 160 hours
Practical: 150 hours
Course Description:
This course is designed to assist students to develop a broad understanding of fundamental principles, concepts, trends and issues related to education and nursing
education. Further, it would provide opportunity to students to understand appreciate and acquire skills in teaching and evaluation, curriculum development,
implementation, maintenance of standards and accreditation of various nursing educational programs.
General objectives:
On completion of each unit students will be specific objectives able to understand the fundamental concept related to nursing education and its application.
Specific objectives:
At the end of the course, students will be able to:
1. Explain the aims of education, philosophies, trends in education & health. Its impact on nursing education.
2. Describe the teaching learning process.
3. Prepare and utilize various instructional media and methods in teaching learning process.
4. Demonstrate competency in teaching, using various instructional strategies.
5. Critically analyze the existing, nursing educational programs, their problems, issues & future trends.
6. Describe the process of curriculum development, and the need and methodology of curriculum change, innovation and integration.
7. Plan and conduct continuing nursing education programs
8. Critically analyze the existing teacher preparation programs in nursing
9. Demonstrate skill in guidance and counseling
10. Describe the problems and issues related to administration of nursing curriculum including selection and organization of clinical experience.
11. Explain the development of standards and accreditation process in nursing education programs
12. Identify research priorities in nursing education
13. Discuss various models of collaboration in nursing education and services
14. Explain the concept, principles, steps, tools and techniques of evaluation.
15. Construct, administer and evaluate various tools for assessment of knowledge, skill and attitude.

58
Specific objectives Content Hours TP Teaching / Teacher Referenc Evaluation
Learning responsible e
activities

Unit I :
General Objective: The students will be able to understand and gain knowledge is nursing education acquire skills in nursing various methods & strategies
apply this knowledge in teaching nursing schedules.

- Define education Education -Lecture / Ref. No.1 Unit test – 20


discussion
- State aims & concepts of education Definition, aims, concepts 3 hrs 1hr
philosophies & their education - Prepare a
- Explain philosophy & their Ref .no.8
implication impact of social philosophy and
education implications
economical, political & 4 hrs objectives for Group
- List the impact of social, technological changes in different courses assignments -
education Ref. No.2
economical, political & 20
- assignments
technological changes on education
- Professional education
- Identify the current trends & issues 1 hr Ref. No.3
- Current trends & issues in
in education - lecture cum
education
discussion
- Enumerate the policies & various
- Education reforms and 1 hr
educational commissions, reports
national educational policy,
- Elaborate the trends in various educational commission Ref. No.4
development of nursing education in reports
Ref. No.5
India
- Trends in development of
1 hr -assignments
- Explain freedom & authority in nursing education in India
education 1 hr Ref. No.6
- Traditional & liberal
- State agencies of education movement in education 1 hr
- Freedom & authority in 1 hr Ref. No.7
education agencies of education

Unit II :

59
General Objective : The students will be able to understand and gain knowledge in concepts of teaching & learning

- Define teaching learning process Teaching learning process : -Lecture cum Ref. No.2
discussion
- Explain the theories of teaching & - Define, theories, & relationship 4 hrs 1hr
learning between teaching & learning
Unit test – 25
- Appreciate the relationship - Educational aims, & objectives
between teaching & learning types, domains, levels, elements
-Preparing
and writing of educational 3 hrs 2hrs Ref. No.7
- State the aims & objectives of objectives based
objectives
education on domains Preparatin of
- Competency based education learning
- Explain the domain of education Preparing lesson Ref. No.3
and outcome based education resource
plan
- List the types of education & its OBE material – 25
elements Peer group
- Instructional design planning 2 hrs 1hrs
- Elaborate CBE and OBE and designing the lesson, writing Peer group
lesson plan, meaning its needs 1hrs
- Discuss instructions design and and importance formats Junior group
1hrs Ref. No.6 Practice
strategies
- Instructional strategies Health education teaching – 25
2 hrs 1hrs
- lecture Clinical
1hrs
- Discussion Peer group Presentation
1hrs Ref. No.8
- Demonstrations Peer group
1hrs
- Simulation Peer group
1hrs
Clinical
1hrs Ref. No.2
- Laboratory Conduct
1hrs workshop
- Seminar
7hrs Ref. No.1
- Panel
1hrs Peer group
- Symposium

60
- Problem solving 2hrs Community Ref. No.9
- Problem based learning 4hrs Clinical
- Workshop 1hrs Peer group
1hrs Peer group
- Project 1hrs Peer group
- Role play 1hrs Peer group
- Clinical teaching methods Peer group
- Programmed instructions 1hrs Junior group
- Self directed learning Peer group
- Micro teaching & junior group Preparation of
instruction
- Computed assisted instruction 1hr Peer group Ref. No.2
aids - 25
- Computer assisted learning 1hr Preparation of
instructional aids
Instructional media & methods : 1hr
- Bulletin board
Key concepts in the selection and 1hr Ref. No.4
use of media in education - Flannel board
1hr
- Developing learning resource - Models
- Discuss the instructional media & 1hr
material using different media
methods - Magnetic chalk
1hr Ref. No.6
- Instructional aids types, uses, board
selections, preparation 1hr
- Charts
- Teaching role in processing & 1hr Ref. No.1
- Cartoons
managing
1hr
- Cornic
- Instructional aids projected &
non projected aids, multi media, 1hr Ref. No.4
- Leaf let
video tile conferences

61
- Graphtype
1hr - Hand out film Ref. No.3
strip
1hr
- Flash cards
1hr
- OHP
1hr
- Pamphlets
1hr Ref. No.6
- Map
- Globe

Unit III
General objectives : The students will be able to understand and gain knwoledge in measurement and evaluation acquires necessary skills in assessing the
student, apply this knowledge while teaching nursing subjects.

- Define measurement and Measurement and evaluation : Ref. No.4


evaluation
- Concept and nature of 2 hrs Lecture cum Unit test – 20
- Explain process of measurement measurement and evaluation, discussion
meaning process, purpose,
- List the purpose of measurement
problems in evaluation and
- Identify the problem in evaluation measurement
and measurement
- Measurement of cognitive,
- State formative and summative affective & psychomotor domain
evaluation assessment 2 hrs Ref. No.2
- Principles of assessment
- Explain internal and external formative & summative 1 hr
examination assessment internal assessment
external examination, advantages 5 hrs Ref. No.1
and disadvantages
62
- Differentiate the advantages and - Criterion and norm referenced 1 hr Ref. No.9
disadvantage of formative and evaluation
summative assessment state.
Ref. No.4

Unit IV
General Objectives : The students will be able to understand and gain knowledge in standardized tests acquires skills in using this tests apply their
knowledge in assessing students while teaching nursing.

- Define standardized & non Standardized & non standardized Ref. No.4
standardized test meaning & characteristics objectivity,
Lecture cum Satyanaraya Unit test – 20
validity, reliability, usability, norms
- Explain the meaning & discussion na sir
3 hrs 1hr Ref.
characteristics Construction of tests
No.10
1hr Construction
- State objectivity, validity, - Essay
Construction of of test
reliability, usability, norms 1hr
- Short answer question & test preparation
Ref. No.4 Preparation –
- Explain construction of 1hr
- MCQS -essay question 20
tests
1hr
- Rating scale -short answer
- Describe eassy, short Ref.
answer question, MCQS, 2 hrs 1hr
- Check list -MCQS No.10 Preparation –
Rating scale, checklist, 3hrs 20
OSCE/OSPE - OSCE / OSPE – check list Ref. No.8
2 hrs
- Discuss differential scales - Differential scales & summated scales -rating scale
& summated scales, critical 3 hrs
- Sociometry -conducting Ref. No.4
incident technique, question
2 hrs 1hr
bank preparation, validation - Attitude scales OSPE for junior Ref. No.5
moderation by panel
63
utilization - Critical incident technique 1hr group Ref.
No.10
- Question bank preparation, validation 2hr Preparing -
moderation by panel utilization. attitude scales Ref. No.8
1 hr
-Developing a system for maintaining -question bank Ref. No.5
confidentiality preparition

Unit V
General Objectives: The students will be able to understand & gain knowledge in administering scoring & supporting, acquire skill in using these
evaluation process in and apply this knowledge in practicing nursing education.

- Describe the method of Administration, scoring, Unit test – 20


administrating test reporting
Lecture cum Ref. No.4
- Highlight on scoring, grading - Administrating a test, scoring, discussion
4 hrs 3hrs Written
grading versus marks
- Define objective test assignment-20
- Objective tests, scoring essay
- Explain the methods of scoring Practice scoring
tests methods of scoring item 4 hrs 4hrs Ref. No.2
essay test test
analysis
- Describe item analysis

Unit VI
General Objectives: The students will be able to understand and gain knowledge in standardized tools acquire skill in using these tools for evaluation and
apply this knowledge to practicing nursing education.

- Define intelligence test , Standardized tools Unit test – 25

64
attitude test,personality test - Tests of intelligence aptitude, 2 hrs 3hrs Lecture cum Ref. No.4
interest, personality achievement, discussion
- Explain tests of interests Presentation –
socio economics status scale,
achievement 25
tests for special mental & 5 hrs 2hrs
- Describe test for special mental physical abilities & disabilities Preparation of
3hrs
and physical abilities and scales and
disabilities 5hrs administering in
clinical,
classroom &
community
settings.

Unit VII
General Objectives: The students will be able to understand & gain knowledge in various nursing education programmes and apply this knowledge in
practicing nursing education.

- Explain the perspectives of nursing - Perspectives of nursing 1hrs -Lecture cum Mam Ref. No.2 Unit test -20
education education global & national discussion shakuntala
- Discuss the patterns of nursing - Patterns of nursing education - Preparation of
Written
education and training programme and training program in India-
different non- assignment-20
Non university & university
university &
programme ANM, GNM, B.Sc
university
Nsg, PCBSc, M.Sc Nsg, M.Phil
nursing programs
& P.hd post basic diploma 4 hrs 6hrs Ref. No.3
curriculum.
program nursing practitioner
programme

Unit VIII
General Objectives: The students will be able to understand and gain knowledge in continuing nursing education, acquire skills in assessment of learning
need and apply this knowledge in practicing nursing education.

- Define continuing education Continuing education in nursing

65
- List the importance of continuing - Concepts, definition, 5 hrs Lecture cum Ref. No.3 Unit test -25
education importance, need, scope, discussion
principles of adult teaching,
- Identify the scope of continuing
assessment of learning needs, Collecting
education
priority resources. Conducting information &
- Explain the principles of adult continuing preparing
- Programme planning,
learning nursing education different
implementation & evaluation of
in clinical for distance
- Discuss the implementation of continuing education 20 staff nurses education in
continuing education programme programmes hrs
3 hrs Ref. nursing
- Elaborate distance education in - Research in continuing No.15
nursing education 2 hrs
3 hrs
- Distance education in nursing
2 hrs
2 hrs

Unit IX
General objectives: The student will be able to understand and gain knowledge in curriculum development and acquire skills in formulating curriculum
frame work and apply this knowledge while teaching nursing education.

Ref. No.3
- Define curriculum development Curriculum development Development of
curriculum of
- List down the curriculum - Definition, curriculum Ref. Unit test-20
nursing course
determinates determinates, process and steps No.10
3 hrs 2hrs
of curriculum development,
- Identify the process of curriculum
curriculum models, types &
development
frame work Ref. No.8
- Explain the steps of curriculum
- Formulation of philosophy, Ref. No.2
development Assignments-
objectives, selection & Preparation of
organization of learning 20
- Discuss the types of curriculum 3 hrs 1hrs unit plan,
experiences, master plan, unit Ref.
plan. lesson plan,
66
- State formulation of philosophy - Evaluation strategies process of 2hrs master rotation No.11
curriculum change, role of plan &
- States objectives 1 hr 1hr Ref. No.3
students, faculty, administration
course plan
- Prepare master plan, unit plan statutory bodies & other state 2 hrs 3hrs Ref.
holders No.10
- Describe the evaluation strategies 1 hr 2hrs
Equivalency of courses Ref. No.8
- Discuss the equivalency of course transcripts, credit system.
transcript & credit system Ref. No.2

Unit X
General Objectives: The students will be able to understand and gain knowledge in preparation of professional teachers acquires skills in organizing
professional aspects of a teacher and apply this knowledge in daily practices.

- Discuss the teachers roles & Teacher preparation Mam Ref. No.2
responsibilities Jayanthi
- Teaches roles & 3 hrs Lecture cum Unit test-20
- Identify the characteristics of responsibilities, functions, discussion
2 hrs Ref. No.1
teacher role characteristics, competencies,
qualities
- List the qualities of teachers
- Preparation of professional 2hrs Ref. No.3 Written
- Explain the preparation of
teacher assignment-2
professional teacher
- Organizing professional aspects
- Discuss the critical analysis of 1 hr 2hrs Ref.
of teacher
various programs of teacher No.13
education in India - Preparation programs
- Evaluation – self & peer
- Critical analysis of various
programs of teacher education in
India

67
Unit XI
General objectives: The student will be able to understand and gain knowledge in guidance and counseling and acquire skills in counseling and apply this
knowledge while preparing for counseling.

- Explain concepts of guidance & Guidance and counseling Ref. No.3


counseling
- Concept, principles, need, 3hrs Seminar Seminar -20
- List the principles of guidance difference between guidance &
Ref. No.8
counseling counseling tends and issues
- Differentiate between guidance - Guidance counseling services,
counseling diagnostic and remedial 1hrs Ref. No.2
- Identify the diagnostic & remedial - Co ordination and organization 2hrs
measure of services
Ref. No.8
- Discuss the techniques of - Techniques of counseling,
counseling interview, case work, 1hr 2hrs Conduct
characteristics of counseling guidance &
- Enlist the characteristics of 1hr Ref. No.3
problems in counseling counseling
counseling 3hrs services at
- Professional preparation and community &
training for counseling. 2hrs hospital settings Ref. No.8

Unit XII :
General Objectives : The students will be able to understand and gain knowledge in nursing curriculum administration and acquire skills in implementing
curriculum role and apply this knowledge while preparing curriculum.

- Explain the role of curriculum co- Administration of nursing


ordinator in planning, implementing curriculum :
Lecturer cum Unit test -20
& evaluation
- Role of curriculum co-ordinator discussion
4 hrs 2hrs Ref. No.3
planning implementation and

68
evaluation
- Identify the evaluation of - Evaluation of education
education programme in nursing program in nursing course &
3 hrs 3hrs Ref. No.8
course program
- List the factors influencing faculty - Factors influencing faculty staff
staff relationship relationship and techniques of
working together
2 hrs Concept mapping Ref. No.2
- Concept of faculty supervision
- Discuss the concept of faculty
position
supervision
- Curriculum research in nursing
- Explain curriculum research in
nursing - Different models of 2hrs Ref. No.8
collaboration between education Ref. No.3
and service
- Identify different models of 3hrs Ref. No.8
education & service

Unit XIII:
General Objectives : The students will be able to understand and gain knowledge in managing nursing educational institutions acquire skills in planning and
organizing nursing institutions and apply this knowledge in teaching nursing education.

- Explain management of nursing Management of nursing Ref. No.2 Unit test – 20


education & its importance educational institution :
Lecture cum
- Planning discussion
1hr Presentation –
- Organizing 20
1 hr Ref.
- Staffing No.14
1 hr
- Budgeting
1 hr

69
- Recruitment 1 hr
- Discipline 1 hr Ref.
No.12
- Public relation 1 hr
- Performance appraisal 1 hr
- Welfare services 1 hr
- Library services 1 hr
- Hostel 1 hr

Unit XIV :
General objectives : The students will be able to understand and gain knowledge in standards and accreditationprocess acquire skills in developing and
maintaining standards in nursing education programme and apply this knowledge in teaching nursing students

- Discuss development & Standard & accreditation Unit test – 20


maintaining standards of
- Development and maintenance 2 hrs 2hrs Lecture cum Ref. No.2
accreditation in nursing
of standards and accreditation in discussion
- Identify role of INC, council nursing education programs
Developing
boards & university 2 hrs Presentation-
- Role of INC, State registration standards of
20
- Explain the role of professional nursing council board & 1hr different courses
associations & union’s university of nursing & role
3hrs of INC, KNC
- Role of professional
associations and union’s

Reference :
70
1. HEIDGERKEN. E. LORETTA. Teaching and learning in schools of Nursing. 3rd edition, 2009. Konark Publishers Delhi.
2. BASAVANTAPPA B.T. Nursing education. 2nd edition 2009. Jaypee Brothers Medical Publishers Delhi.
3. NEERAJA K.P Text book of Nursing education. 1st edition 2005. Jaypee Brothers Medical Publishers Delhi.
4. GRONLUND .E. NORMAN. Measurement and evaluation in teaching. 2 nd edition. Macmillion company. New York.
5. VEERABHADRAPPA G.M. Communication and education technology for nurses. 1 st edition 2011, Vora Medical Publisher, Mumbai.
6. R. PRAMILLA. Nursing communication and educational technology. 1st edition 2010. Jaypee Brothers Medical Publishers, New Delhi.
7. NAG4ESHWARA RAO SINGAMANENI, SREEDHAR PREETHA, BHASKAR RAO DIGUMARTI. 1 st edition 2004. Sonali publishers 2004. Sonali
publishers New Delhi.
8. B.SHAKARANARAYANA. B. SINDHU Learning and teaching nursing. 2nd edition 2008. Print media publisher, Calicut.
9. THAKKAR G. VIMAL. Nursing and nursing education. 2nd edition 2002. Vora Medical Publisher, Mumbai.
10. KURIAN GEORGE. Dr. ALEYAMMA Principal of curriculum development and evaluation. 1 st edition 2002.
11. CARROLL IWASIW, DOLBY GOLDENBERG. MARY ANNE. Curriculum development in nursing education. 1 st edition 2005. Jones and Bartlett
publishers Sudbury.
12. S.K.KOCHHAR. Secondary school administration. 1st edition 1970. Sterling publishers, New Delhi.

M.Sc NURSING 1st year

71
UNIT PLAN
NURSING RESEARCH – RESEARCH METHODOLOGIES
Total : 250hrs.
Theory : 150hrs
Practical : 100hrs.

COURSE DESCRIPTION:
The course is designed to assist the students to acquire an understanding of the research methodology and statistical methods as a basis for identifying
research problem, planning & implementing a research plan. It will further enable the students evaluate research studies and utilize research findings to
improve quality of nursing practice, education and management.
GENERALOBJECTIVES:
At the end of the course the student acquire in depth understand of research methodology appreciate the and develop, will is conducting research.
SPECIFIC OBJECTIVES:
At the end of the course, the students will be able to:
1. Define basic research terms and concepts
2. Review literature utilizing various sources
3. Describe research methodology
4. Develop a research proposal
5. Conduct a research study
6. Communicate research findings
7. Utilize research findings
8. Critically evaluate nursing research studies
9. Write scientific paper for publication.

Unit I: Introduction:
General Objective: At the end of this unit, the students will be able to understand the concept of research and appropriate this knowledge and apply in
the research process.

Sl.No Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching learning Reference


72
. Th Pr activity
1. The students define related Basic research terms 1 Quiz 1(711-735),2(727-
terminologies 755)
2. Identify the methods of acquiring Methods of acquiring 2 Presentation 2(9-12)
knowledge knowledge
3. Differentiate between problem solving, Problem solving & scientific 1 Presentation & 2(21-22)
scientific method and nursing process method Discussion
4. Describe characteristics purpose, scope Scope of nursing research, 2 NIL Presentation & 1(730,18)
and type of research areas, problems Discussion 3(20,23,107),
2(2-3,71,23-29)
Research definition purposes
kinds of research
5. Describe the historical development of Historical evolution of nursing 1 Presentation 2(16),3(85), 1(256)
nursing research research
6. Differentiate health and social research Health social research Lecture cum
discussion
7. Identify the concept of evidence based Evidence based practice 1 Lecture cum 2(640), 1(4-10,673-
practice discussion 690)

8. Identify the ethical principles in nursing Ethics 1 Lecture cum


research discussion

9. Describe the steps in research process Overview of research 1 Lecture cum 3(43),1(18,51,57)
discussion 2(176-210)

Unit: II – REVIEW OF LITERATURE:


General Objectives:The students will be able to understand the concept of review the literature process, appreciate this knowledge and apply this process.

Sl.No Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching Reference


. Th Pr learning activity
1. Describe the importance of review of Review of literature 2 Lecture cum 1(88-111), 2(93-
literature Importance, Purpose, sources discussion 117)
2. Differentiate between primary & Primary & Secondary sources 1 5
secondary sources
3. Identify the steps in writing review of Steps in writing review of 2
literature literature
73
Unit: III – RESEARCH APPROACHES AND DESIGNS
General Objectives:The students will be able to understand the concept of research design, appreciate and apply this knowledge is research process.

Sl.No Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching Reference


. Th Pr learning activity
1. Differentiate the various types of Types: Qualitative & 4 Lecture cum 1(168), 2(26-28)
research design Quantitative discussion

2. Describe the various quantitative Quantitative 4 Nil Lecture cum 1(245)


designs Experimental discussion 2(24)
Non Experimental

3. Describe the various qualitative designs Qualitative designs- 4 Lecture cum 1(580), 2(55-57)
Phenomenology, Grounded discussion 1(249-254)
theory, ethonography

Unit: IV – RESEARCH PROBLEM


General Objectives:The students will be able to understand the concept of research process, appreciate this knowledge and apply this is research.

Sl.No Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching Reference


. Th Pr learning activity
1. Describe research problem in relation to Identification of research 1 Lecture cum 2(79), 3(32-38)
characteristics sources & importance. problem discussion
Selection of a
research
problem
2. Develop skill in formulating problem Formulation of problem 4 5 Lecture cum 2(157), 1(69)
statement, objective statement & objective discussion
exercise
74
formulating
objectives
3. Differentiate between operational & Definition of terms 4 Lectureexercise 1(731), 3(32)
conceptual definition developing op- 2(121)
definition

4. Develop skill in identifying variables Definition of variables Lecture 1(29-32), 2


exercise, (156,168)
discussion

5. Demonstrate skill in developing Hypothesis – definition , types 5 Lecture cum 2(128,259,161)


hypothesis and formulation discussion

Unit: V – DEVELOPING THEORETICAL / CONCEPTUAL FRAME WORK


General Objectives:The students will be able to understand the concepts of theory and conceptual frame work.

Sl.No Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching Reference


. Th Pr learning activity
1. Describe various nursing theories. Theories – nature, 10 Nil Discussion 1(20,114-120)
characteristics, purpose, use review

2. Demonstrate skill in developing Testing and developing 10 Lecture cum 1(132,119,115)


conceptual theoretical frame work conceptual frame work models, discussion 2(128-130,141-145)
theories develop a TF for
the study

Unit: VI – SAMPLING

75
General Objectives:The students will be able to understand the concept of sampling and apply this is research process.

Sl.No. Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching Reference


Th Pr learning activity
1. Define population and sample Population and sample 1 Nil Lecture cum 3(13-20)2(447)
discussion

2. Identify the factors influencing sampling Factors influencing sampling 1 Presentation 3(19)
3. Describe various sampling techniques Sampling techniques sample 3 Lecture cum 2(358)
mints, dements explain problems of size Probability & sampling discussion
sampling error Review of
statistics class
4. Demonstrate skill in developing a good Characteristics of a good 1 Developing 2(354) 1(300),
sampling design for the selected sampling design sampling design 2(344,346), 1(50,295),
1(299,477),3(110,13-
problem for the selected 19)
problem

Unit: VII – TOOLS AND METHODS OF DATA COLLECTION


General Objectives:The students will be able to understand the methods and tools of data collection appreciate this knowledge and apply this is research.

Sl.No Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching Reference


. Th Pr learning activity
1. Describevarious methods of data Data collection – sources, 2 Presentation 2(539), 1(319)
collection methods, techniques
2. Compare various tools of data collection Tools of data collection 9 Presentation 1(349-368)
discussion 2(385)
 Self report
 Observation
 Bio-Physiological
measures
 Projective techniques
3. Demonstrate skill in developing scale Scale construction 5 10 Preparation of a 2(394-410) 1(400)
tool for the
selected problem
76
4. Explain item analysis Item analysis 2 Lecture cum 2(412)
discussion
5. Describe the methods of establishing Validity & reliability of tools 1 Lecture 2(402-405)
validity & reliability 1(356)

6. Explain pilot study Pilot study 1 Discussion 1(51,196) 2(42)

Unit: VIII – IMPLEMENTING RESEARCH PLAN


General Objectives:The students will be able to understand the concept and apply this is research process.

Sl.No Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching Reference


. Th Pr learning activity
1. Explain the administration and data Planning for data collection 5 Nil Lecture cum 2(421-425)
collection procedure. administration of tool collection discussion
of data

Unit: IX – ANALYSIS & INTERPRETATION OF DATA


General Objectives:The students will be able to understand the concept of analysis of data, appreciate this knowledge and apply this is research process.

Sl.No Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching Reference


. Th Pr learning activity
1. Describe the quantitative and qualitative Plan for data analysis 3 Nil Lecture 2(42)
analysis quantitative analysis qualitative discussion 1(501-542)
(570-591) 2(539-
analysis 546)
2. Describe various analysis package Statistical analysis 2 Review of 2(441)
Interpretation of data, statistics class
conclusion, generalization

3. Demonstrate skill is drawing, Summary and discussion 2 2(441)


interrupting data preparing

77
4. Master sheet Preparation of master sheet 3 Exercise, 2(574) 1(325)
preparation of 2(425)
master sheet
Unit: X – REPORTING & UTILIZING RESEARCH FINDINGS
General Objectives:The students will be able to understand the concept of research report and apply this knowledge in preparing research report.

Sl.No Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching Reference


. Th Pr learning activity
1. Describe the types of research report Communication of research 2 Nil Lecture 1(96-103)
report
- Oral
- Written
2. Identify various styles of writing report Writing research report 3 Exercise 1(12,617)
Vancouver, APA, Campbell 3(62)
3. Demonstrate skill in writing scientific Writing scientific articles for 3 Exercising 1(667)
papers publication independentstudy
4. Explain utilization of research finding Utilization of research 2 Discussion

Unit: XI – CRITICAL ANALYSIS


General Objectives:The students will be able to understand the concept of research report and apply this knowledge in preparingresearch report.

Sl.No Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching Reference


. Th Pr learning activity
1. Explain research critiquing – is terms of - Critiquing – definitions 1 Lecture cum 1(655-669)
types, skills needed skills needed, discussion
dimensions involved
2. Demonstrate skill in critiquing research Critique selected 2 8 Critique selected 1(665)
report research studies research report

Unit: XII – RESEARCH PROPOSAL


General Objectives:The students will be able to understand the concept of research proposal, appreciate this knowledge and apply this in develop proposal.
78
Sl.No Specific objectives Content Hours Teaching Reference
. Th Pr learning activity
1. Demonstrate skill in preparing research - Research proposal – 4 7 Properties and 2(662)
proposal definition, steps present action of 1(51,631-645)
involved research
proposal
REFERENCES:Polit Denise, Hungler, Bernadelli, Nursing Research, Principles and Methods, 6 th Edition Philadelphia, LippincotBurns naney, glove susan. The
practice of nursing research 5th edition California

79
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF
NURSING SCIENCE & RESEARCH

LESSON
PLAN
SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

80
Lesson Planning

A teaching unit generally contains a number of lessons. Careful planning of


lessons is essential for experienced as well as beginner teachers. Experienced teachers
use loosely structured lesson plans, whereas beginners use highly structured lesson
plans. Lesson planning, in fact is fundamental to effective teaching.

Meaning and definition:

Lesson plan is a plan prepared by a teacher to teach a lesson in an organized


manner.

According to Lester, “a lesson plan is actually a plan of action, It, therefore,


includes the working philosophy of the teacher, her knowledge of philosophy, her
information about and understanding of her pupils, her comprehension of the objectives
of education, her knowledge of the material to be taught and her ability to utilise
effective method. Thus, lesson plan is the tide given to a statement of the achievements
to be realised and the specific means by which these are to be attained as a result of the
activities engaged during the period of 45 minutes or one hour. It points out what has
already been done, in what directi88on the pupils should be guided further and helped
and what work is to be taken up immediately. Lesson plan is the teacher's mental and
emotional visualization of the classroom experience as she plan it to implement. It is in
many ways, the heart of effective teaching. Purposes of Lesson Planning Careful lesson
planning is the foundation of good_ teaching. It performs the following functions.
1. It demands adequate consideration of goals and objectives, the selection of
subject matter, the selection of teaching-learning methods, the planning of
activities and the planningof evaluation devices.
2. It keeps the teacher on the track, ensures steady progress and a definite outcome
of teaching andlearning procedures.
3. It helps the teacherin effective teaching. The teacher looks ahead and plans a
series of activities with an intention to modify students' attitudes, habits and
abilities in thedesirable directions.

81
4. It prevents waste. It helps the teacher to carry out the teaching activity in a
systematic and orderly Fashion. It encourages proper organisation of subject
matter. It prevents haphazard teaching through eliminating disorder and other ills
of thoughtless teaching.
5. It provides confidence and self-reliance to the teacher. It can ensure that the
teacher does not 'dry up' or forget a vital point. A teacher can enter the class and
carryouttheteaching activity without anxiety.
6. It serves as a check on unplanned curriculum. It provides a framework to carry
out the teaching at a suitable rate” The Hierarchy of lessons becomes well-knit
and interconnected. Continuity is assured in the educative process. Needless
repetition is avoided.

Principles of Lesson Planning


The following principles will help in the preparation of a good lesson plan, (a)
The teacher should prepare a careful but flexible plan. The lesson plan is to be used as a
guide rather than as a rule of thumb to be obeyed blindly. The teacher should have the
courage to depart from it according to the needs of the students, (b) The teacher must
have mastery of and adequate training in the topic from which the subject matterhas
been selected for a certain lesson, (c) The teacher must be fully conversant with new
methods and techniques of teaching nursing, (d) The teacher must know his students
thoroughly and organise the materials in a psychological rather than merely a logical
fashion, (e) The teacher must ensure active student participation. (£) Since monotony is
a defect, different teaching-learning methods have to be employed while teaching
instead of adhering to a single method.

Steps in Lesson Planning


For teaching nursing effectively, the teacher has to proceed in a systematic
manner. For this purpose, some steps have to be followed while preparing the lesson
plan. There is no universally accepted steps in planning a lesson. The following steps
may help in preparing a lesson plan.

82
1. Planning :This step is concerned with the formulation of objectives, selection of the
content, organisation of the content, selection of teaching-learning methods, selection of
audio-visual aids, etc.
2. Preparation or introduction :This brief stage is concerned with introducing the
lesson to the students in an interesting manner and thereby preparing them to receive
new knowledge. Different methods and techniques can be used to prepare the students.
Awareness regarding the previous knowledge of the students is essential for the
successful implementationof thisstage of lesson planning.
3. Presentation :During the presentation stage teacher and students actively engage in
the teaching-learning process. The objectives of the lesson is largely attained during this
stage. The teacher employs appropriate teaching-learning methods with the help of
various teaching aids. A teacher has to employ multitude of teaching skills to make this
stage a successful one (see teaching skills). During this stage nurse educator has to give
importance for generalization and application. Through generalization students develop
an ability to generalize the learned information. For example, while teaching the
importance of maintaining intake output chart, teacher has to motivate the students to
recognize conditions which required intake output monitoring from their clinical
experiences. Teacher has to teach the theory with a practical orientation so that students
can easily apply the learned lessons in various health care settings.
4. Recapitulation or closing stage :This is the last step of the lesson and concerned with
planned repetition, giving assignments, evaluating pupils progresss and diagnosing
pupil learning difficultiesandtaking remedial measures.
Proforma for a Lesson Plan
Just like the steps of lesson plan, there is no universally accepted proforma for
lessonplan. Experienced teachers use a loosely structured lesson plan (Fig 4.3), while
beginnerteachers use a highly structured plan as shown in fig 4.2.
Lesson plan:
Name of teacher Class
Subject No of students
Unit Date and time
83
Topic of lesson duration
Previous knowledge of students venue
Method of teaching
Resources
Central objectives
Specific objectives
Time Specific Content Teaching Student Avaids Evaluation
objective method activity

Assignment:
Reference:
Remarks
Fig: 4.2: Highly structured lesson plan
Lesson plan
Name of teacher class
Subject No of students
Unit Date and time
Topic of lesson duration
Previous knowledge of students venue
Method of teaching
Resources
Central objectives
Specific objectives
Time Specific Objective Content Teacher-learner
activity

84
Assignment
References
Remarks

Fig 4.3 loosely structured lesson plan

85
LESSON PLAN
Name of the student and teacher :
Subject : Nursing Education
Unit : II
Topic : Lesson Planning
Group of student :
Number of student :
Method of teaching : Lecturing
Teaching aids : Black Board, OHP, PPT, Charts, Leaflets
Date, time and duration of teaching :
Place : Class room
Previous knowledge of the group : The previous knowledge about teaching practice has reviewed
Central objective:
At the end of the class students will be able to gain in depth knowledge on lesson planning and develop desirable attitude & skill.
Specific objective:
At the end of the class students will be able to
 define lesson planning
 enumerate the purposes of lesson planning
 describe the steps in lesson planning
 describe the quality of a teacher
 explain the essentials of a lesson plan
 explain the teacher requirement in lesson planning
86
87
Time Specific objective Content Teacher’s activity Learning A-V Evaluation
activity aids
3min Introduce the topic Announces the Listens
topic, planning is
essential not only in
teaching but in all
activities. To be
effective every one
plan out his work.
Lesson planning is
an important part of
work in daily
teaching. A teacher
has to prepare more
detail in writing, it
guides her teaching
activities.
Defines the lesson
planning
Explains the
purposes of lesson
3min Define lesson Definition; planning Listening Black What is
planning and notes Board lesson
taking planning?
“A plan prepare by a teacher to teach a
lesson in an organization manner”

Purpose of lesson planning:


Listening, What are the
Enumerate the Black
8min discussing purposes of
purposes of lesson board
1. It ensure a define objective for the day &notes lesson
planning
work and a clear visualization of that taking planning?
88
objective.
2. It forced consideration of goals /
objective the selection of subject matter,
procedure planning of the activities and
Rankin.S.Patient education, issues, principles, practices. P112-119

89
Conclusion:
At the end of the class students have gain the knowledge about purposes, steps, essentials, teacher’s requirements, elements, format of lesson planning
and quality of a teacher.
Assignment:
Write an assignment on the importance of lesson planning
Reference
Neeraja KP. Text book of nursing education. Jaypee publish

90
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE & RESEARCH

CLINICAL ROTATION PLAN


SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

91
P.C.B.Sc NURSING, 2019-2020 clinical rotation plan
Oc
April       May June July August September t
2 2 2 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 5 5
5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 41 2 43 4 45 6 7 8 9 0 1 52

144hrs     182hrs 178hrs 136hrs 68hrs     1482


4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3
    8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 4 4 4 4 34   34 4                 1482

Child Health Nursing clinical

microbilog Partial Teaching

psychology practical
III Sessional Exam
block

University Exam
OBG Clinical

Model Exam

Study Leave
Revision
vacation

vacation
practical
644hr
        116hrs 102hrs   s
838hr
    48X5=240hrs 48X5=240hrs 34hrs 20   s

92
Orientation Nutrition Practical

Complete Teaching Block Microbiology Practical

Partial Teaching Block Psychology Practical

Sessional Exams Revision

Msn Practical Block Study Leave

Obg Practical Block Model Examination

University Examination
Child Health Nursing Practical Block
Vacation

93
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF
NURSING SCIENCE & RESEARCH

Micro
Teaching
SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

94
MICROTEACHING
Introduction
Microteaching is a training technique whereby the teacher reviews a
videotape of the lesson after each session, in order to conduct a “postmortem”.
Teachers find out what has worked, which aspects have fallen short, and what
needs to be done to enhance their teaching technique. Invented in the mid-
1960's at Stanford University by Dr. Dwight Allen, micro-teaching has been
used with success for several decades now, as a way to help teachers acquire
new skills.
In the original process, a teacher was asked to prepare a short lesson
(usually 20 minutes) for a small group of learners who may not have been her
own students. This was videotaped, using VHS. After the lesson, the teacher,
teaching colleagues, a master teacher and the students together viewed the
videotape and commented on what they saw happening, referencing the
teacher's learning objectives. Seeing the video and getting comments from
colleagues and students provided teachers with an often intense “under the
microscope” view of their teaching.
Micro lessons are great opportunities to present sample “snapshots” of
what/how you teach and to get some feedback from colleagues about how it was
received. It's a chance to try teaching strategies that the teacher may not use
regularly. It's a good, safe time to experiment with something new and get
feedback on technique.
Meaning and Definition
A training exercise used in teacher training in which a student or student
teacher is videotaped during part of a class for subsequent analysis and
evaluation, (cncarta.msn.com/dictionary.../microteaching.html)

95
Micro teaching is also defined as a scaled down sample of actual teaching
which generally lasts ten to thirty minutes and involves five to ten students
(Olivere, 1970)
Techniques
Since its inception in 1963, microteaching has become an established
teacher-training procedure in many universities and school districts. This
training procedure is geared towards simplification of the complexities of the
regular teaching-learning process. Class size, time, task, and content is scaled
down to provide optimal training environments. The supervisor demonstrates
the skill to be practiced. This may be live demonstration, or a video presentation
of the skill. Then, the group members select a topic and prepare a lesson of five
to ten minutes. The teacher trainee then has the opportunity to practice and
evaluate her use of the skills. Practice takes the form of a ten-minute micro-
teaching session in which five to ten pupils are involved.
Feedback
Feedback in micro-teaching is critical for teacher-trainee improvement. It
is the information that a student receives concerning his attempts to imitate
certain patterns of teaching. The built-in feedback mechanism in micro-teaching
acquaints the trainee with the success of his performance and enables him to
evaluate and to improve his teaching behavior. Electronic media gadgets that
can be used to facilitate effective feedback is a vital aspect of micro-teaching.
(Teg, 2007).
Microteaching Process
Micro teaching involves a set of activities which teacher-trainee undergo
to acquire teaching skills. These are referred to as the micro teaching process.
Allen and Ryan (1968) developed the original micro-teaching process called
“Teach-critique-Re-teach cycle”. Sequences of steps are adapted from the
original processes:
1. Modelling

96
2. Planning teaching
3. Teach - Re-card stage
4. Play back critique stage (Feedback)
5. Re-planning to re-teach
6. Re-teach
7. Re-observation of teaching
Micro-teaching Group Session Guidelines
♦ to be distributed to all participants prior to a Micro-Teaching Session ♦
Introduction:The main objective of the micro-teaching session is to
provide the participants with an environment for practice-based teaching to
instill self-evaluative skills. These sessions are usually conducted with a small
group (~ 4 presenters) from within a department. If there are fewer than three
presenters from a department, their session will be combined with that of
another department. Presentations take about 15 minutes each (including
presentation, feedback and transition time). Micro-teaching sessions should be
held as early in the academic year as possible. Those wishing to receive the
Sheridan Teaching Seminar: Certificate I in a given year must complete their
micro-teaching session by mid March of that year. Micro-teaching sessions are
usually held in departmentsA-but can be held at the Sheridan Center if
necessary. The department's Faculty Liaison (FL) to the Sheridan Center
organizes the micro-teaching sessions with the assistance of the Graduate
Student Liaison (GSL). The sessions are attended by at least one faculty
member from the department (usually the FL), the GSL and a Sheridan Center
staff member. The Sheridan Center handbook Teaching and Persuasive
Communication: Class Presentation Skills
(http://www.brown.edu/sheridan_ccnter/publications/preskils.html) is available
online to assist in the preparation for these sessions.
1. Goals

97
• To encourage participants to think more specifically about the goals of
their teaching in terms of how students will learn the
informationpresented. This involves thinking about teaching style as well
as content.
• To give participants specific suggestions regarding how their teaching
styles are perceived by others both within and from outside specific
disciplines.
• To provide an opportunity to observe and evaluate other styles of
teaching and to learn how to share observations constructively with
others.
2. General Format
• A scribe is appointed for each presentation.
• A participant then gives a five-minute presentation, followed by ten
minutes of feedback from the audience.
• The scribe records the audience feedback, using the Micro-Teaching
Group Session
• Feedback Sheet. The Micro-Teaching Group Session Feedback Sheet is
available at: http://www.brown.edu/sheridan center/consulting/micro
feedback.pdf
• The Faculty Liaison is responsible for bringing a copy of this form for
each presenter.
• The scribe gives the completed Feedback Sheet to the presenter for
his/her own reference.
3. Presenter Information and Session Preparation
• Each participant prepares a five-minute mini-lecture on any topic. The
content is not crucial for this process. In fact, it is preferable to make a
presentation of something outside the field, as colleagues can find
themselves responding more vigorously to the content than to the
effectiveness of communication. If a department prefers presentation of

98
discipline-specific material, then the presence of Sheridan Center staff
ensures that some of the feedback replicates the possible responses of
non-specialists. It is recommended that the time limit will be enforced to
make sure that all participants have sufficient time. Participants with
audio-visual aids (e.g. overheads, LCD projectors.) must make their own
arrangements. Media Services (863-2197) provides these for a fee.
• Each participant should plan to begin the presentation with an explicit
statement of goals for the presentation and the objectives by which they
plan to achieve those goals. These goals can be written on a board,
distributed on sheets for the audience, displayed on an overhead or slide,
or stated at the beginning of the presentation.
• Each presenter should consider:
o the style as well as the content of your presentation,
o the methodology of your presentation
o special strategies you may need to accommodate students who are
not experts in your discipline.
4. Audience Participation:
• Group members are expected to participate actively in other's
presentations. They should write down any comments they would like to
make during the feedback period. Their comments should focus on
evaluating how well the goals articulated by the presenter at the
beginning of the talk have been fulfilled. Group members can also
comment on other aspects of the presentation that they may deem
important.
5. Sharing Feedback & Criticism
Associate Provost Nancy Dunbar and Professor Barbara Tannenbaum of
the Theater, Speech and Dance Department have some useful tips on sharing
feedback and giving criticism. Their list of suggestions is provided below.
• “Own” your messages
99
State your reactions with “I” rather than “you” as audience reactions vary.
By owning your own reactions, you allow for the possibility of different
responses. (You might invite other reactions as well).
Examples:“I appreciated the way you connected your speech to last week's
class discussion.”“I was confused when you said.... because...”
• Be specific and concrete.
While it might be nice to know that someone liked my introduction, it
doesn't tell me very much. Instead, one could say, for example, “I liked the
concrete illustrations of the theory X.”, “I liked the way you included your own
background and interest in the introduction.”
• Focus on presentation behavior, not on personality characteristics and
judgments.
For example, say “I would have liked more eye contact” rather than “It's
clear you're really not interested in us since you never look at us.”
Also, limit comments to behaviors that are changeable. Distracting gestures can
be brought under control. Calling attention to a stutter, however, is probably not
helpful in a public setting.
• Distinguish between observations, inferences, and judgments. All of these
have some role in evaluation but they are quite different.
• Observations have to do with what we see and hear; inferences and
conclusions we reach based on those observations and judgments and/or
evaluative response.
• Listeners observe differently, and, more important, draw different
inferences and judgments from what they see and hear. Therefore, start
by reporting your observations and then explain what you inferred from
them.
• Speakers can hear a great deal of feedback on observations. Inferences
and judgments arc better received when the observations they are based
on are clear. For example, “I noticed that you made eye contact with the

100
students, which made me feel that you were genuinely trying to engage
their attention”.
• Balance positive and negative comments.
Try to emphasize the positive aspects of a presentation which the
presenter can build upon constructively in the future to improve his/her style.
• Invite feedback from a variety of listeners. Conclusion
A microteaching session typically involves recording a short lesson in
front of a small peer group in order to receive feedback on one's teaching style.
This exercise gives participants the opportunity to oractice teaching and receive
feedback in a non-threatening and supportive environment. Microteaching also
allows participants to gain a new perspective on their teaching through
simulating the perspective of the student. Microteaching participants are able to
literally see how they teach through the eyes of “students”—in this case, their
fellow peer participants—and through observing themselves teaching via
recorded playback.
In a true microteaching session, participants only present for 5-7 minutes
and are recorded. The video is then played back in front of all participants. One
variant of microteaching is to record longer teaching presentations and prepare
DVDs for the participants, to be viewed later during a confidential follow-up
consultation.

101
Bibliography
1. The Harriet W. Sheridan Center for Teaching and Learning Brown
University Box 1912;863-
1219;Shericlan_Center@brown.eduhttp://www.brown.edu/ sheridan _
center
2. http://www.utorontoxa/tatp/certificate/micro.html
3. http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Microteaching
4. JSTOR: Microteaching: A Programme of Teaching Skills REVIEWS
Microteaching: A Programme of Teaching Skills. By G. Brown. Pp. 163.
London: Methuen, 1975.
5. Microteaching as a vehicle of teacher training—its advantages and ...
Brown G. Microteaching - A Programme of Teaching Skills.
Philadelphia: Harper & Row Publishers Inc; 1975.
6. Universidad FASTA
Microteaching : a programme of teaching skills. Autor/es: Brown,
George. Publicacion:. Editorial: Methuen, Nueva York.

102
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE & RESEARCH

SUBJECT: NURSING EDUCATION.


MICRO TEACHING ON HEALTH EDUCATION
SUBMITTED TO: SUBMITTED BY:
MR. SHYAM NAGAR PRIYANKA SINGH
ASSISTANT PROFESSOR MSC NURSING1st YEAR
MENTAL HEALTH NURSING K.I.N.S.R. KANPUR
K.I.N.S.R. KANPUR

103
LESSON PLAN

Name of the student and teacher :PRIYANKA SINGH


Subject : COMMUNITY HEALTH NURSING
Unit : IX
Topic : Health Education
Group of student : 2ndB.Sc(N)
Number of student :
Method of teaching : Lecturing
Teaching aids : Black Board, OHP, PPT, Charts, Leaflets
Date, time and duration of teaching :
Place : Class room
Previous knowledge of the group : The previous knowledge about importance of health education has reviewed

104
GENERAL OBJECTIVES:
At the end of the class group will get adequate knowledge regarding definition, types and importance of health education and develops desirable
attitude and skills.
SPECIFIC OBJECTIVE:

 Explain about meaning of health education


 Define health education
 Explain about aims & objectives of health education
 Enumerate principles of health education

TEACHER’S REFERENCE:

 PARK.K. Preventive and social medicine. 17th edition. Pp 123-129


 B.T.Basavanthappa’s “medical surgical nursing”, Jaypee brothers, pp752-753

SL . Time Specific Contents Teachers activity Learners Activity Evaluation


NO objective
01. 1Min Introduces Introduces the topic. Students are Introduced
the topic Health is the concern of attentively the topic on
health everyone for everyone. listening to the Health
education. Health education is the class Education.
foundation of a preventive
health care system. Health
education can bring about
changes in life styles and
risk factors of disease.
Most of the world’s major
health problems and
premature deaths are
preventable through

105
changes in human
behaviour at low cost.

2 1Min Explains Meaning: Explains the meaning of Students have Explained the
about Health Education is a term commonly used and referred health education. taken down the meaning of
meaning of by health professionals. meaning. health
health education.
education.
3 1Min Defines Definition: Explains the definition of Students have Explained the
Health Health Education is indispensable in achieving individual Health education taken down the definition of
Education and community health. It can help to increase knowledge definition health
and to reinforce desired behaviour patterns. education.

4 2Min Explains Aims & Objectives of Health Education: Enumerates the aims & Students have Explained the
about aims a) To encourage people to adopt & sustain health objectives using taken down the aims &
and promoting lifestyle & practices. transferancies points objectives.
objectives b) To promote the proper use of health services available
of health to them.
education c) To arouse interest and provide new knowledge,
improve skills & change attitudes in making rational
decisions to solve their own problem.
d) To stimulate individual and community self-reliance
and participation to achieve health development
through individual and community involvement at
every step from identifying the problems to solve
them.

5 3Min Enumerates Principles of health education are.


Principles 1. Credibility: It is the degree to which the message to Enumerates the principles Students have Explained the
of Health be communicated in perceived as trust worthy by of health education. taken down the principles of
education receiverInterest: It is a psychological principal that points. health

106
people are unlikely to listen those things which are education.
not to their interest.
2. Participation: Participation is a key word in health
education.
3. Motivation: In every person there is a fundamental
desire to learn.
4. Comprehension:In health education we must know
the level of the understanding education and literacy
of people to whom the teaching is
directed.Reinforcement: Few people can learn all that
is new in a single period. Reputation at interval is
necessary.Learning by doing: Learning is an action
process not a memorizing.
5. Known to unknown: In health education we must
proceed from the concrete to obstruct from the
particular to general from simple to more
complicated.Setting an example
6. Good human relation.
7. Feed back
8. Leaders
06 1Min Concluded Conclusion: Concludes the topic. Student listen to Concluded
the topic Health education is very important in creating an the conclusion. the topic.
awareness about health and its maintenance among
general public.

07 1Min Assignmen Write the different levels of health education: Writes on the block board. Students have
T Reference: taken down the
Preventive and social medicine K.PARK 17th assignment
edition.Fundamentals of nursing.Potter & Perry.

107
LESSON PLAN
Name of the student and teacher :Priyanka singh
Subject : Community Health Nursing
Unit : IX
Topic : Prevention of accidents
Group of student : 2nd B.Sc(N)
Number of student :
Method of teaching : Lecturing
Teaching aids : Black Board, OHP, PPT, Charts, Leaflets
Date, time and duration of teaching :
Place : Class room
Previous knowledge of the group : The previous knowledge about accidents
has reviewed
GENERAL OBJECTIVES:
At the end of the class group will get adequate knowledge regarding definition, types and
preventive management of accidents and develops desirable attitude and skills.
SPECIFIC OBJECTIVES:
Group will be able to
 Define home accidents.
 Enumerate the causes of home accidents.
 Enlist the types of home accidents.
 Explain drowning and its management.
 Describe burns and its management.
 Enlist the types of poisoning and its management.
 Explain about falls and its preventive measures.
 Discuss about bites and other injuries by animals including management.
 Describe common management and preventive measures of accidents.
Teacher’s reference:
 B.T.Basavanthappa’s “community health nursing”, Jaypee brothers, 2 ndedition,
pp752-753
 Stanhope Lancaster, “ Community health nursing” Mosby publications, 18 th edition,
pp 791-792
 Park .K, “ Preventive and social medicine”, Bhanot publishers, 18 th edition, pp325-
326.
 http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ emergency management in children

108
SL. TIME SPECIFIC CONTENTS AV TEACHERS STUDENTS EVALU
NO. OBJECTI AIDS ACTIVITY ACTIVITY ATION
VES

To Black Teacher introduces the Group listens


1. 1 mt
introduce board topic.An accident has to the topic.
the lesson been defined as an
for the day. unexpected,
unplanned occurrence,
which may evolve
injury. It also
produces intended
injury, death or
properly damage.
Home accidents or
domestic accidents are
common in children
and most of them are
preventable

2. 1 mt DEFINITION:
To define Black
home Home accident is defined as an accident which board Defines the home Listen to the Define
accidents. takes place in the home or in its immediate accidents. definition. home
surroundings. It includes all accidents not accidents
connected with traffic vehicles or sports. .

CAUSES:
 Defective floors
 Bad lighting

109
 Keeping poisons within reach of children.
 Highting stare on floor.

Leafle List out the common Listens to the Enumera


3. 2mts To TYPES OF COMMON ACCIDENTS te the
ts
enumerate home accidents topic. types of
the common  Drowning
 Burns accidents
home .
By flames
accidents
Hot liquid
Electricity
Crackles of fire works
Chemicals
 Poisoning
Drugs
Insecticides
Kerosenes
 Falls
 Injuries from sharp or pointed instruments
 Bites and other injuries from animals.
4. 1mts Define
To define PPT Listens to the
DROWNING: Defines drowning. drownin
drowning. topic.
g.
Drowning is defined as the death from suffocation
caused by submersion in water within 24 hours of
the incident
Children are more prone to accidental drowning

110
and death takes place in ponds, rivers or ocean.

5. 2mts To explain PREVENTIVE MEASURES OF PPT Explains the Actively Explaint


the DROWNING: preventive measures listens to the he
prevention  Signs should be posted in areas of known and first topic and preventio
and hazardous water to warn older children of aidmanagement. clarify n and
managemen the danger. doubts. manage
t of  Adequate fencing and self latching gates ment of
drowning restricting access to wading swimming drownin
pools could also reduce drowning. g
 Parents should educate their children
about the effects of drowning.
 Children should be taught about the basic
steps of swimming and call for help.
 Swim only in areas where adequate
supervision is present (i.e. a trained and
certified Lifeguard).
FIRST AID CARE.
 Efforts at rewarming should be instituted
as soon as possible.
Wet clothing should be removed to
prevent continued conductive heat loss.
 Put the victim in a prone position (face
down) and make sure that air passage is
not obstructed.
 Pull the tongue forward.
 Raise middle part of the body with hands
6. round the belly. This helps to drain out the
water from lungs.

111
 Give artificial respiration until the
respiration comes to normal

To describe BURNS
burns and A burn is an injury caused by heat, cold,
2mts Describes burns, its Actively Explain
its electricity, chemicals, light, radiation, or friction. OHP causes and preventive listen and the
managemen
Burns can be highly variable in terms of the tissue care and management. clarifies all preventiv
t.
affected, the severity, and resultant complications doubts e and
CAUSES manage
ment
 scalds, the No. 1 culprit (from steam, hot care of
bath water, tipped-over coffee cups, hot
burns?
foods, cooking fluids, etc.)
 contact with flames or hot objects (from
the stove, fireplace, curling iron, etc.)
 chemical burns (from swallowing things,
like drain cleaner or watch batteries, or
spilling chemicals, such as bleach, onto the
skin)


electrical burns (from biting on electrical
cords or sticking fingers or objects in
electrical outlets, etc.) overexposure to the
sun
MANAGEMENT OF MINOR BURNS AND
SCALDS:
 Reassure the victim, place the injured part

112
under slowly running water or immerse in
cold water for 10 minutes longer if pain
persists.
 Dress the area with clean sterile material.
 Give plenty of oral fluids.
 Do not use adhesive dressing.
 Do not apply cotton pads.
 Do not break blisters, remove loose skin if
any.
MANAGEMENT OF SERIOUS BURNS AND
SCALDS.
 Keep the victim to lay down with comfort.

 Gently remove any rings, watches or


constricting clothing’s.
 For facial burns make a mask from a
clean, dry, sterile materials and cut holes
for nose, mouth and eyes.
 Immobilize badly burnt limbs.
If breathing stops give resuscitation .

 If the victim is conscious give sips of


water at frequent intervals to maintain the
fluid balance.
 Do not apply lotions or ointments to
injury.
 Patient is to be removed from the
offending agent like gaseous atmosphere.
 Put out the flames by any means available.
113
PREVENTION:
 Arrange the open cooking labs in a place
away from the wind circulation.
 Always close the valve of the gas cylinder
after use.
 Keep kerosene and other inflammable
materials away from fire sources.
 Keep the fire and matchboxes away from
children reach.

POISONING:
Listens to the
7. 2mts Taking a substance that is injurious to Enlists the different
To enlist the class.
health or can cause death. Poisoning is types of poisoning and
types of Charts its preventive and
still a major hazard to children, despite
poisoning
child-resistant (and sometimes adult- management care Enlist the
and its
resistant) packaging and dose-limits per types of
managemen
container. poisonin
t.
g and its
AGENTS OF POISONING: manage
 Drugs ment?
 Insecticides and pesticides
 Rat poisoning
 Kerosene like substances

114
MANAGEMENT:
 Inform the police or authority.
 Bring to hospital immediately.
 Collect the maximum data from reliable
sources.
 Preserve any suspect materials like a
bottle containing pills or liquid for
information to the treating doctors.
 If the victim has vomited, collect the
vomitus which can give some dues about
the type of poison ingested.

FALLS
Certain age groups among children are more
prone to certain types of falls. For example,
8 2mts To list out infants are more likely to fall from furniture, Teacher Listen to the
the while toddlers are more likely to fall from OHP topic with
enlists the preventive
preventive windows. Older children sustain more fall-related active
measures of falls.
measures of injuries from playground equipment. response
falls. List out
the
 Slips and falls can be a normal part of preventiv
growing up, for example when a child is e
learning to walk. measures
 Many falls are not serious and may simply of falls?
result in a bump or bruise; others
may result in fractures, cuts or head injuries.

115
Prevention.
9.  Keep the cribs up when the infants are
sleeping.
 Always be with the child while climbing
the stairs.
 Keep the door closed.

INJURIES FROM SHARP OR POINTED Discussed about the Actively


INSTRUMENTS common injuries by listens with
10. 2mts To discuss
Charts instruments and bites good
the common
response
injuries by
instruments Children are more prone to get injuries from
and animal instruments like knives, blades and other kitchen
Describe
bites appliances.
the
including common
preventive injuries
care. PREVENTIVE MEASURES
by
Keep away all the sharp instruments away from instrume
the reach of the child. nts and
animal
bit
BITES AND OTHER INJURIES FROM
ANIMALS
Insect bites such as those with honeybees and
injuries by animals like cows, goat, squirrals, dogs
etc also common.

116
Most of these injuries are poisonous and requires
serious medical treatments.
Snake bites are also common and serious accident.
SUMMARY:
The accidents are common in our day to
day lives and children are more prone to Summarizes the topic Actively
get accidents. So the preventive measures participates
1mts
are important to avoid such accidents. The in discussion
Describe
common people should gain basic
common
knowledge regarding this topic.
home
accidents
and its
preventiv
e
manage
ment?

Conclusion:
Hence accidents are common in our day to day lives and children are more prone to get accidents. So the preventive measures are important to
avoid such accidents. The common people should gain basic knowledge regarding this topic.
Assignment:
Write an assessment on common types of accidents
Reference:

117
B.T.Basavanthappa’s “community health nursing”, Jaypee brothers, 2ndedition, pp75

118
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE & RESEARCH

Teaching Method
In Class Room
SUBJECT : EDUCATION AND NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO: SUBMITTED BY:


MR. SHYAM NAGAR PRIYANKA SINGH
ASSISTANT PROFESSOR MSC NURSING 1st YEAR
MENTAL HEALTH NURSING K.I.N.S.R. KANPUR
K.I.N.S.R. KANPUR
119
LESSON PLAN
ON
LECTURE METHOD
SUBMITTED TO: SUBMITTED BY:
MR. SHYAM NAGAR PRIYANKA SINGH
ASSISTANT PROFESSOR MSC NURSING 1st YEAR
MENTAL HEALTH NURSING K.I.N.S.R. KANPUR
K.I.N.S.R. KANPUR

120
LECTURE METHOD

INTRODUCTION
Lecture method is a strategy is the oldest one that is been used by the teachers to teach
almost all the subjects of the curriculum at all grade levels.
MEANING
The term lecture was derived from the Latin word ‘lectare’ which means to ‘read
loud’.
DEFINITION
Lecture is a teaching activity where by the teacher presents the content in an
comprehensible manner by explaining the facts, principles and relationships, during which
the teacher is expected to elicit the student participation by employing the appropriate
techniques
It is a mode or planned scheme device and employed by the teacher for presenting a
segment or unit of the desired content material of a subject to a group of learners through
lecturing which mainly aims in attaining the teaching learning objectives related particularly
to the cognitive and affective domains of the learners behavior
PURPOSES OF LECTURE
 to provide structured knowledge
 to motivate and guide in hunting the knowledge
 to arouse the student interest in the subject
 introduce the students to the new area of knowledge
 to clarify the difficult concepts
 to assist the students in preparing the students for discussion
 to promote critical thinking

PRE PARATION OF LECTURE


The goal of lecturing is communication, and it is more effective when it is prepared
beforehand.The objective of the course and the immediate objective should be kept clearly in
the mind. The teacher should remember what points she has to make, in what order and what
emphasis. The teacher should have a scheme for each lecture in mind, not as a set number of
pages to be read over. The lecture should have central theme carried to completion in each
delivery. The lecture should contain a sequence of ideas kept relatively simple with headings
and sub-headings. There should be a definite limitation on the number of sections in which
the main topic is decided. The lecture should contain a introduction to maintain rapport with
the class, this introduction may be the preview of the main topic to be covered. Introduction
can serve as a means of getting the class started properly. The lecture should be written in
outline form. If the illustrative materials are used, they should be prepared and tested before
the lecture.

121
LECTURE COMPONENTS: 

Silberman (1990) suggests five approaches to maximizing students' understanding and


retention during lectures. These can be used to help ensure the effective transfer of
knowledge.

 Use an opening summary. At the beginning of the lecture, present major points and
conclusions to help students organize their listening.
 Present key terms. Reduce the major points in the lecture to key words that act as verbal
subheadings or memory aids.
 Offer examples. When possible, provide real-life illustrations of the ideas in the lecture.
 Use analogies. If possible, make a comparison between the content of the lecture and
knowledge the students already have.
 Use visual backups. Use a variety of media to enable students to see as well as hear what is
being said.

The key to an effective lecture style is to break down the lecture into its component parts and
use a variety of approaches within each component. This is especially critical when a group
of students will be attending a series of lectures by the same educator. The three main parts of
a lecture are the introduction, body and summary

The purpose of the introduction is to capture the interest and attention of the students. It can
also serve to make students aware of the instructor's expectations and encourage a positive
learning climate. A good introduction is critical to the success of a lecture.

TIPS FOR CREATING AN EFFECTIVE INTRODUCTION 

1. Review lecture objective(s).


2. Ask a rhetorical question.
3. Ask for a show of hands in response to a general question.
4. Ask a series of questions related to the lecture topic.
5. Use an interesting or famous quotation.
6. Relate the topic to previously covered content.
7. Use a case study or problem-solving activity.
8. Use a videotape or other media.
9. Show an appropriate cartoon with the overhead or slide projector.
10. Make a provocative statement to encourage discussion.
11. Give a demonstration.
12. Use a game or role play.
13. Relate the topic to future work experiences.
14. Share a personal experience.
15. Relate the topic to a real-life experience

The instructor can then make a smooth transition into the body of the lecture once the
attention of the students has been captured with an interesting introduction. The body of the
lecture contains the core of the information to be transferred to the students. Beitz (1994)
recommends that the instructor use brain-storming, discussions, problem-solving activities,
case studies and games to make the lecture more interactive. 

122
The purpose of the lecture summary is to draw together the critical information presented and
ensure that students leave the lecture with a clear under-standing of this information. The
summary should be brief and address only main points. There are several techniques which
can be used to summarize a lecture: 

 Ask the students for questions. This gives students an opportunity to clarify their
understanding of the content.
 Ask questions of the students. Several questions which focus on the main points of the
content may be used to summarize the content of the lecture.
 Use a transparency, slide or flipchart to review the summary points.

LECTURE NOTES:
 Many lecturers make the mistake of thinking that they know their content well enough to
deliver a lecture without notes to guide them. This is very difficult for most instructors and
usually results in an unsatisfactory experience for both the instructor and the student. Instead,
the instructor should prepare lecture notes to serve as a script or set of cues to follow during
the lecture. Lecture notes are key words, phrases and other reminders (e.g., audiovisual cues,
questions, examples, notes for activities) organized into an outline format. If a text rather than
an outline format is used, the lecturer may begin to read the notes and the students will
become bored.
LECTURE NOTES HELP THE INSTRUCTOR:

 Stay on topic and prevent getting lost.


 Cover the main points without forgetting anything.
 Glance at a specific point and quickly return attention to the students.

Relax and focus on delivery instead of worrying about what point to make next.

Tips to Reduce Presentation Anxiety

 Avoid eating a big meal before the lecture. Not only will a full stomach make you drowsy,
but it makes it more difficult to move around the room with energy.
 Arrive early to make sure that everything is ready before the first student arrives.
 Make sure all of the media equipment is working.
 Locate and check the lighting and temperature controls.
 Decide where the lecture notes will be placed (e.g., on a lectern, desk, table) when they are
not being held.
 Have a glass of water available during the lecture.
 Go for a short walk just before the lecture.
 Look over your lecture notes one last time.

Greet students as they enter the room. Shake their hands, welcome them to the lecture and
talk to as many of them as possible.

With planning and effective presentation techniques, the lecture can be a highly effective and
interactive method for transferring knowledge to students. If the lecture is carefully planned,
the educator will have a clear purpose of the lecture and will have considered the logistics
associated with the number of students, amount of time allocated for the lecture, room size

123
and available media. Planning will also help ensure that the educator uses a variety of
approaches to introduce, deliver and summarize the lecture. Lecture notes in outline form will
help the instructor give an effective presentation.

Other key points to remember in preparing and delivering a lecture: 

 The first few minutes of a lecture are important. Plan them well!
 Verbal communication skills are critical. These include appropriate voice projection,
avoiding fillers, using students' names, making smooth transitions, using examples and
providing praise.
 Nonverbal communication skills also are very important. These include eye contact, positive
facial expressions, gestures and movement.
 Effective questioning and interaction are critical to the success of the lecture. Questioning
skills include planning questions in advance, asking a variety of questions, using students'
names and providing positive feedback.
 The lecture should be summarized by asking for questions, asking questions and using media
to review main points.
 An evaluation using a video recording or an observer can assist the lecturer in assessing the
quality of the presentation and improving lecture skills.

TECHNIQUES OF LECTURE
 voluntary dissemination of information or spontaneity
 voice gradation and voice clarity
 adequate pacing
 proper body language
 control annoying mannerism
 judicious use of audio-visual aids
 simple plans and key points
 elicit feedback from students
 providing further clarifications
 time management
 eye contact

ADVANTAGES
It is most economical method of teaching (apparent saving of time). It is provided
with all the facilities, lecture can be conducted even with a teacher and student ratio of 1:200.
For students it is more economical in terms of time as they get more information by attending
the lecture than reading books. Lecture method enhances the listening capacity of the
students. Gives a feeling of security
DISADVANTAGES
Keeps the students in a passive situation
Does not facilitate learning how to solve problems
Offers hardly and possibly of checking the learning progress
Doesn’t allow for individual pace of learning

124
Low receptivity
Teachers may practice lecture method without adequate preparation

STRATEGIES TO OVERCOME THE DISADVANTAGES


Emphasis higher level intellectual skills
Signposting for clear instruction
Make lecture notes interactive
Less memorizing for facts and more construction of meaning

THE INTERACTIVE LECTURE


It is a combination of lecture, discussion and questioning. It is modified method of
tradition lecture, it is developed by retaining the merits and deleting the demerits of the
lecture method, discussion and questioning. The technique of lecture, discussion, and
questioning can be blended together into an interactive lecture by utilizing the advantages of
all the methods and reducing the disadvantages. Class time can be logically and efficiently
divided into sections for lecture, informal discussion and questioning. In this way it will
stimulate the students thinking and clarify difficult points.Students become periodically
active, changing tactics may recapture the students attention. The class room becomes more
interesting and it is hoped more memorable.
CONCLUSION
This is an old method of teaching which is used in a large groups, which has many
techniques to be used, it has many advantages. In the other hand it also have many
disadvantages. To overcome the disadvantages they have formulated some strategies to be
followed. More moreover they have identified a new method of lecture called as interactive
method, which is the combination of lecture, discussion and questioning. This interactive
method is formulated by keeping the advantages in mind and deleting the disadvantages.
BIBLIOGRAPHY

1. Cavanagh SJ, K Hogan and T Ramgopal. 1995. The assessment of student nurse learning
styles using the Kolb Learning Styles Inventory. Nurse Education Today 15(3): 177-183.
2. KP NEERAJA “ TEXTBOOK ON NURSING EDUCATION”1st edition, Jaypee brothers
medical publishers, New Delhi. pg.403-405, 429-439
3. SANKARNARAYANAN “LEARNING AND TEACHINGMETHODS” , 1 st
edition,Brainfill Publications calical.

4. BTBASAVANTHAPPA “NURSING EDUCATION” -1st edition. Jaypee publications. New


Delhi. pg.413

125
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
DEMONSTRATION METHOD

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

126
THE DEMONSTRATION METHOD
The demonstration method is of utmost importance in the teaching of nursing. The
demonstration method teaches by exhibition and explanation. It is an explanation of a
process. It trains, explains the student in the art of careful observation, which is essential to a
good nurse.
ADVANTAGES:
1. It provides an opportunity for observational learning
2. It commands interest by use of concrete illustrations. The student not only can hear the
explanation, but also can see the procedure or process. As a result, demonstration method
projects a mental image in the student’s mind, which fortifies verbal knowledge
3. The demonstration method has universal appeal because it is understandable to all.
4. The demonstration method is adaptable to both group and individual teaching
5. It activates several senses, it increases learning, because the more senses used, the better the
opportunity for learning.
6. It clarifies the underlying principles by demonstrating the “why” procedure
7. It correlates theory with practice.
8. It has particular reference to student demonstration of procedures already learned.
9. It gives the teachers an opportunity to evaluate the student’s knowledge of a procedure, and
to determine whether reteaching is necessary.
10. It points out that the student must have knowledge and must be able to apply it immediately.
11. It serves as a strong motivational force for the student.
12. Return demonstration by the student under supervision of the teacher provides an opportunity
for well- directed practice before the student must use the procedure on the ward.

USES OF THE DEMONSTRATION METHOD:


 To demonstrate experiment or procedures and the use of experimental equipment in the
laboratory, classroom and the ward.
 To review or revise procedures to meet a special situation or to introduce a new procedure.
 To teach the patient a procedure or treatment which he must carry out in the home
 To demonstrate a procedure at the bedside or in the ward conference room.
 Demonstration of a procedure in its natural setting has more meaning than when carried out
in the artificial environment
 To demonstrate different approaches in establishing rapport with patient’s, so that the most
effective nurse- patient relationship may be established.

ESSENTIAL CHARACTERISTICS OF A GOOD DEMONSTRATION:


 Every step of a well conducted demonstration should be understandable and exemplary of the
best possible procedure, which might be used under the same circumstance
 It should allow sufficient time for reflective and critical thought as a demonstration proceeds.
 Applied principles in demonstration method performed by both the teacher and the student:
 The demonstration should understand the entire procedure before attempting to perform for
others. This sometimes necessitates review before performance.

127
 All equipment should be assembled and pretested before the demonstration takes place. This
saves time and ensures that the apparatus will be in good state.
 Advance knowledge: the group as well as the demonstrator should have advance knowledge
of the general procedure to be followed in the demonstration, its relation to the unit and its
purpose. Otherwise, the students’ attention will not be focused on the procedure, her mind
will be distracted by questions relating to the performance why it is being given, what it
means. Which is to follow to negate any possibility of such distraction. The student should
receive specific instructions about everything from the apparatus to the demonstrator and the
method she will use.
 A positive approach should be used , emphasis should be placed on what to do rather than
what not to do
 Everybody should have a good view of demonstration; precautions should be taken to ensure
all-round comfort.
 Running comments: the person in-charge of demonstration should accompany it with running
comments relative to materials used, amounts necessary processes taking place, and
anticipated results. However the commentary should be limited to essential facts. If an actual
patient is used in the demonstration, explanatory and comments must be regulated
accordingly.
 The setting for the demonstration should be true to life as possible. Demonstration of a
nursing procedureshould be done on a live model where ever possible.
 A discussion period should always follow the demonstration. This affords an opportunity for
reemphasis, questioning, recall, evaluation and summary while the procedure still refresh.
 Mimeographed directions should be distributed before demonstrating a nursing procedure,
this saves continuous dictation on the part of the teacher and writing on the part of the student
 Prompt practice: if the purpose of the demonstration is to teach form for skills, the student
should be given an opportunity to practice the procedure as soon as possible after the
demonstration. Students vary in their ability to learn. The sooner practice takes place after
demonstration, the better the learning.

LECTURE –DEMONSTRATION:-
Lecture – demonstration is a combination of the lecture and the demonstration. Its purpose is
to point out relationships as they occur during a demonstration. These may be in the nature of
properties of matter, explanation of structure or steps of a procedure.
This method is used extensively in teaching sciences and nursing subjects. It measured
factual knowledge only.
THE TELEVISION LECTURE- DEMONSTRTION:
The lecture demonstration is the method used most frequently in t.v teaching, because of the
nature of the medium in which photography and audio tape are combined, and because of
time limitations, the preparations of t.v. lectures is more exacting than the regular classrooms.

128
Scripts have to be prepared and rehearsal, to ensure proper use of time and photography.
Television lecture should not be simply a talking lecture: it should make wide use of all kinds
of illustrative materials.
BIBLIOGRAPHY

1) K.P NEERAJA ; “Text book of nursing education”: Edition 1 st 2003; Jaypee Brothers: New
Delhi; Pg 404-416

2) B.T.BASAVANTHAPPA; “Nursing Education”; Edition 1 st 2003; Jaypee BrothersNew


Delhi; Pg 178-186

3) LORETTA.E.HEIDERKEN; “Teaching & learning” in school of Nursing”; Edition 10 th;


2001; Konark Publication Pvt. Limited, New Delhi; Pg 316-322

129
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
LABORATORY METHOD

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

130
LABORATORY METHOD OF TEACHING
CLINICAL TEACHING
INTRODUCTION
Nursing education is a practice discipline, the students will learn the subject matter by
doing the things and practices the skills. It is a science, as it is based on systematic body of
knowledge and principles of education. It also implies as an art, as it requires professional skills
especially based upon humanitarian approach. Nursing education is having more emphasis on
skill development based upon two aspects i.e., Theory of Nursing and Nursing Practice.
Old nursing curriculum contained only a few hours of teaching and many hours of
practice. Through the intervening years, the amount of nursing knowledge has grown
exponentially and the time allowed to learning by doing has contracted steadily. The clinical
experiences for nursing students will be provided in the places where the actual clients are being
cared for. Since the practice involves human life and handling real life situation, it is essential,
such training and experiences should be supported by good clinical teaching. In clinical practice,
the theoretical knowledge and skills learned receive repeated testing. The student has the
challenge of putting this knowledge and skills gains in real life situation to make them
practitioners in nursing. To bridge the gap between classroom and clinical instruction is, to
expose the student to a series of laboratory stimulation in real settings. Clinical experience
requires the presence of a clinical instructor to guide, reinforce and correct behaviour.
In the nursing curriculum to correlate the subject matter learned in ideal situation (eg: lab
and classroom) to real situation, the clinical instructor organizes the clinical experiences. The
student nurse learns the bedside nursing from older nurse (i.e., senior nursing personnel) in real
field situation.
In classroom teaching there is possibility for careful demonstration of procedures, the
ideal equipment will be collected well in advance and sufficient time was permitted for
developing skills based on theory underlying sound practice under close, strict supervision.
After learning in ideal situation, the student will practice the procedure (by implementing
care to the clients) in real situation utilizing available facilities.
Clinical instruction is directly concerned with teaching students about the care of clients.

Objectives
At the end of the seminar, students should be able to,
 Define laboratory method
 Enumerate the values of laboratory method
 Explain technique of laboratory method of clinical teaching
 Tell purposes of laboratory method of clinical teaching

131
 Enumerate the limitations of laboratory method of clinical teaching
 Enumerate the types of laboratory required for demonstration

TERMINOLOGIES
 LABORATORY: a room or building for scientific experiments
 CULMINATE: reach the highest point
 INVALID: sickly person

LABORATORY METHOD
Introduction:
According to Webster’s New Collegiate Dictionary the laboratory method had its beginnings in
the teaching of chemistry, whereby students went to a workroom for purposes of experimental
study involving testing, analyzing, and preparing chemical substances. This concept of
experimental problem-solving became an integral part of the study of a variety of the science
components of nursing curricula. Soon the nursing components of the curricula became a natural
media for the use of the laboratory method by providing opportunities for students to use a
problem-solving approach to the development of techniques in a controlled learning environment.
In undergraduate, study the early laboratory experiences are usually performances of well-known
actions that, when followed correctly, allow the student to share in reaching a known goal. At
graduate levels the laboratory is the site for exploration and discovery of new knowledge.
Definition: Planned learning activity dealing with original or raw ‘data’ in the solution of
the problems. The term "Original data" includes materials obtained experimentally and any other
materials resulting from laboratory procedure.
Laboratory method is a procedure involving firsthand experience – with primary source
materials, through which the student can acquire psychomotor as well as metal skills.
Explicitly the laboratory method of teaching utilizes a problem-solving approach to
learning that offers students opportunities for supervised, individualized, direct experiences in the
testing and application of previously learned theory and principles and the refinement of specific
skills or complex abilities. The learning experiences are planned so that the theory and laboratory
experiences complement each other. This concept has been expanded to include the clinical
setting in the hospital, the home/ and community health agencies in providing students with
opportunities for using problem-solving techniques to study patients with varying degrees and
kinds of nursing and health problems. Unlike chemical laboratories, patient care settings can
rarely be sufficiently controlled so that the instructor can guarantee the details of the student's
findings. Even the beginning undergraduate student must be prepared to discover something new
about human-experience with health and illness.
Many schools and colleges of nursing have expanded the use of the laboratory method to
include prolonged observational studies within the clinical and community setting. This technique
has proved particularly successful in the study of growth and development patterns and of
interpersonal relationships to gain in understanding of behavioral patterns of children and adults

132
As schools and colleges of nursing modernize their teaching facilities, they are providing
laboratories equipped with one-way viewing devices for observation studies by small groups of
students. The objectives for the observational study vary according to the subject, such as
i. Parent-child interactions;
ii. Growth and development patterns of various age groups;
iii. Demonstrations of group therapy;
iv, Nurse-patient interaction; and
v. Counseling and interviewing patients with specific problems such as long-term illness, death
and dying, drug dependency, unwed parents, or other family crisis situations. The purpose for
using this technique and its variations is to build observation skills by allowing the interaction to
occur in or more natural way than if the observer is seen, and to allow interaction among
observers during the event. Alternating observations of specific situations with participation in
these settings and later student/ teacher interaction can be very effective.
A demonstration of this kind necessitates ethical consideration of the rights of the subjects
being viewed. Prior to the observation session the persons working directly with the patients
should clearly explain the purpose of the demonstration, describe the viewing audience, and
provide sufficient explanation to the subjects to allow each to make an intelligent decision about
his willingness to participate in the observation study. Situations involving patients must be
evaluated on an individualized basis to determine whether the demonstration will help or hinder
their progress.
The demonstration-observation requires careful planning and should be conducted by an
expert in the given subject matter who already has established a rapport with the subjects. For a
productive learning situation, observations should be:
i. Conducted at frequent intervals over a sufficient period time.
ii. evaluated by students in accord with their objectives and their theoretical insights, and
iii. followed by teacher- observerconferences to validate findings, develop new insights regarding
observed responses of patients, discuss observer reactions to the problem, and explore ways that
will lead to better patient understanding.
Variations of this device are frequently used in medicine. One excellent example is
described by Marschak and Call in observations of parental influence on disturbed children. In
another, KubIer-Ross interviewed dying patients to determine their feelings about death and
dying, followed by a seminar with the observers representing a wide range of professional
disciplines to help them understand their own feelings about the patient and provide the support
and understanding needed. Careful study of these techniques furnishes the creative teacher with
numerous ideas regarding ways of adapting this method to selected portions of clinical
nursing.While both teacher and student have definite responsibilities for the effective use of
laboratory method, its creative use is dependent on the teacher- student milieu.
The extent to which the teacher fosters self-direction through cooperative planning, action,
and validation of results is directly proportional to the degree of creative action expressed by the
student.

133
In clinical nursing the use of the laboratory method becomes procedure for providing
students with well-planned, supervised experiences in translating principles of nursing into active,
problem-solving for nursing problems. The laboratory methods serves as the foundation tor
building in those combinations of teaching methods best suited for establishing a structural
framework to bridge the gap between the theoretical study of nursing and the study of patients.
Therefore, the following methods of teaching can be viewed both in terms of their singular uses or
their integral contribution to the total laboratory method.
As stated earlier the term laboratory method has received various definitions and
interpretations and applications in many fields education, Webster used this work tea work room
which is used in teaching physical sciences for testing and doing experiments, "Learning by
doing" is the philosophy of Dewey which is applied to all other sciences.

VALUES
For student it gives best opportunity to experience a learning situation at first hand,
 To use the problem-solving approach to the solution of real problems.
 To translate theory into practice.
 To develop, to test and to apply principles.
 To learn methods of procedures.
 Initiates group work.

Laboratory method helps:

• The student to master the subject.


• To participation of students with his suggestion while planned demonstration by the teacher
helps to learn the procedure accurately.
• To provides concrete and firsthand knowledge of factual materials-
• To make provision for purposeful student activity-
• In training in scientific method and develop scientific attitude.
• To development of laboratory techniques in handling laboratory things.
• Provision of concrete materials which help in imaginary experiences.
• To provide opportunity to work out experiments under guidance.
For teacher :
Provides the teacher an opportunity
 To observe the student in action.
 To assess her worth.
 To correct her mistakes.
 To guide her in promising directions.

134
 A little encouragement or special help at the right moment may intensity interest and
provide the hopes for independent accomplishment in future.

TECHNIQUE
1. Introductory phase
2. Work period
3. Culminating activities.
1. Introductory phase
Involves establishment of objectives and a plan of work.
Teacher preparation :

1. It requires establishment of objectives and plan of work.


2. It motivates the student by presenting problem together with effective method for its solution.
3. Teacher prepares the plan with cooperation of the student considering objectives not wasting
time.
4. Teachers allow time for maximum use of laboratory work.
Discuss objectives or plan of work with the students by means of class discussion:
 To solve a problem.
 To understand a process.
 To develop skill.
 To provide for correlation of lab aspect of the course with class work.
 To give instructions for the students, to proceed without wasting time.
 In thinking over what the students will be doing.

Student preparation : for orientation and motivation achieved through proper instructions and
guidance.
2. The work period
Supervised study activity, in which the student is involved in a first-hand experience designed to
achieve particular objectives by solving the problem.
 It refers to that period when demonstration, experimentation or practice for a skill in a nursing
procedure.
 To ensure an effective work period there must be adequate equipment and facilities including
basic tools.
 There must be adequate supply of specimens and materials.
 There should be sufficient space, light and ventilation. Teacher should plan the entire class for
learning activities, extra-work should be assigned to those who finish, but it should not he special
work, but to get more knowledge in the same work.
3. Culminating activities

135
After the lab work, the class should meet together for discussion of common problems, for the
organizations of findings, for the presentation of the results of individual or group problem
solving activities.

PURPOSES OF LABORATORY METHOD


1. To provide first hand experience with materials or facts in the solution of problem, e.g. Science
Laboratory.
2. To provide experiences with actual situation such as Nursing Laboratory and Hospital Wards.
3. To make student to become skillful in manipulation apparatus, practicing laboratory technique.
4. It helps student to acquire scientific attitudes and scientific approach in problem-solving. It
should be well-organised and well-planned with close coordination, between class and laboratory
work,

LIMITATIONS OF LABORATORY WORK


a. Poor planning and lack of direction of teacher may result in wasting student time, use of
complicated approaches and consumes time. Poor direction causes blind manual without an
conception of the purpose.
b. lack of budget in getting qualitative-laboratory equipment create insecurity in teachers to
operate them. Actually simple equipment is far more comprehensive to the student and they are
within the bonds of school grant. Teacher should remember that these equipment does not result
in effective laboratory work, wise planning and direction of learning activities are more effective
means of inservice learning.

TYPES OF LABORATORY REQUIRED FOR DEMONSTRATION, LEARNING.


RESEARCH, TREATMENT.CLASSROOM, CLINICAL COMMUNITY.
1. Science laboratory.
2- Nutrition laboratory.
3. Nursing art laboratory.
a. Science laboratory: Used to teach science subjects, widely used in physiology, physical
science, chemistry, microbiology for teaching these subjects.
b. Nutrition laboratory: Used to teach the basic knowledge about food and for practice of
cooking food for normals as well as invalids.
c, Nursing art laboratory of demonstration room: it is used for demonstration of some
techniques in nursing. Students may practice to become familiar with nursing procedure

136
CONCLUSION
The laboratory method is the part of study in the education which helps to give proof to the study
which is based on scientific principle.
It helps for clear and comprehensive study which helps in acquiring skill in particular study. The
success of laboratory period is largely depending upon good planning. It is a type of instruction in
which the student learns by actually doing things by himself', It helps to observe and listen to
others doing. Students are made to understand the use of laboratory findings.

Bibliography
1) B.T Basavanthappa, Nursing Education 2nd edition, Jaypee brothers medical publishers. Page
no:536-539
2) K.P neeraja, Text book of Nursing Education, Jaypee brothers medical publishers. Page no:
3) Sankara Narayan B and Sindhu B learning and teaching nursing 3rd edition, page no: 146-151
4) Illustrated oxford dictionary, 1st edition, 2006, published by Dorley Kindersley Ltd

137
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OFNURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
STIMULATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year

138
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

SIMULATION.
Introduction-
A simulation presents learners with a more or less life like situation or model of real world
with which they interact in solving problems from an adopted role perspective.Simulation
allows anticipatory learning (Bastable,2003).Learners are required to assess and interpret the
situation and make decisions based on information provided. Usually conducted in a
laboratory setting, simulation learning allows student to execute a variety of skills including
assessment, psychomotor skills and decision making.
Terminology
Simulation-”Anoperating representation of centralfeatures of reality.”
Simulation is the basis of sensitivity training, sociodrama, and psychodrama. It is a certain
underlying skills to teaching can modified, described and prectised like any other skill.
Simulator- It is deliberately designed to omit certain parts of real operational situation.
Role play- A group of(minimum 4-6)pupilperformed in an artificial environmentan actual or
false role under a teacher guidance.This may provide the student an understanding of a
situation or relationship among real life participants of a social process.
Socio-drama- It seeks to utilize role playing as a means of finding out the situation assigned
to role players.The problem may be false or based on real life situation and the actor is
required to find out an acceptable solution of the situation.
Gaming-the situation involved outcomes affected by decisions made by one or more
decisions.It designed in a small manner which enables chance to affect the outcome.

Definition-
A role playing in which the process of teaching is displayed artificially and effort is made to
practice some important skills of communication through this technique.The pupil teacher
and the students simulate the particular role of a person to an actual life simulation.The whole
programme becomes a trainingin role perception and role playing.
Characteristics of simulation-

139
A good simulation will:
1. Mirror real situation while providing control over extraneous variables or constraints that
might interfere with learning.
2. Provide a mix of experiences that can be replicated for successive learner.
3. Provide a safe environment in which learning has priority over patient care or systems
demands.
4. Focuses on application rather than uncertain recall of knowledge.
5. Provide immediate feedback on performance

Principle-
1. Player take on roles which are representatives of the real world and then make decisions in
response to their assessment of the setting in which they find themselves.
2. The experiences simulated are consequences which related to their decisions and their general
performance.
3. The ‘monitor’ the results of their actions are brought to their actions are brought to reflect
upon the relationship between their own decisions and the resultant consequences.

Types of simulation-
 Written simulation
 Audio-visual simulation
 Model simulation
 Computer simulation.

Activities in simulation-
Activities used in simulation is-
 Role playing,
 Socio-drama,
 Gaming
Values-
 It actively engages learners in application of knowledge and skills in realistic situation.
 Promote high level critical thinking.
 It is useful in promoting transfer of learning from the classroom to clinical setting.
 The controlled setting of the simulation makes it possible to have consistency in learning
experiences from learner to learner.
 Simulation permits application of theory to practice when access to clinical setting is limited
or impossible.
 Enables the student to empathize with real life situation and to learn pre requisite content
before the real exposure.
 Motivate the student by real life situation exciting and interesting.

140
 Provide feedback to learners on consequences of action and decision made.
 Student can learn without harming the patient.

Limitations-
 Simulation cannot be made in all curriculums.
 Simulation are time consuming to develop particularly if they are to mirror realistic situation
 Mechanism for feedback of data may require the use of sophisticated materials.
 Cost development and reproducing a simulation may not be recovered even with repeated
use.
 Simulation is not a convenientfor small children because the mechanism is too difficult for
them to follow.
 It requires extra work preparation of teacher.
 It reduces the seriousness of learning process.
 Minimum of feedback sequence to chose.
 Difficulty in using analytic approach.
 Need many stimulators.
 Learner may not find the simulation relevant to their situation.

Steps of simulation-
1. Selection of role player:-
A small group of 4-5 student teacher is selected.They are assigned different letter in
alphabetic order.The role assignment are rotated within the group to give chance to
everyone.Every member of group gets similar opportunity to be the actor and the observer.
2.Selection and discussing skills:
The skills to be practiced are discussed and the topics that fit in the skill are suggested.One
topic each is selected by groups member for earlier.
3.Planning:-
It has to be decided who starts the conversation and who will top the interaction and when.
4.Deciding and procedure of evaluation:-
How to record the interaction and how to present it. The actor has to decided so that a proper
feedback on his performance could be given.
5.Provided Practical Lesson:-
The role players should be provided re-enforcements on their performance to give them
training for playing their part well.

Application of simulation in teacher training-

141
Crruikshank(1968)has developed a teacher training system which includes:
 The participant is introduced into the situation (if he is a new teacher in school).
 The participants are provided with information and opportunity to solve the problems.
 The participant is exposed to a variety of potential solutions to a particular problem.
 The participant is given the opportunity of observing the results of his chosen line of action.
 The participant is introduced to the situation by a film strips.
 The participant is also given the materials e.g.the rules,regulation,curriculum handbook, and
record card,to familiarize to the topic.
 The participant presented with the role playing situation written and respond to incident as a
response sheet.
 The participant then identified the factors influencing the problem,locates the relevant
information ,suggests appropriate alternative course of action,communicates and implements
a decision.
 Small group discussion.

Summarization-
Simulation is an effective method of teaching where the learner earn the knowledge by using
critical thinking by their active participation.Simulation in some cases or in problem situation
can used for teaching or for evaluation.Both psychomotor and cognitive decision can be
incorporated into computer simulation.It is a very effective method to train new teachers who
used to learn the new behaviourin teaching problems.

Bibliography-
1.Neeraja KP;New text book of nursing education;1 st edition;Jaypee
brotherspublication;2007;P.no-253-288.
2.Basavanthappa BT; Nursing education;1st edition;Jaypee brothers publication;2007;P.no-
365-378
3.Moyer Barbara A.and William Ruth A; Nursing education;1st edition;Jaypee brothers
publication;2008;P.no-192-197.
4.Guilbert JJ;Education handbook for health personnel;1st edition;WHO;2004;

142
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
SEMINAR

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:
143
Seminar
Introduction
The term seminar refers to small group of graduate students engaged in original
research under the guidance of a knowledgeable professor. In general, the seminar consists of
a scientific approach to the study of a selected problem. The seminar method could be
introduced early in the course of the nursing program by utilizing the student’s problem of
adjusting to nursing situation as the focus for developing beginning problem solving skills.
Definition of Seminar
Seminar is a small group discussion that provides an opportunity for knowledge
integration at high level
Seminar is an instructional technique involves generating a situation for a group to
have guided interaction among themselves on a theme which is generally presented to the
group by one or more members.
Purpose of seminar
1. It helps the students to study the subject matters.
2. It helps the students to gain knowledge and skills in library work.
3. It helps the students to develop problem solving skills.
4. It helps the students to participate in methods of scientific analysis and research
procedures.
5. It helps the students to increase their responsibilities.
6. It helps the students to change their attitudes and values.
Types of seminar
On the basis oflevels or organization the seminars are 4 types.
1. Mini-seminar
A seminar organized by to discuss a topic in class is known as mini seminar.
The purpose of the mini-seminar is to train the students for organizing the seminar
and play different role.
2. Main seminar

144
A seminar organized at departmental level or instructional level on a
majortheme. All the students and staff members take part in such seminars.
3. National seminar
A national seminar is organized by an association or organization at national
level. The experts are invited on the theme of the seminar. For example Trends of
education, Non formal education.
4. International seminar
In this seminar the topic or theme of the seminar is very broad, e.g. students
unrest or activisms, innovations in teacher education and examination reforms
Criteria for good seminar
1. Seminar group preferably is limited to 10 to 15 and students with a maximum of 25.
2. Duration should be 1 to 2 hours
3. Teacher is a leader (students can also function as teacher)
4. The topic is presented by the students taking 15 to 20 minute’s time.
5. Used with students in upper division courses than it is with beginners.
6. Effective use of seminar method requires a background of knowledge, skill in library
work.
7. Effectiveness of seminar depends on selection and preparation of the topic.
8. Leader should keep the discussion within the limits of the problem discussed.
9. Members must come prepare with material for presentation and discussion
Technique of seminar (conducting seminar)
1. Define the purpose of the discussion
2. Relate the topic of discussion to the main concept or the objectives to be attained.
3. Direct and focus the discussion on the topic.
4. Helps students express their ideas.
5. Keep the discussion at a high level of interest so that students will listen attentively to
those who are contributing ideas.
6. Plan comments and questions that relate to the subjects and will also help to guide the
discussion.
7. Set time limitation for each person to contribute.
8. Guard against monopoly of the discussion by any member of the seminar.
9. Plan for a summary at intervals during discussion and also at the endand relate the
ideas expressed to the purpose of discussion.

145
10. Have the discussion recorder either by student as a recording.
11. Plan for a teacher and student self-evaluation of the progress made towards the
immediate objectives.

Role of members in seminar


1. Student
2. Teacher
3. Co-ordinator

 Student
1. Expected to do library work.
2. Collect the appropriate relevant content.
3. Content should be clear and well started.
4. Utilizes the AV aids.
5. Should be well prepared before presentation.

 Teacher
1. Help the students to select appropriate topic.
2. Guide the students to select the contents.
3. Suggest the available sources of information.

 Co-ordinator
1. Select problem is solved, analyzed critically evaluate and conducted by
coordinator.
2. The coordinator has to organize the seminars.
Advantages of seminar
1. Seminar helps the student to increase their responsibilities.
2. It gives opportunity to participate in methods of scientific analysis and research
procedures.
3. It helps to do through study on subjects.
4. It helps to improve leader ship qualities.
5. It is an effective method of problem solving.
6. It will help to improve curriculum there by the profession.

146
Disadvantages of seminar
1. It is useful only upper division students as it needs high skills for performing library
work.
2. Members must come prepared with material for presentation and discussion.
3. Proper planning is needed to arrange a seminar.
4. It is time consuming
Bibliography
 Loretta. E. Heidgerken; “Teaching and learning in schools of nursing; principles and
methods”; 3rded; konark publishers pvt. Ltd; delhi; 2003; 475-476

 B.T. Basavanthappa; “ Nursing education; 1st ed; J.P.Brothers medical publishers (p)
Ltd; New delhi; 2003; 385-387

 Elsa sanatombi devi; Manipal manual of nursing education”; 1 st ed; CBS Publication;
New delhi; 2006;206-209

 Sankara Narayana. B and Sindhu. B; “Learning and teaching nursing”; 3rd ed; page no
254-255

 www.encyclopedia.com

147
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
SYMPOSIUM

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
148
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON-
SYMPOSIUM:
i. INTRODUCTION:

The symposium technique is used to realize the higher cognitive and affective
objectives.The nature of the topic should be such that the audience should be interested in the
theme of symposium.

ii. DEFINITION OF SYMPOSIUM:

Symposium is a method of group discussion in which 2 or more persons under the


direction of a chairman present separate speeches which gives several aspects of one
question.

iii. CHARACTERISTICS OF SYMPOSIUM TECHNIQUES:

It has following characteristics:

1. It provides the broad understanding of a topic or a problem.


2. The opportunity is provided to listeners to take decision about the problem.
3. It is used for the higher classes to specific themes and problem
4. It develops the feeling of co-operation and adjustment.
5. It provides the different views on the topic of the symposium.
6. Success depends on personal involvement and degree of preparation.

iv. TECHNIQUES OF SYMPOSIUM:

1. Teacher should plan the program a head of time.


2. Each member of the class as well as student speakers should know the objectives of
the symposium.
3. Each student should prepare on the given or accepted topic.

149
4. The teacher should have pre-conference with each of the student speakers,
5. Either teacher or student may function as a chairman.
6. The symposium starts with the chairman introducing the each speaker and the topic.
7. Then the topic is presented by the student taking 15-20 in time.
8. As a conclusion at the end the chairman gives brief summary of all the speeches and
opens the discussion to the students.
9. Any questions or contributions addressed through the chairman.

v. PURPOSES:

1. To investigate a problem from several point view.


2. To boost students ability to speak in group.

vi. a. ADVANTAGES:

1. It is well suited to a large group or classes.


2. This method helps to discuss broad topics at organization meetings.
3. Gives deeper insight into the topic
4. Directs the students for continuous, independence study.
5. This method can be used in political meetings.

b. DISADVANTAGES:

1. Inadequate opportunity for all students to participate actively.


2. The speech is limited to 15-20 minutes.
3. Limited audience participation
4. Questions and answers are limited to 3-4 minutes
5. Possibility of overlapping of subjects.

vii. LIMITATIONS OF SYMPOSIUM TECHNIQUE

The symposium has following limitations.

1. There is possibility of repetition of the topicbecause every speaker prepares theme as


whole it creates difficulty of understanding to the listeners.

150
2. Listeners are not able to understand theme correctly because different aspects of
theme are presented simultaneously.
3. The listeners remain passive in the symposium because they are not given opportunity
to ask classifications and put questions.
4. Only mature person can make use of this technique
5. Affective objectives are not emphasized properly.
CONCLUSION:

After learning about 2 methods of group discussion i.e seminar and symposium we
trace out the importance of these methods in teaching scenario.These methods helps to
develop self learning abilities and helps to develop co-operation among the group and also
helps to bring out cognitive and affective changes in the higher level of education where it is
essential to learn and develop such an abilities.

BIBLIOGRAPHY:

1. Heidgerken. L. E., “Teaching and learning in school of Nursing”. 3 rd edition, 1990,


Konark publishers Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi Page No. 475, 476 & 482 to 485.

2. Basavantappa.B.T. “Nursing Education”, Ist edition, 2003, Jaypee Broter, EMCA House
23123B, Ansari Road, Dariyaganj, New Delhi – 110002, India, Page No. 385-387, 396-
401.

3. Neeraja.K.P :Text bool of Nursing Education”, Ist Edition, 2003, Japee Brothers Medical
Publishers, Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi, Page No. 279 to 282.

151
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
PANEL DISCUSSION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

152
SUBMITTED ON:

PANEL DISCUSSION
INTRODCTION
All techniques of higher learning require the discussion among the participants. The
discussion provides the equal opportunities in the instructional situation to every participant.
The discussion technique of the learning is based on the modern theory of organisation. The
assumption of this theory is that every member of the organisation has the capacity to initiate
and solve the problem and brings certain attitude and values to the organisation.Thus
interactional technique is the most appropriate in democratic way of life.
ORGIN OF THE PANNEL DISCUSSION TECHNIQUE
The technique at the first time was used by Herry A Ober Street in 1929.He organized a
discussion for small group for definite period for the audience ha also participated the
important question were put by the audience on the topic.The experts tried and answered all
questions and certain points were clarified.Which were not included in the several other
persons had used this technique.This type of panel discussion are organized on television and
radio.
Panel discussion is the discussion in which 4 to 8 qualified personnel sit and discuss the topic
in front of large group or the audience.Panel discussion has a chairperson and 4 to 8
speakers.The success of the panel discussion depend up on the chairperson,he is the one who
has to keep the discussion going on and develop train of thought.
PURPOSE
 To produce the features for the benefit of a large group.
 It is a socialised group conversation in which different points of view are presented.
 Panel discussion stimulus thought and discussion and clarifies thinking.
 The quick exchange of facts,opnion and plan trends to develop more critical attitude
and better judgement.
 It can be helpful to stimulate discussion encouraging thinking and developing group
opnion.

OBJECTIVES OF PANEL DISCUSSION


The following are the main objectives of the technique..

153
 To provide information and new facts.
 To analyze the current problem from different angle.
 To identify the values.
 To organize for mental recreation.

THEORETICAL BASIS OF THE PANEL DISCUSSION


This technique is based on the following principles ..
o It observe the democratic principles of human behaviour.Equal opportunities are
provided to every participant.
o It encourages the active participation with originally and independently.
o It involves the social and physiological principles of group work feeling co-operation
and sympathy and to respect the ideas of others.
o It is based on the modern theory of organisation.The panel discussion organizes
teaching at reflective level which is the most thoughtful and employ independent
thinking of the participents.

THE GROUP DISCUSSION MAY BE OF 2 TYPES


 Public panel discussion.
 Educational panel discussion.
 PUBLIC PANEL DISCUSSION

This type of panel discussion are organized for the common men problems.Three typeof
objectives are achieved by this kinds of discussion.
 To provide factual information regarding current problems.
 To determine the social values.
 To recreate the common men.
The public panel discussion are organized in the television program.The current
problems , unemployment,annual budget,increase in the price of things,jobs
delinking with degrees,emerging diseases etc.
 EDUCATIONAL PANEL DISCUSSION

It is used in educational institutions to provide factual and conceptual knowledge and


clarification of certain principles and theoris.Some times there are organized to find out the
solution to the certain problems.
The following three objectives are achieved by the educational technique,,
 To provide factual information and concept knowledge.
 To give awareness about theories and principles.
 To provide solution of certain problems.

This type of panel discussion are very useful but they are not used in an any institution
even at higher level.The conferences,seminar,symposium and workshops are commonly
organized.These techniques provide the situation for group discussion but of for

154
different types.The situation of panel discussion is usually of autocratic where as the
other techniques have democratic situation of group discussions.

PROCEDURE OF PANEL DISCUSSION


A panel discussion consist of 4 types of persons.It means 4 roles are played in
organizing panel discussion.
i. Instructor
ii. Moderator
iii. Panellists
iv. Audience
1. INSTRUCTOR

In the panel discussion most important role is of instructor.It is the responsibility of instructor
how,where and when panel discussion will be organized.The schedule of panel discussion is
prepared by him,some times he has to plan rehearsal also.
2. MODERATOR

In the discussion moderator has tokeep the discussion on theme and encourages the
interaction among the members.He has to summarize and high light the discussion more
often.The moderator must have the mastry on the theme or problem of the discussion.
3. PANELLISTS

There are 4 to 10 panellists in the discussion.The members of the panellist in semi circle
before the audience.The moderator sits in the middle of the panellist .The panellist must have
the mastery on the theme of the discussion.
4. AUDIENCE

After the panel discussion ,audience are allowed to participate and seek clarification.They can
present their points of view and their experiences regarding the theme or problem,the
panellist attempt to answer the questions of the audience.In some situations moderator also
tries to answer the question.
PANEL DISCUSSION TECHNIQUE
o Other chairperson and 4 to 8 speakers sit in front of the large audience.
o Chairperson opens the meeting ,welcome the group and then invites the panel
speakers to present their view.
o In panel discussion there is no specific agenda no order of speaking and no set of
speeches .
o The chairperson can interact in the form of questions and simple statement related to
topic to any of the speaker without any order form.

155
o At the end ,after exploration of many aspects of subject by speaker the chairperson
opens the discussion for audience by inviting them to participate in discussion.

USES OF PANEL DISCUSSION


The instructional technique has the following advantages,,
 This technique encourages social learning.
 The higher cognitive and affective objectives are achieved .
 It is used to develop the ability of problem solving and logical thinking.
 It develops the interests and right type and attitude towards problem.
 It develops the capacity to respect others idea and feelings and ability of tolerance.
 It provides the opportunity of assimilation of theme and content.

CHARECTIRISTICS OF PANEL DISCUSSION


The followings are the main characteristics of panel discussion technique..
 It is used to college and university level to organize teaching at reflective level.
 It develops the ability of problem solving.
 It provides the opportunity to understand nature problem theme and giving their point
of view logically.
 It develops right type of attitude and ability totolerate anti ideas of others.
 It develops the ability of creative thinking and to criticize the theme.
 It develops the manners of putting questions and answering questions.

LIMITATIONS OF PANEL DISCUSSION TECHNIQUE


The following are the limitations of this technique..
o There are chances to deviate from tem at time of discussion,hence the purpose
of the panel discussion technique is not achieved.
o Some members demonstrate the discussion and do not provide the
oppurtunities to participate others in discussion.
o Ther is possibility to split the group into2 sub groups ie. For and against the
theme.It does not maintain the conductive situation of learning.
o If the panellists belong to different groups,it may not create appropriate
learning situation.

SUGGETIONS FOR ORGANIZING PANEL DISCUSSION


The following suggestions should be taken into consideration to organize effective panel
discussion..
 There should be rehearsal before the actual panel discussion.

156
 The moderator should be matured person and have the full understanding of theme or
problems.He should have to control over the situation.
 The seating arrangement for the panellistsand audience shouldbe such that every one
should be equaldistence.They can observe each other.
 The moderator should encourage the discussion on the points and which may lead to
constructive aspect of the problem.He should encourage the constructive discussion
among panellists and audience.

CONCLUSION
The discussion provides the equal opportunities in the instructional situation to every
participant.The success of the panel discussion depend upon the activeparticipation of the
members.All techniques of higher learning require the discussion among participents.

JOURNEL ABSTRACT

Barkan A, Bronstein MD, Bruno OD, Cob A, Espinosa-de-los-Monteros AL,


GadelhaMR, Garavito G, Guitelman M, Mangupli R, Mercado M, Portocarrero L,
Sheppard M.

The University of Michigan, Ann Arbor, MI, USA.

ABSTRACT

Although there are international guidelines orienting physicians on how to manage patients
with acromegaly, such guidelines should be adapted for use in distinct regions of the world.
A panel of neuroendocrinologists convened in Mexico City in August of 2007 to discuss
specific considerations in Latin America. Of major discussion was the laboratory evaluation
of acromegaly, which requires the use of appropriate tests and the adoption of local
institutional standards. As a general rule to ensure diagnosis, the patient's GH level during an
oral glucose tolerance test and IGF-1 level should be evaluated. Furthermore, to guide
treatment decisions, both GH and IGF-1 assessments are required. The treatment of patients
with acromegaly in Latin America is influenced by local issues of cost, availability and
expertise of pituitary neurosurgeons, which should dictate therapeutic choices. Such
treatment has undergone profound changes because of the introduction of effective medical
interventions that may be used after surgical debulking or as first-line medical therapy in
selected cases. Surgical resection remains the mainstay of therapy for small pituitary
adenomas (microadenomas), potentially resectable macroadenomas and invasive adenomas
causing visual defects. Radiotherapy may be indicated in selected cases when no disease
control is achieved despite optimal surgical debulking and medical therapy, when there is no
access to somatostatin analogues, or when local issues of cost preclude other therapies. Since
not all the diagnostic tools and treatment options are available in all Latin American

157
countries, physicians need to adapt their clinical management decisions to the available local
resources and therapeutic options.

Kipen H, Rich D, Huang W, Zhu T, Wang G, Hu M, Lu SE, Ohman-Strickland P, Zhu


P, Wang Y, Zhang JJ.

University of Medicine and Dentistry of New Jersey - School of Public Health and Robert
Wood Johnson Medical School, Piscataway, New Jersey, USA. kipen@eohsi.rutgers.edu

ABSTRACT

Ambient air pollution has been linked to cardiovascular and respiratory morbidity and
mortality in epidemiology studies. Frequently, oxidative and nitrosative stress are
hypothesized to mediate these pollution effects, however precise mechanisms remain unclear.
This paper describes the methodology for a major panel study to examine air pollution effects
on these and other mechanistic pathways. The study took place during the drastic air
pollution changes accompanying the 2008 Olympics in Beijing, China. After a general
description of air pollution health effects, we provide a discussion of panel studies and
describe the unique features of this study that make it likely to provide compelling results.
This study should lead to a clearer and more precise definition of the role of oxidative and
nitrosative stress, as well as other mechanisms, in determining acute morbidity and mortality
from air pollution exposure.

BIBLIOGRAPHY
I. K.P.NEERAJA,A Text Book of Nursing Education.New Delhi,Jaypee Bros.
Publications 2005,pg;282-283.
II. B.T.BASVANTHAPPA,Nursing Education,New Delhi.Jaypee Bros. Publications
2004,pg;403-405.
III. K.PARK,Text Book Of Preventive And Social Medicine,M/sBanarsidas Bhanot
Publishers 2002.pg;628.
IV. BUTTER B.K,KUMARI NEELAM,A Text Book Of Communication And
Education Technology Jalandhar.S.VIKAS And Co,pg;255-256.

......................................................................................................................................................

158
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
PROBLEM BASED LEARNING

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh

159
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

PROBLEM-BASED LEARNING (PBL)


The goal of nursing education is to prepare nurses who are competent and caring.Developing
competent practitioners is the concern and responsibility of all nurses (Andrew & Jones
1986 ).To develop competent nurses, they require to be prepared in a way that they can use
problem-solving and clinical reasoning skills in their practice.Problem-based learning (PBL)
is effective in enhancing the problem-solving abilities and clinical reasoning skills of
students.

Problem-based learning is an increasingly popular educational strategy.It has now been


applied to many areas like nursing, space, science, community health.

PBL can be best defined as the individualized learning that results from the processes
involved in working toward the solution or resolution of a problem(Barrows, HS and
Tamblyn).1.What is problem-based learning?

Barrows ( 1985) describes " The basic outline of PBL process is :encountering the problem
first, problem-solving with clinical skills and identifying learning needs in an interactive
process, self-study, applying newly gained knowledge to the problem and summarizing what
has been learned".

2.What are the advantages of problem-based learning?

a. Development of an effective and efficient clinical reasoning process

b.Increased retention of data

c. Development of effective self-directed learning skills

d. Increased student-faculty interaction.

e. Increased Motivation for learning 

160
3.How is the tutorial process conducted for problem-based learning?

The problem-based strategy using the tutorial process is conducted in two sessions i.e.
brainstorming and regrouping.Students meet in small groups of six to eight, with a "tutor"
who is the facilitator.One student takes the role of the group leader who coordinates the
sessions activities.Another student takes the role of the scribe, whose task is to keep track of
the group's process on the board.

Patient problems are presented in a variety of formats like carefully designed printed format,
computer format, video clippings, etc.

The tutorial group begins with the brainstorming session.The second session is the
regrouping session.

Let us see the steps of the tutorial process as presented in Fig.

I.First Session :Brainstorming

i.Clarify unfamiliar terms and concepts

ii. Define the problems/issues

iii. Discuss / analyse the issues identified

iv. Summarize the discussions

v. Decide what new information is required to deal with the problem

vi. Pursue learning objectives individually or together (self-directed learning )

II.Second Session:Regrouping

vii. Resource critique, re-analysis of the problem in the light of new information acquired,
debriefing and evaluation.

When a new group of randomly assigned students meet for the first time, an introduction is
done.The students are asked to introduce themselves to the others in the group.The others in
the group are invited to ask questions to each student or comment on anything he or she
might have said.This helps students to establish who they are and their own importance as an
individual in the group.This will help to enhance the group process as problems of members
identifying their own importance in the group through this, inappropriate behavior is avoided.

Conclusion:

PBL is a very useful method of teaching learning. Research evidence shows this.

161
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
ROLE PLAY

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
162
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

ROLE PLAY
INTRODUCTION
As a teaching – learning form, role playing is useful for developing communication skills
involving emotion and encouraging groups work. Many teachers confuse role playing and
drama. Although that are similar, they are also very distinct in styles. Perhaps the most
strategic point of difference is handling of the subject matter, genune drama requires a scripts
whereas role playing retains the element of spontaneous or at least extemporaneous reaction.
OBJECTIVES
at the end of ht class the group will able to
 Define role play
 List out the purpose of role play
 Explain the value of role play
 Enumerate the principle of role play
 Describe the process of role play

TERMINOLOGY
Empathy – the ability to share some one else feelings or experiences by imaging what it
would be like in the situation.
briefing--The act of giving in advance specific instructions or information.
Consensus – a general accepted opinion or decision among a group of people.
Insight – the ability to have a clear, deep and something sudden understanding of a
complicated problem or situation.
Definition

163
An educational technique in which people spontaneously act out problems of human relations
and analyse the enactment with the help of other role players and observers
History and origin of role play
The term role play was originally coined in the 1920s by Jacob. L. Morens, a Veinese
psychiatrist who surmised patient gained more knowledge from exploring their problems by
acting them out than talking about them. When the practice become popular in business and
educational institutions twenty years later the problem solving aspect shifted towards the
learning of a professional role for later real life assumption.“ what astronaut do in their
practice for mission; what pilot do in learning to navigate flight simulators; what thousands of
soldiers do in the course of military exercises its all role playing. Teaching.Salespersons to
deal with customer, teacher, doctors to interview patients, teaching teacher to deal with
different situation.
Purpose of role playing in nursing education
 To develop specific skill
 To develop a situation for analyse
 To developing understanding of points of views of others
 Increasing students insight into typical ways of dealing
 Length of the role play will make the situation clear and awareness can be created in
the mind of the students

Values of role playing


 The actors really tries to feel the part tries to feel the part of the character he is
portraying and the audience gets some kind of emotional involvement.
 It is enjoyed by people who do it.
 It also fulfills some of the very basic principles of the teaching- learning process such
as learner involvement and intrinsic motivation.
 The involvement of the role playing participants can create both an emotional and
intellectual attachment to the subject matter at hand. If a skillful teacher has
accurately matched the situation to the needs of his group, the solving of realistic life
problems can be expected.
 Individual may develop new skills for dealing with problems in human relations.

Principles of role play


 As a teaching techniques , role playing is based on the philosophy that meanings
are in people, not in words or symbols.
 Creating a teaching situation which can lead to the change of self concepts
requires a distinct organizational pattern
 Should be flexible
 Should be stimulant to think and should not be an escaped from disciplines of
learning
 Requires rehearsal is an important feature to produce effective outcome and an
audience to help players interpret their role.

164
 Should be able to analyse and evaluate which is an essential element to gain
maximum learning benefits.
 Should be done for a brief period

Types of role playing


1.sociodrama
It deals with the interactions of people with other individuals or groups e.g. mother, nurse,
leader etc. it always involves situations of more than one person and deals with problems that
a majority of the group face in executing their roles.
Socio-drama concerns itself with group issues. It is a group action methodin which
participants act out an agreed upon social situation spontaneouslyand discover alternative
ways of dealing with that problem. It concernsitself with those aspects of roles that we share
with others and helpspeople to express their thoughts and feelings, solve problems, and
clarifyvalues. Unlike simple role playing, socio-drama employs many specifictechniques to
deepen and broaden the action of the enactment.
2.psychodrama
Practiced in group setting, mainly concerned with the unique needs and problems of a
particular individual. It should not be attempted except under guidance of a trained therapist.
 A psychotherapeutic technique in which people are assigned roles to be played
spontaneously within a dramatic context devised by a therapist in order to understand the
behavior of people with whom they have difficult interactions.

Steps in role playing


1. Select a problem for role playing, it may be done by:
- The group leader , who recognizes a problem that can be used effectively and
suggests it to the group.
- The group can list problems on the black board and decide which problem they
want to work out.
2. Set up the role playing scene;
- The group should come to a clear agreement on the chief objectives to be realized
in the role play.
- The group work together with the leader decide
 What character to be involved
 The attitudes and personalities of the characters.
 The setting of the story
 The point on which the story should begin

- The leader may brief the players on the situation which they have decided they
want to portray. The leader may arbitrarily assign individuals to take the various
roles or members may volunteers to play the different roles

165
- The player’s lines are never fixed but for just what the character thinks his
character would say in a given situation.
3. Getting underway in the role playing.
- The player should be given sometimes to warm up or to get the feeling of the roles
they are about to play. Specific names , other than their own should be used to
help them to get into their roles.
4. Part the group players
Those members not involved in the actual role playing act as a observers. They may
be assigned to watch particular role players or to look for important cues, which come
out of role playing
5. Cutting the role playing
The leader may cut at point where enough action has already occurred to provide a
basis for discussion
6. After the role playing is cut
- Get immediate reaction of the role players.
- Use in the discussion the role name of each person so that the player will not feel
he is being evaluated
- When role players succeed in really projecting themselves into the roles assigned
them, they usually give during the discussion valuable insight into the problem
and provide additional material for discussion
7. The audience observers.
- The comments of the audience observers constitute the least of the role playing as a
discussion technique
- how did the group think the role was handle
- what are the good point of the action.
- what were the poor points or omission.

8. the role playing scene


The role might be played by different people so that these might be a comparison of the
behaviour of different people.
9.Caution in the use of role playing
- use role play only if when it will be useful not just for the sake of doing it.
- be careful about the interpersonal relationshipwithin the group
- avoid un covering deep seated personal problems, which require professional help.
10 .Summarize
The leader sums up with the groupthe chief point or principle which have come out in the
playing and the comment of the observerwhich follows.

Process of role play


1. Preparation

166
a) Define the problem
b) Create readiness for the roles
c) Established the situation
d) Cast the character
e) Brief and warm up
f) Consider the training
2. Playing
a) Acting
b) Stopping
c) Involving the audience
d) Analysing the discussion
e) Evaluating

Specificallyrole playing can be used to help student


1. develop real communication skills in leadership, interviewing and social interaction
and obtain constructive feed back from peers.
2. Developed sensitivity to another’s feeling by having the opportunity to put oneself in
another’s place.
3. Develop skill in group problem solving e.g. the group work as a whole to developed
the problem of concern to the group. To developed the situation, to identify critical
issues and come to some mutual agreement.
4. Develop ability to observed and analyse situations
5. Practice selected behaviour in a real life situations without the stress of making
mistake.

Role playing helps the teacher


In the teaching – learning situation, it provides her with the opportunity to
a) Note the individual student needs by observing and analysing her needs in a simulated
real life situation
b) Assist the student in meeting her own needs by either giving her or encouraging group
members to give her on the spot suggestion
c) Encourage independent thinking and action by steping aside or giving indirect
guidance for emphasis is on the students helping themselves.

Disadvantage
 Role playing is a means not an end
 It requires expert guidance and leadership
 Sometimes participants may feel threatened
 Strongly dependent on student’s imagination
 Times consuming in group readiness
 Requires willing volunteers who would be ready to act out

167
CONCLUSION
Hence role playing is relatively a new technique where people act out spontaneously to relate
human reactions and analyse the enactment.
JOURNAL ABSTRACT
1.Marvin C. Alkin conducted study on ‘use of role- play in teaching evaluation”. This
paper describes the use of role-play in creating an experiential learning environment for
graduate students enrolled in a comparative evaluation theory and/or an evaluation
procedures course. Role-play exercises have been designed for each course that increase
student involvement in the learning process, which promotes a deeper understanding of and
engagement in course content. The specific exercises used, which are described in detail,
require students to think beyond the words they read—to learn by doing in a safe
environment.

BIBILIOGRAPHY
1. B.T. Basavanthappa, “Nursing Education”Jaypee brother medical publisher(p)Lt.
page number
2. Elsa Sanatombi Devi, “manipal Mannual of Nursing Education”, CBS publisher and
distributers, page numbers 213- 219
3. K.P Neerja, “Text Book O Nursing Education” jaypee publication. Page number263-
266
4. Dr, A.V, “Instructional Aids for teaching of Nursing”, OmagalAchi College of
nursing
5. Marvin C. Alkin,“ The Use of Role-Play in Teaching Evaluation”, University of
California, Los Angeles, UCLA Educ, P.O. Box 951521, 3026 MH, Los Angeles

168
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
COMPUTER ASSISTED
LEARNING

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
169
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

COMPUTER ASSISTED LEARNING


INTRODUCTION TO EDUCATIONAL TECHNOLOGIES

This document introduces the principal technologies that make up the field of learning
technology and so is necessarily brief.

What is Educational Technology?


E-learning, Educational Technology, Information and Communication Technology,
Computer Aided Learning, Computer Aided Assessment, Computer Mediated
Communication - these terms and others are bandied about in recent years but what do
they mean and why should you invest any time in getting to know more about them?

'Technology' in its broadest terms could include overhead projectors and even pen and
paper but, in the context of Learning Technology, it is generally understood that we are
talking about technologies that have arrived with the 'Information Revolution' i.e. those
associated with computers.

For those of us who have been around for a bit, this seems to be the promise that is
never fulfilled. There has been talk about how computers and other technologies would
revolutionize the nature of learning for several decades now. We can all point to isolated
examples of success but probably also point to numerous examples of wasted effort. So what
has changed?

Computer Assisted Learning

The term Computer Assisted Learning (CAL) covers a range of computer-based


packages, which aim to provide interactive instruction usually in a specific subject area, and
many predate the Internet. These can range from sophisticated and expensive commercial
packages to applications developed by projects in other educational institutions or national
initiatives to simple solutions developed by individuals with no funding or support to tackle a
very local problem. The amount of time and money invested in development is high and
partly because of the very subject specific nature of the education market as well as the very
personalised nature of the teaching process - particularly at FE and HE level - means that

170
commercial success is difficult to achieve and work done in one subject area rarely transfers
to others subject areas.

In general, the use of computers in education through CAL has been sporadic a great
deal of effort was expended with little general impact. Many of those academics that took
part in that earlier crusade are now cynical about the effectiveness of computers in teaching.

There are still good reasons to use CAL rather than Internet based technologies. CAL
is run either straight from a CD or floppy disk drive, or over a local network so the constraint
of the internet - slow download times for multimedia materials may not apply. This, coupled
with the fact that CAL technology has been around a bit longer, means that CAL packages
have the potential to offer more advanced, interactive, multimedia learning experiences than
it is currently reasonable to expect from the Web. This has been changing as Web
technologies develop and bandwidths improve but there are currently many things that can
only be achieved with CAL rather than the Web and CAL has been an integral part of the
curriculum in many departments at Warwick for some time.

Internet Technologies

The principle difference - 'What has changed?' is that when we talk about interaction
in CAL packages, we are usually talking about interacting with computer programs. Internet
based technologies are more about interaction between people and in our Postmodernist
world, we know that learning is largely a social activity and even the most well thought out
multimedia interactive materials lack the flexibility of human interaction.

The use of the term Information and Communication Technology (ICT) rather than
Information Technology (IT) emphasises this change. Computers now facilitate
communication between people as well as between people and programs or people and data.

Those who were involved in developing CAL packages in earlier decades usually
point out that there is nothing new under the sun - which the lessons we are learning today
about using the Internet for teaching were learnt before. Others would go further and point
out that distance education with print has also covered a lot of the ground before and it is only
because most lecturers are only accustomed to the face to face setting that they stumble into
well mapped pitfalls when beginning to use internet technologies to teach. All of this is true
but it is also true that using the Internet for teaching brings new challenges and necessitates
the development of additional teaching skills.

The arrival of the Internet made communication between machines much easier and a
number of open protocols and applications were developed to make use of this. Of these,
Email was the forerunner and there can be few academics and students that do not have
access to this now. Email has its limitations and it was the World Wide Web that really
brought the world of networked computers to the general public. The open standards of many
of the technologies and the ease with which anyone could publish information encouraged
participation by all and we need to remember what is about these technologies that makes
them attractive when we try to deploy them for education. However, initially, a relatively
small number of University lecturers adopted it for a range of teaching purposes but even

171
fewer did more than post information about their courses or actual lecture notes - usually not
modified in any way to take advantage of the strengths of the media such as hypertext.

One of the strengths and principle attractions of the Web is that it can provide
authoring access to anybody and this is quite different from the one-way nature of education
through CAL or any other media that predated it. The fact that the technology facilitates this
does not of course mean that it will take place but then this is true of any educational forum.

While far from needing programming skills, it still takes a certain amount of
technophilia to publish a Web page. Creating them is trivial but actually publishing them can
be tedious if the institution has not provided a simple means to do so.

This is all about information rather than teaching and learning and it soon becomes
obvious to any treading this path that you cannot take the people out of the learning equation
entirely. Learning is about interaction and interaction with information alone is not enough.

We can group the Web technologies available for education roughly into 3 areas,
outlined below:

1. Digital Learning Resources


2. Computer Mediated Communication (CMC)
3. Computer Aided Assessment (CAA)

They tend to be adopted in that order with novice online tutors first placing their
lecture notes online 'as is' then restructuring the materials to take better advantage of the
media and perhaps augmenting it with resources not possible in print such as video or
creating interactive materials.

1. Digital learning resources

This could range from simply placing Word document on the Web for your students
to download and print or making your PowerPoint presentations available after a lecture to
creating Web pages that make better use of the media to streamed digital video and simple
interactive CAL-like programs.

2. Computer Mediated Communication (CMC)

CMC can include any means by which individuals and groups use the Internet to 'talk'
to each other.

CMC can either be synchronous (exchanges take place in 'real time') or asynchronous
(messages are posted up at any time, and read and responded to by other users also at times
which suit them; in other words, users do not have to be online at the same time, as they do
with synchronous exchanges). Email, mailing lists, Usenet and computer conferencing are all
asynchronous, while IRC, Internet telephony and videoconferencing all take place
synchronously. All of these types of CMC are now available through the Web i.e. through a
standard Web browser.

172
Which type of CMC you use will depend on what kind of discussion you want to take
place? Each has their strengths and weaknesses both in terms of technical constraints and the
type of interaction that they encourage.

The main technologies, which fall into this category, include:

Email- the most popular Internet tool, used to exchange messages between individuals

Mailing lists - which use email to enable communication among groups of people.
Individuals send emails to the list email address and receive a copy of all emails sent to that
address

Usenet newsgroup - a separate Internet system which allows users to read and contribute to
global special-interest 'newsgroups'; the number of newsgroup topics is vast, and subjects
range from the very dry to the totally bizarre

Computer conferencing - (sometimes also known as 'discussion boards' or more accurately


'threaded discussion lists') which enables groups of people to hold discussions by reading and
posting text messages on a computer system. The advantages over mailing lists are that the
messages are archived and the structure of the discussion is also recorded. Computer
conferencing is widely used to support learning, and within the educational context is
generally what people mean when they talk about 'CMC'

Internet Relay Chat (IRC)- an Internet system which allows users to chat 'live' (in real time)
using text or audio Internet telephony, a way of using the Internet as an alternative to the
main telephone network; currently in its teething phase, though exciting in that it has the
potential to reduce the cost of calling long-distance to that of a local call

Videoconferencing - a means by which small groups of geographically distant people can


hold discussions in real time, during which they are able to hear and see each other and share
various other types of data.

Hybrid systems - systems such as Web Board combine threaded discussion lists, IRC and
email lists allowing users to switch easily between the two depending on the nature of the
discussion. See also Yahoo Groups which is a free online service allowing you to set up a
Web based email discussion list with optional forwarding to and replies from your normal
email account. It also offers a facility to share documents and images.

3. Computer Aided Assessment (CAA)

The next step is to provide a way for students to assess their own progress and
understanding of the material. Without human feedback or very sophisticated artificial
intelligence, this usually means some form of objective test delivered as an online quiz.
Because it is objective and the possible responses are known, the feedback can also be
automated. Students can therefore receive immediate feedback. This use of CAA for self-

173
diagnosis / formative assessment can be quick to set up and if used wisely can provide
valuable feedback on the effectiveness of the course to the course tutor.

Integrating educational technologies in learning

While each of these technologies has its strengths and weaknesses, it is when they are
combined that we start to see their true potential. This was one of the driving forces behind
the arrival of Virtual Learning Environments (VLEs) although it has to be said that few of the
commercial products make serious efforts to enable this, focusing more on the administration
of learning rather than on the learning itself. VLEs attempt to 'wrap up' the three technologies
discussed above into online course objects that are password protected. Usually, the
sophistication of the tools within a VLE is less than that of an equivalent stand-alone tool; the
trade off is in the ease of use, integration of technologies and single point of authentication.
Whether you use a VLE or a combination of stand-alone tools really depends on what you are
trying to achieve.

E-learning technologies in the classroom

The changes have not all been happening on the Internet or with students sitting in
computer labs using CAL packages. Out in the classrooms and lecture theatres, data
projectors have being introduced and packages like PowerPoint are being used to present
directly through a computer rather than to create and print overhead projector transparencies.
The setups have often been unreliable and under supported and there has been a lack of
technical confidence among lecturers and it is only within the last few years that this has
started to change. Other presentation technologies such as electronic whiteboards, audience
feedback systems and videoconferencing facilities are beginning to appear in teaching spaces
and these will all require careful thought in integrating them into teaching practice.

Where is all this leading?

"Where do you see yourself 5 years from now?"

At the crest of the wave, the pace of change is overwhelming and there is a great
temptation (for some) to try to ride that wave and that can look very impressive... for a while.
Slightly behind the wave, you begin to see the really effective approaches beginning to take
hold and that is perhaps where you need to look to see long-term trends and truly useful
approaches. One of these trends has been the popularity of VLEs and MLEs. You can read
more about these in other documents on this site but essentially the drive is to integrate all
computer based activity in Universities and so make it as easy to engage in e-learning as is to
send an email. Making systems easy to use usually carries the penalty that they are limited in
scope. For those starting out in e-learning, this will not matter, as the technology provided is
likely to be more than you need. As you develop as an eTeacher, however, you will identify
needs, perhaps ones very specific to you, that the system was not designed for. If you are not
to let the technology determine your teaching rather than the other way around, you must
learn to communicate your needs to the providers of the systems and they must learn to listen.

174
The tools and environments that are available to lecturers are still determined more by
service issues than academic ones. Some enthusiastic individuals and departments are
impatient with central provision and perhaps will always provide their own facilities but the
majority will wait to see what central services provide. The advent of VLEs in recent years
and the formation of eLab at Warwick have largely been in response to this need for easy and
easily supported provision of core tools. It should go without saying that the tools will not
teach for you but obviously they need to be in place. The main reason that the decisions have
to date been made by central services is that there is that academics are still largely
uninformed. Hopefully as they become users of the technologies they will provide more input
into the design of these tools.

One thing that will almost certainly not happen is that good teachers will be replaced
by automated systems or even, in my opinion, that face to face education can be entirely
replaced but you can be sure that learning technology will find its way into your teaching.

New media, new skills

Whatever sorts of technologies you decide to use, you will need to develop new skills
and recognise that your students also need to develop new skills. There is much from your
existing teaching practice that applies just as well in this new environment although
sometimes those practices successful as they might be have been developed without
conscious thought and need to be teased out and analysed before you can apply them in a new
context. One of the biggest benefits of using learning technology is that it forces us to do this
and this can enhance all of your teaching. Primarily, it is less easy to think and adapt on the
fly than it is in a traditional face-to-face environment.

What is available at Warwick?

Many departments have been engaged in small and larger ways in the use of learning
technology for some time and there may be activity and expertise in your own department
that you are unaware of so ask around.

In terms of central provision, the arrival of eLab has begun to coordinate the provision
of tools and eLab is currently engaged in developing some core tools in-house to better serve
our local needs.

As to advice on how to use these tools, the Educational Technology group within the
Centre for Academic Practice (CAP-ET) is a good place to start. They can advise you on
training, funding, tools and good practice as well as put you in touch with others pursuing
similar projects locally and nationwide. The ETUG mailing list is a forum for discussing
learning technology issues at Warwick as well as acting as a notice board for learning
technology events. Interactions is an online learning technology journal produced by CAP-ET
3 times a year and features local innovations.

Where do I start?

175
The first impression that most people have is that this is all very interesting but somewhat
overwhelming. So the best place to start is to talk to somebody who has some experience in
applying the technologies in teaching and an overview both of what is available and what
works. There are a number of groups within the University currently engaged in developing
tools and helping academics to use them. Other CAP-ET Guides will always point you to
individuals that can tell you more about specific technologies but for a more general
discussion do contact the author of this document in CAP-ET.

Bibliography

Graham Lewis graham.lewis@warwick.ac.uk


Centre for Academic Practice, University Of Warwick, United Kingdom.

KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &


RESEARCH

Clinical Teaching
Method :

SUBJECT :NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
176
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &


RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
NURING CLINICS

SUBJECT :NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
177
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

178
NURSING CLINIC
There are different strategies of teaching. Broadly they are classified into:

1. Autocrat – It is content centered and dominated by teacher.

2. Democratic – student centered and democratically organized.

Clinical teaching is type of group conference in which a patient(s) is observed and


studied, discussed, demonstrated and directed toward improvement in nursing care.

In nursing various method or clinical teaching are used. Nursing clinic is most popular
method in it.

Nursing clinic or patient presentation utilizes the presence of selected patient as its
focus for group discussion.

Purposes: -

1. Improvement in nursing care.


2. Sharpen student’s observation & interviewing skill.
3. See relation between patient’s health problem & his resources for coping.
Following points are involved in effective nursing clinic.
1. Well planed
2. Determining the purpose
3. Selection of patient (to whom students have given care)
4. Securing patient consent
5. Selecting the setting to be used (bed side or conference room).
6. Providing advance preparation of the student in terms of bio data of patient, the
purpose, place, date, time & any specific instruction regarding preparation for
discussion.
7. Group discussion is important activity in it. The group discussion consists of 3 phases.

i. Introduction
ii. Patient centered discussion
iii.The evaluation discussion

179
1. INTRODUCTORY PHASE.
It is for

Know patients back ground

Presenting nursing care situation

Understand purpose of discussion significant observations, types of
questions to be asked, collect needed information.
II. PATIENT CENTERED DISCUSSION
Here only patient is presented. Student will ask simple questions to patient.
Opportunities are given to patient to verbalize their needed & how they see their particular
problems.Some times demonstrating a particular nursing care is sufficient for meeting the
purpose. (If patient appears unresponsive or tired close the discussion. Even though the
purpose may not have been -accomplished)
III.EVALUATION DISCUSSION.
It offers an excellent opportunity for the students to evaluate.
 The patients behaviour
 Ability to solve his own problems.
 Available resources.
And also student can be evaluated in terms of observation & interviewing skill.
Ability to solve problem-solving techniques.
Discussion should be summarized in terms of application of background knowledge to the
given nursing care problem.
 Goals accomplished
 Provision of follow up on comparison between student’s view of the patient’s
problems and patients views on his problems.
In nursing clinic nursing aspects are presented and discussed. (Physical Mental and social,
spiritual).
Also discussed brief medical history and therapeutics.
CONCLUSION:
Nursing clinics are valuable as a teaching-learning device because activities are related to
patient. It develops power of observation and initial thinking on problem solving approach.
All students apply their knowledge, skill and attitude to the subject of nursing clinic. It keeps
to meet situations presented by patient.
BIBLIOGRAPHY:
1. Basavanthappa BT, Nursing education, 1st Edition, New Delhi. Jaypee Brothers, 2003.
2. Bhatia K.K. Principles and practice of nursing education 1 sted, Kanpur printing press,
1997.
3. Tores, Educational Technology, 1st ed. Annual publication, 1992.

180
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
CASE STUDY

SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

181
CASESTUDY
Case study is an analysis of the nursing problems of an individual patients which
grows out of his diagnosis his physical and mental conditiontreatment which are influenced
by personality and socio economic development
CRETERIA FOR GOOD CASESTUDY
1. Continuity
2. Completeness of data
3. Validity of data
4. Confidential recording
5. Analysis and scientific synthesis

SOURCES
1. Personal documentaldiaries
2. History of previous illness
3. Health team members
4. Related persons
5. Official records
6. Subject(patients)

STEPTS
A. Selection of the case :

The level of knowledge of the students is taken into considerations while assigning
patients. Selection of cases should be based on the level of care needed.
B. Collection of data
Its divided into 2 aspects
 Subjective data:The information which is given by patients
 Objective data: data which are documented through observation investigation
or intervention
C. Examination
Examination of the patients included anthropometric measures biological measures
clinical examination and dietary examination history relevant to present andpast
condition is collected using the relevant formants.
D. Diagnosis and identification of casual factor
The nursing process includes assessment of the patients forming nursing diagnosis on
the basis of assessment planning the care and implementation.
E. Evaluation and follow up
The effectiveness of care rendered is identified.

182
TYPES OF CASE STUDY
1. ORALCASE STUDY
2. WRITTEN CASE STUDY:
It’s a form and presentation
 Case study which is in written form in generally
consideredbest to record in narrative form
 Some form of outline should be used to guide the beginners.
 The older student may use an outline as a guide but should be
permitted to use his or her own initiative and creative ability in
writing her study
 Oral case study is one which is presented by one or
morestudent in the form of verbal records to the clinical
instructor.

ADVANTAGES
 Its useful to the students in planning and providing comprenhsivenursing care to the
patients.
 It permit the student to provide care and follow up the services for 3-5 days
continuously.
 Helps in developing clinical knowledge (book andpatient picture)
 It provides for individual differences of the study

DISADVANTAGES
 Time consuming and a costly method
 It leaves no opportunity once the study is completed to branch out an in
corporate new idea.
 It requires a great deal of time to rewrite into an acceptable form.

CASE ANALYSIS
Introduction
The seminal and role playing methods particularly lend themselves to
discussion involving care analysis . This method of teaching refers to group
analysis. This method of teaching refers to group analysis of case history for the
purpose of developing skill in reflective thinking by defining problems to do
solved discussing relevant data and various sides of the issue and verifying face
to make judgment.
Definition

183
A concrete care of analysis and discussion by a group of the students
under the relationship of the instructor sufficient information is presented to the
students to make judgment of problem or situation in case .
Learning as focused on discussion - making regarding concrete problems
related to real life situation , but the problems can be increased more objectively
because the students are not personally involved .
Use of this method requires a completely of thinking and action on the
face of the students and the teacher, students are required to study the case
history and to extensive reading as advance preparation for the required analysis
and decision - making discussion.
They are faced with the task of analyzing significant factors elevated
from a maze of possible, ideas and charged with the responsibility for providing
appropriate case history material and must be skillful as the use of the seminar
technique . Keeping the discussion moving without forcing a preconceived on
the group . Yet ready to summarize the ongoing discussion as necessary to keep
I centered on the problem .
The creative teacher in clinical nursing could utilize this method of
teaching nurse patient behavior and leadership skills .But to use if successfully
the teacher must meetthe following requisition.
• Careful study of the teaching involved.
• Extensive exploration of case histories that are realistic , with in the realin
of knowledge of the group and contain enough information to permit
analysis and decision making.
• Careful preparation of the group participants regarding the purpose of the
study, the technique based and needful advance preparation for a given
case .
• Because of its limited use in the basis nursing curriculum , a detailed
description of this technique has not been included .

184
Conclusion
Case analysis help to find out the problem of patient through the proper
history , physical examination and the medical management . It helps the group
members management. It helps the group members (participants ) of case
analysis to provide the discussion and problem solving approach to the
particular health problem.

185
PROCESS RECORDING
It is a tool used in teaching , counseling and psychiatry field . Process
recording also known as inter personal relation recording , patient - nurse
interaction interviews .
The importance of the therapeutic nurse - patient relationship. The
emotional support required by patients. The identification and the understanding
of patient emotional and physical needs and the method s of assisting patients to
workout solution to other health and related problems are being recognized .
Nursing students are continuously attempting to cope with the wide range
of human experience . Often they are found which arise with in the
interpersonal process.
Process recording is being utilized as a tool to help them in assisting
nursing students to acquire understanding of competence in IPR .
Definition
Walkets , defines 'A Visit for purpose s of bringing out the interplay
between the nurse and the patient in relation to the objectives of the unit.
Purposes
Used as a data collection instrument for
• Teaching.
• Self evaluation.
• Therapeutic assessment.
Elements of communication studied through process recording are;
• Conservational skills.
• Skills in interviewing for a specific purpose.
• Verbal and non verbal uses to the patient needs.
• Skills in meeting the patient needs.
• Awareness of behavior in relation to the patient.
• Control of behavior as a result of awareness.
• Recurrent themes in the nurse - patient interaction.

186
• Skills in verbal interaction.
• Interaction patterns.
• General experiences out of which the interactionpattern are developed.

Technique of process recording


• Preparingthe student for process recording.
• Recording nurse - patient interaction.
• Evaluating the nurse - patient interaction.
PROCESS RECORDING
The following process recording was clone with a 49-year-okl black male
recovering from an amputation. The client was interviewed at a short term, in-
patient rehabilitation hospital. This was the fourth contact with the client.
CONTENT - NARRATIVE STUDENT FEELINGS
S: Hi Mr. Chandran He seems happy to see me. Felt good.
C: Hi, C'mon over and have a scat. -
Mr. Chandran pulled a chair over
closer to him. I sat down in the chair.
S: You're a hard man to find. You I'm trying to be funny to break the ice.
weren't in your room again today. I'm still a hit unsure of our rapport

C: I was in there a little while ago. I


come in here lo ha c a cigarette.
W: Well, I'm glad I found you. How
are you today?
C: I'm doing good.
S: How is your leg? Is it draining?
C: Yes, it's draining a little. It's much
better than last week.

187
S: Was it draining more last week?
C: Yes, it was draining more.
S: Did you go to PT today?
C: Yes, I went two times today.
S: How did it go?
C: Good, but two times ain't enough. Good for him! I'm glad he's
That's only an hour a day. I'd rather be advocating for himself. It would be
home than sitting around here if I'm great if more clients did it!
only getting an hour. Now I'm going
to go to a group to walk.
S: So that will be another Vi hour of
PT then?
C: Yes.
S: Will that be enough?
C: I think so.
S: If it gets you too tired or you have I hope he does.
chest pains again, you should tell
Christine.
C: Yes, I will.
S: Did you go to OT this morning?
C: Yes. At 11 o'clock.
S: 11 o'clock? I thought it was at 10
o'clock, right after PT?
C: Well today they done it different.
S: Maybe that's because we had
rounds this morning.
C: I don't know. There was a pause in What should I bring up next? How
the conversation and then Mr. should I lead into asking him about

188
Chandran began shaking his head. C: his story?
That lady in the kitchen made me so
mad though.
S: The Occupational Therapist made Mad? This doesn't seem like someone
you mad? who gets mad easily.
C: No, that lady in the cafeteria made
me mail.
S: What happened? What will happen if I ask? I have to
ask.
C: I go down there to get 4 or 5 or 2 As soon as he said '“jungle”', 1 knew
dollars in change. Today I go down it was a racial issue. I wanted him to
there and she looked at me. Then I tell me that though.
asked her for change of a dollar and
she said no. She told me I have to go
ask the nursing station. But she
looked at me like I just come out of
the jungle.
S: The jungle?
C: Jungle.
S: So you were upset because of the
way she looked at you?
C: I know that look. I seen that look a I knew what was coming next. I
hundred times before. She's lucky I started to feel anxious and wondered
need a leg because if I didn't need a how to handle what was seeming
leg then I would have telled her just increasingly inevitable.
what I thinked.
S: What do you think? I knew I had to ask.
Mr. Chandran paused and looked

189
away.
C: I don't want to say what I think. I knew he wanted to say more. I
Pause decided to just wait. Okay, he said it.
C: She be looking at me like I'm a I guess we need to explore this. Oh
nigger. I know what she be thinking. boy, he's really getting angry!
You can tell the difference between
that look and any other look.
S: So you felt like she was looking at
you a certain way because you're
black.
C: These men was in a car next to This story was somewhat confusing,
mine then passed me. They thought but I got the basic point. I was
their car was better than mine. So I surprised that his relatively harmless
passed them then pulled in front of looking man who had been so
them and stopped my car. pleasant to me could have such a past.
To tip it off, I'm a white middle class
female social worker.
They called me a nigger. I took off Wow! He thinks it's okay when
my work boot and broke up the someone calls
windshield. Cut them up real bad. It him a nigger to act violently against
was 1984. Then I spent 1 year in the them. This is against what I believe
county jail. I don't care though in; violence breeds violence.
because 1 done right. I was raised up
that you say what you think no matter
what. Don't matter none- you got to
say what you think.
S: It sounds like being called a nigger 11c probably thinks I'm full of it. I
really upsets you and I can imagine feel like there's something “right” to
why. I don't think I'd care to be called
190
names. say and this isn't it.
C: I been called a nigger, coon, I am uncomfortable hearing these
burrheadand all that. I don't care but words. I feel empathy towards the
nobody going to look at me like that. client.
S: Did you get your change Mr.
Chandran?
C: I got it at the nurse's station. I ain't I really hope that this wasn't the case.
never going back to that kitchen. That I don't know if it's true. There are a
lady ain't never going to see me again. number of other possibilities. How
From now on, Charles going to bring can I bring them up without sounding
me change or I get it from the nurse's like I'm sticking up for her'.'
station.
S: Okay. Mr. Chandran I understand
that you think Carol looked at you a
certain way, but can I suggest that
maybe it wasn't you? It might be that
she was having a bad day or that she
was angry at someone else.
C: Then she don't have to take it out
on me.
S: You're right. She shouldn't have
taken it out on you.
C: She wasn't having no bad day. She He thinks I don't understand. I feel
was polite to the white man in front of like 1 should be able to communicate
me. I'm so mad by blood is boiling. better with him.
S: She's given you change before
though with no problem?
C: You don't know. You aren't 47 He's right. 1 don't know. I wonder

191
years old. You were raised up in a how lie would react if I just talk
different time than me. completely open.
S: You're absolutely right Mr. I want to say something that is
Chandran, I'm not your age. I'm not genuine. I'm feeling very genuine.
black and I didn't grow up in the
South. It woujd be foolish of me to
pretend that I know what it's like.
The only thing that I can tell you is
that I'm sorry it happened.
C: Well, that's okay. Nothing you can
do.
S: I'm very uncomfortable with this I am uncomfortable! I hope I don't
Mr. Chandran. I'm obviously white sound patronizing. I don't know what
and 1 hope that you don't think I look else to say about this.
at you that way.
C: I know that you don't look at me I believe that he means this. He's
that way. There's bad people in all trying to make me feel okay about
colors. Bad blacks and bad whites too. this. Now I feci like I dumped on him.
Don't matter. All colors got bad in Oh, thank God!
'em. Nothing you can do about it. Mr.
Chandran is paged over the
loudspeaker to come to PT. He looks
at his watch.
C: Must be time for me to go.
S: Yes, it's 2:30. Uncomfortable silence, I don't know
Mr. Chandran and I ride down to PT. what
S: Okay Mr. Chandran, this wasn't to say, so I say nothing.
what I had in mind for us to do today, Might as well be honest. I am glad

192
but I'm glad we talked. I'm glad you that he
told me what was on your mind. told me. I feel like he trusts me at
some
level and maybe 1 helped by letting
him
vent.
C: That's okay. Do you have to go He doesn't want me to go!
now?
S: Yes, I have to go meet with my
supervisor.
C: Okay.
S: I'll be back on Friday. I'll come
back and see you then.
C: Yes, okay.
S: Good. Take care Mr. Chandran. Whew! I'm glad that's over. I wonder
how he's feeling. He seems okay with
the conversation. I wonder if there's
somethingIcouldhave done differently
so that I could be more
surethatIactedinthe best professional
capacity.

GROUP HEALTH TEACHING


Introduction

193
Health is the concern of everyone for everyone . Health teaching is
therefore are important area of communication. The term 'health teaching' is
often used synonymously with health education, which itself suggests
“Outwards and Downwards” communication of knowledge. Health education is
the foundation of preventive health care.
Functions ofhealthTeaching
Health Teaching has to cater to the following needs .
a. Information
b. Education
c. Motivation
d. Persuasion
e. Counseling
f. Raising morals
g. Health development
h. Organization
Alma Ata declaration
The declaration of Alma-Ata (1978) by emphasizing the needs for
“individual and community participation” gave a new meaning and direction to
the practice of health education. The dynamic definition of health education is
new as follows.
A process aimed at encouraging people to want to be healthy to know
how to stay healthy , to do what they can individually and collectively to
maintain health and to seek when needed .
The moderate concept of health teaching emphasis on health behavior and
related action of people.
Integrated in to the educational system and must have the young
population as the target.The contents of health teaching to the group or
community must include :
1) Human Biology .

194
2) Nutrition .
3) Hygiene
4) Family tree
5) Disease prevention and control
6) Mental health
7) Prevention of accidents
8) Use of health service
PRACTICE OF HEALTH TEACHING
Educational material should be designed to focus attention to provide new
knowledge, to facilitate interpersonal and group discussion and to reinforce.
CONCEPTS OF HEALTH TEACHING
The scope of health teaching extends beyond the conventional health
model sector. It cover every aspects of family and individual and group or
community health reinforce orcommunity health reinforce or clarify prior
knowledge and behavior.
1. Audio visual aids
No health teaching can be effective without audio visual aids. They help
to simplify unfamiliar concepts ; bring about understanding about word facts ;
reinforce learning by appealing to more than one sense , and provide a dynamic
way of avoiding monotony .
2. Methods in Health Communication
Since health teaching has a limited impact when directed from general from
general, most of the information must be.

CONCLUSION

195
Group health teaching is more than more exchange of information. It is a
process necessary to same way for desire changes in human behavior and
informed individual and community participation.
BIBLIOGRAPHY
Park. K., (2005), “PARK'S TEXT BOOK OF PREVENTIVE AND SOCIAL
MEDICINE” 18m edition, BanarsidarBhanot Publishers, Jabalpur, India ,Page
No/o30 - 650 .

196
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

Preparation of
AV Aids
SUBJECT :NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

197
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON SLIDE AND


SLIDE PROJECTOR
SUBJECT :NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

SLIDES AND SLIDE PROJECTOR


198
INTRODUCTION

A slide projector is a specialized projector, which has been designed to be used with
slides. Slides are small transparencies mounted in sturdy frames, which are ideally suited to
magnification and projection, since they have a very high resolution and a resulting high
image quality. The use of slide projectors is in decline, as other projection methods have
become more popular.

At one time, the slide projector was the presentation method of choice when visual
media needed to be presented to a large group. Because slides can be difficult to work with,
other projection methods such as projectors designed to link to computers or read
presentations from CDs and DVDs have become more commonplace.

OBJECTIVES

At the end of the class, student will be able to:

 Define slides and slide projector


 List various types of slides and slide projector
 List purpose of using slides and slide projector
 Describe steps in using a slide projector
 Point out different parts of a slide projector
 Explain the care of slides
 List the advantages and disadvantages of using a slide projector

TERMINOLOGIES

 Slide: a mounted transparency, typically one placed in a projector for viewing on


a screen
 Projector: an object that is used to project rays of light, esp. an apparatus with a
system of lenses for projecting slides or film onto a screen.
 Cellophane: A thin transparent wrapping material made from viscose.
 Silhouette: The dark shape and outline of someone or something visible against a
lighter background, esp. in dim light.
 Etched: cut or carve (a text or design) on a surface

CONTENT

199
SLIDES

DEFINITION

SLIDE

 A slide is a still transparency of 70 mm, 35 mm or 6 mm size, which is optically


enlarged and projected on a screen as a real image. This helps to make the
abstractions concrete.

MEASUREMENT

The common sizes of slides used for teaching purposes are:

 2” X 2” (50mm X 50mm)
 31/4 “X 4” (80mm X 100mm)

TYPES OF SLIDES

There are two types of slides:

1. Photographic slides
2. Handmade slides

Handmade slides can be of different types:

 Marker Ink slides


 Cellophane slides
 Silhouette slides
 Etched Glass slides

PREPARATION OF SLIDES

I. Photographic slides:
The object is photographed and from the negative or microphotograph a positive is
made whether on film or printed on a slide glass plate.
Eg. Anatomy, microbiology slides.
II. Handmade slides:

200
1. Marker Ink slides:
 A marker ink slides can be made using a glass piece.
 Clean the glass piece properly and draw the diagram or write the material clearly
with a fine tip marker pen or Indian ink.
2. Cellophane slides:
 Cutouts from colored cellophane are pasted on a glass piece and another glass
piece is placed over it and the two are taped together.
3. Silhouette slides:
 Small cutouts from paper are pasted on a glass piece with adhesive.
 Because of the contrast between the dark picture and transparency background,
these slides give the clearest image.
4. Etched glass slides:
 Clean a glass piece thoroughly and rinse it with kerosene oil.
 Draw the diagram with crayon or glass marking pencil or cover the glass piece
with smoke from a burning mustard oil lamp and then etch out the diagram with a
sharp needle.
 Cover the etched glass piece with another glass piece and tape them together.

EVALUATION OF SLIDES:

Different set of standards has been developed for the evaluation of slides. They are:

1. Truth
Evaluate the following:
 Does the picture tell the truth?
 Are the facts recorded accurately?
 Are they free from distortion or illusion?
2. Photographic quality
Evaluate the following:
 Is the photography good?
 Are the lines sharp?
 Do the main facts stand out clearly in the midst of other details?
 Is the material up-to-date?

201
3. Relevancy
Evaluate if:
 The picture pertains to and contributes meaningful content to the topic under
discussion.
4. Relative size of items
Evaluate if:
 The picture includes items or elements of known size so that the observer may secure a
correct idea of the unknown elements.
5. Mechanical qualities
Evaluate if:
 The slide is free from blemishes, smears, stains, scratches, blurs etc
 Slide is substantially bound
 It is free from thumb marks.

CARE OF SLIDES

The glass slides are breakable and hence it requires care in handling and storage.

 The slides should be stored vertically in cardboard trays or right size.


 The tray should be covered to protect the slides from dust.
 The slides should be catalogued subject wise if there are large number of slides.

SLIDE PROJECTOR

DEFINITION

The slide projector is an optical instrument used for projecting still pictures to an
audience by

use of a powerful light source passing through a lens system and focusing on the screen.

PRINCIPLE

 When an illuminated object (slide) is placed between the focus and twice the
focus of a convex lens, it produces and enlarged real image beyond twice the
focus on the other side of lens.

202
PURPOSES

 To introduce material to the student. Slides of unfamiliar objects add meaning to


the lesson. For e.g. Pictures of equipment such as resuscitator, which is difficult
to have in a classroom, gives the student a better idea of what it looks like rather
than a simple verbal explanation.
 To accompany a lecture for illustration purposes. When lecturing on pathologic
tumors, slides of tumors will add greatly to the students understanding.
 To present a well organized summary of a unit with appropriate illustrations. If a
unit covers a topic of reproduction, pictures of the various stages in the
development of the embryo are appropriate.
 To illustrate points the student should look for while doing and assignment.
Bacteriology slides show what to expect when looking at a slide under a
microscope.
 To portray outstanding symptoms of various diseases such as skin conditions in
dermatology.
 To give the student an opportunity to prepare a talk while presenting slides. This
creates an opportunity for student self-expression as well as for mastering the
subject matter.

PARTS OF A SLIDE PROJECTOR

1. Metal case having a concave reflector


2. A light source – 500 to 1000 watts straight filament bulb
3. A set of convex lenses called condenser to illuminate the slide to be projected.
4. A slidable set of convex lenses that focus the image of the slide on the screen.
5. Small exhaust or cooling fan to blow off the excess heat.
6. Slide frame behind the objective lens.

TYPES OF SLIDE PROJECTORS

1. Hanimette slide projector:


This type of slide projector is suitable for small group viewing.
2. Kodak Carousel slide projector:
This is a unique magazine system. The lamp is 24V, 250W tungsten halogen. The
advantage of this type is:

203
 Remote control of slides
 Focusing
 This helps in effective presentation.

In this type of projectors, the slides operate in the horizontal position on top of the
projector.

STEPS IN USING A COMMON SLIDE PROJECTOR

 Place the slide projector on a rigid and stable table.


 Place the screen at an appropriate place so that the whole class can see it.
 Insert the slide carrier in its place behind the object lens tube after opening the
tube
 Mount a slide on its carrier.
 Insert the projector cord plug into the wall socket.
 Darken the room in which projection is to be carried out.
 Switch the cooling fan first and then the projection bulb.
 Focus the image on the screen sharply by moving or sliding objective lens
forward and backward.
 Show the slide and explain your subject matter with its aid. Remove the slide
after this.
 Insert the next slide to get to the next frame.
 Present the slides sequentially.
 After the lesson, switch off the bulb first then the cooling fan. Unplug the slide
projector and store it back in its box.

PREPARATION FOR A SLIDE SHOW

 Prepare and plan for making an effective slide show.


 Collect all the available slides and checks them thoroughly using a viewer or
placing them against a lighted lamp.
 Choose the slides, which are relevant to the lesson.

204
 Arrange the chosen slide in a proper sequence and write a brief introductory note
for each slide.
 Set up the slide projector in a room, which can be darkened, for the slide show.
Place the screen in the room and adjust the objective lens for proper focus.
 Make proper seating arrangement for students within an area covering a sector of
60 from the center of the screen.

CHECKLIST FOR EFFECTIVE USE OF THE SLIDE PROJECTOR

A. BEFORE THE LESSON


 Position screen for maximum visibility.
 Align projector so that required size of the image is obtained.
 Adjust the focus using a slide to get a sharp image.
 Attach the remote lead if required and position control near teacher’s position.
 Check blackout. If curtains are used, close them at the beginning of lesson and
put on overhead lights.
 Insert slides if automatic projector standing behind the projector and turning each
slide upside down before inserting into magazine.
 If more than one sequence or slides is required during the lesson, insert an
exposed black slide between each sequence to prevent continually switching the
projector off and on.

B. DURING THE LESSON


 Switch off lights when showing the slides.
 Use a pointer on the screen.
 Use remote control lead to refocus and change slides.

C. AFTER THE LESSON


 Remove all slides, including the last one in the “well”
 Don’t move projector until the lamp is cool.

205
POINTS TO BE REMEMBERED

 Slides should be carefully incorporated into the verbal presentation with the
objectives of illustrating and clarifying particular ideas rather than providing a
major focus.
 Media should only be used when they enhance understanding of the subject
matter.
 AV aids should be clearly visible and audible.
 Too much information on a slide distracts rather than clarifies.

ADVANTAGES

 Easy to use
 Relatively inexpensive
 Slides are compact and easy to store
 They are easy to update and reorganize to fit changing class needs
 The teacher can control the speed of slide presentation so that each frame can be
discussed for the desired length of time.
 Convenient aid for making classroom teaching interesting.
 Can promote student participation in learning.
 Can be used effectively to introduce, review and test a lesson.
 Saves time for teacher as she does not have to draw or prepare graphic aids for
the lesson.
 It is also easy to back up to previous frames of a pertinent question arises.
 Slide projectors are light in weight and easy to carry.
 Required simple skills to operate.
 A remote control extension allows teachers to walk around or stand in front of the
class and still control the slides.

DISADVANTAGES

 Slides can easily get dirty and smudged with finger prints because they are small.
 Slides can get bent inside a malfunctioning projector.

206
 Requires projection equipment, mains, electricity or batteries to operate.
 Can easily get damaged
 Projector bulbs do not last long and are expensive to replace.
 The size of slide tray is not standardized. Hence a teacher’s personal slide tray
may not fit the projectors used in a particular institution.
 No face to face contact with audience since room usually darkened
 Not effective in a fully-lighted room
 No ability to modify slides and sequence during presentations
 Longer lead time (2 to 5 days) for preparation of slides

MICROPROJECTOR

These are also slide projectors designed to project the microfil slides or microscopic
slides to a group of students simultaneously.

Advantages:

 It reduces cost of instruction as it eliminates the expensive individual microscopes


for each student to view the slides.
 Enlargement on screen is quite big for students to see and get more details.
 It assures the instructor that students understand what is required of them, which
is not possible with viewing slides individually though microscopes.

CONCLUSION

Slide projectors were common in the 1950s to the 1970s as a form of entertainment;
family members and friends would gather to view slideshows. In-home photographic slides
and slide projectors now have largely been replaced by low cost paper prints, digital cameras,
DVD media, video display monitors and video projectors.

207
BIBLIOGRAPHY

BOOKS:

1. B. Sankaranarayan., B. Sindhu., “LEARNING AND TEACHING NURSING”., Ist


Edition., Brainfill Publication.
2. BT Basavanthappa., “NURSING EDUCATION”., Ist Edition., Jaypee Publication.
3. Elsa Sanatombi Devi., “MANIPAL MANUAL OF NURSING EDUCATION”., Ist
Edition., CBS Publication.
4. Loretta E Heidgerken., “TEACHING AND LEARNING IN SCHOOLS OF
NURSING”., 3rd Edition., Konark Publishers Pvt. Ltd.

JOURNAL ABSTRACT AVAILABLE AT:

1. Dee FR, Lehman JM, Consoer D, Leaven T, Cohen MB. Implementation of virtual
microscope slides in the annual pathobiology of cancer workshop laboratory. Hum
Pathol. 2003 May;34(5):430-6.
2. Fleming DE, Mauriello SM, McKaig RG, Ludlow JB. A comparison of slide/audiotape
and Web-based instructional formats for teaching normal intraoral radiographic
anatomy. J Dent Hyg. 2003 Winter;77(1):27-35.

208
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
OVER HEAD PROJECTOR

SUBJECT :NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON-

209
OVER HEAD PROJECTOR (OHP)

Over head projector is a type of visual projector aids. The over head projector is a
very vital teaching aid which has made projection so simple and easy that it has replaced a
chalkboard completely in many classrooms.
An over head projector produces images on a screen behind and over the head of the
teacher. An over projector can be used in soft light conditions and enables the students to take
down notes while viewing the projections on the screen.
OBJECTIVES
After the completion of the class, the student will have knowledge about
 Over head projector
 How to use an OHP and its parts
 Advantages and disadvantages of OHP
 Functioning of OHP
 Precautions to be taken while using OHP

TERMINOLOGIES
1. TRANSLUCENT: allowing the light to pass through.
2. TRANSPARENCY: being transparent.
3. TRANSPARENT: that can be clearly seen through.
4. CELLOPHANE: transparent wrapping material made from wood pulp.

OHP TRANSPARENCIES
A transparency is really a very large slide usually 7x7 or 10x10 (25x25cm) in size.
The transparency pertains broadly to a single image that is seen by means of a light passing
through it.
It is usually clear, but has portions, which are not clear but permit light to pass
through. These portions are termed translucent.
The term transparency also called as visual project, is usually given to those materials,
which are projected in the OHP.
PARTS OF OHP
An over head projector consists of a metal box with a 1000 watt bulb and a concave
reflector, a condenser lens illuminates the transparency placed on the glass sheet on the top of
the box.
There is a vertical rod by the side of the box which carry an objective convex lens
parallel to the transparency and a plane mirror to reflect the image on the screen.

210
The objective lens and mirror combination can be slided up and down the rod with
rock and pinion arrangement operated by the knob.
The movement of the objective lens and mirror focuses the image properly on the
screen.
There is also a small exhaust or cooling fan in the over head projector to blow out the
excess heat produced by the bulb.
METHODS OF USING OHP
While using the over head projector one should proceed in the following steps:
1. Place the over head projector on a stable table with the objective lens facing the
screen behind the teacher.
2. Put the cord plug into a power wall socket. Switch on the blower first and then the
bulb.
3. Place the acetate or cellophane transparency on the glass top.
4. Move the objective lens and mirror assembly up and down to get the image in focus
on the screen.
5. Explain about the material on the transparency sitting behind the over head projector
with a small pointer.
6. The projector usually gets very hot in spite of cooling arrangement. Switch of the bulb
after every 5-10 min of use, keeping blower on for some time.

MATERIALS THAT CAN BE PROJECTED


Apart from transparency, other transparent objects like protractors, plastic shapes,
plastic numbers and letters, drawings, small templates, coloured cellophane etc may be put to
variety of uses in an over head visual projector.

METHODS OF PREPARING TRANSPARENCIES


1. Hand drawn transparency:the acetate sheet is placed over the paper and kept in
position by paper clips or pins. The sketch is carefully traced using ruling pen or
marker pen. Watercolour markers and brush pens also can be used. But it can be
easily erased. Hence the surface carrying an impression should be protected by
keeping another acetate sheet over it.
2. Photographic transparency/printed transparency: employing reflex printing,
where some complicated drawings are pictured.

ADVANTAGES OF OHP
1. An head projector has a large aperture and can project a large number of instructional
materials like diagrams, charts, maps, graphs after those are transferred on the
transparencies.
2. The use of OHP can be quite cheap as transparencies can be used repeatedly.

211
3. In the OHP the teacher can write directly with a marker pen and the writing is directly
projected on the screen.
4. With an over head projector the teacher is always facing the students keeping an eye
contact which is not possible with other projection equipments.
5. An over head projector can be used in a normally lighted room, the students can take
down notes and the teacher facing the class can observe the students reaction and
strengthens his presentation.
6. An OHP can be easily used with other visual aids also without the fuss of switching
on and off the room lights as is the case with other projection aids.
7. The verbal disclosure of the teacher can be supported with illustrations as he can
directly sketch the diagram; write key points and concepts on the transparency with
his students in front.
8. If an acetate sheet is used, the teacher can prepare the whole study course before hand
and give accurate notes to his students.
9. With the OHP, an enlarged image can be obtained with quite a less distance, therefore
the students can sit close to the teacher and this produces a better rapport.
10. As an over head projector can be used in the normal class room, the difficulty of
ventilation does not hamper teaching which in the case with the other projection
equipments that are used in a classroom.
11. The operation of over head projector is convenient as it involves switching and
focussing only.

DISADVANTAGES
1. Power consumption is high.
2. Apparatus is costly.
3. Requires maintenance.

CARE TO BE TAKEN OR PRECAUTIONS


1. The apparatus should be kept covered all the time, so that no dust gets deposited on its
lenses and the bulb, which may make the image dull on the screen.
2. Don’t keep the bulb on for longer time, as it can over heat the projector and thus
damage the acetate transparencies.
3. Switch of the bulb after every 5-10 min of use keeping blower on for some time.
4. Do not shift the OHP when bulb is on, as the filament of the bulb may break if jerked
during shifting.
5. Do not keep the projector too low, as it will distort the image. This is called as key
stoning.
6. Clean with soft, moistened flannel cloth.
7. Don’t clean when the apparatus is warm.
8. Avoid making finger prints on lamp house, mirror on the projection head, the
projection lamp, lens and glass heat filter.

212
CHECKLIST FOR EFFECTIVE USE OF OVER HEAD PROJECTOR
A. Before the lesson:
 Position screen so that everyone can see it, with lover border levels with head
of audience.
 If available, use tilting screen to avoid key stone effect.
 Obtain correct image size by moving machine backward or forward in relation
to screen.
 Focus image sharply.
 Place masking sheet to hand.
 Place transparencies in correct order..
 Check table and head of dust, and wipe if necessary.
 Ensure that a spare lamp is available in case of blowout.

B. During the lesson:


 Switch off when:
a. Placing transparency on table.
b. Removing transparencies.
c. Point has been explained.
 Use pointer to indicate, preferably on the transparency rather than screen.avoid
use of fingers.
 Use mask to reveal points in a step by step fashion when required.
C. After the lesson:
 Do not move the machine while lamp is hot, and never disconnect from mains
supply while the fan is operating.

CONCLUSION
OHP is a type of visual projected aid. The over head projector is a very vital teaching
aid which has made projections so simple and easy that it has replaced a chalkboard
completely in many class rooms.
OHP is incomplete without transparencies. Apart from transparency, other transparent
objects like protractors, plastic numbers and plastic numbers can be projected using a over
head projector.
OHP has more advantages compared to few disadvantages. Care should be taken
while using over head projectors.
Thus the use of OHP has made teaching more easy and attractive compared to
chalkboard teaching.
JOURNAL ABSTRACT
1. Elizabeth Greenfield., “over head projector: new technology boots old”.,
technological horizons in education., volume 18, 1990

Abstract: one of the old standbys of virtually every instructor or trainer is the over head
projector. OHP’s have around since the early 1960’s, serving to increase subject

213
understanding by visually representing concrete applications and abstract concepts. With
the advent of computer, one may think that this tried and true product will have suffered a
decline in use.

2. Micheal essex-lopresti., “use an over head projector”., informa health care., volume1,
issue1, jan 1979, page no 9-15

Abstract: the over head projector is a very useful adjunct to teaching aids. It is easy to
operate, flexible and the lecturer can work it himself while facing the audience.
Transparencies can be produced quickly and simply, and since they are very large enough
to be studied without viewing equipment, sets of transparencies can be kept in libraries
for the benefits of students revising particular subjects.
BIBLIOGRAPHY
1. B.T Basavanthappa., “NURSING EDUCATION”., 1ST edition., jaypee publications
New Delhi., page no 425-428, 453-455.
2. Loretta E. Heidgerken., “TEACHING AND LEARNING IN SCHOOL OF
NURSING” ., 3rd edition., konark publication private limited.
3. B Sankaranarayan., B Sindhy., “LEARING AND TEACHING NURSING”.,1ST
Edition., brainfill publications.
4. K.P Neeraja., “TEXTBOOK OF NURSING EDUCATION”.,jaypee brothers
medical publications private limited New Delhi., page no 231-237.
5. Dr A.V Raman., “INSTRUMENTAL AIDS FOR TEACHING AND LEARNING
OF NURSING”.,Omayalachi college of nursing., page no 55-58.

214
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
MODELS

SUBJECT :NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON-

215
MODELS:
Unlike charts and posters, models are three-dimensional visual aids. Models provide
representation of the real things in all respects except size and shape.
Models may be simple (static), sectional or working. Simple models such as a thermocol
model of a cell show different parts of the cell, but these parts cannot be separated. In a sectional
model of an eye, for example, all the parts of an eye in the model can be separated, shown to the
students and can be replaced. You may like to list some sectional models in subjects like
Science, Geography, etc.
Working models are used to show actual operation or working of a real object. A working
model of the circulatory system of the human body will show actual the circulation of impure
and pure blood. A working model of generation of hydroelectricity using turbines dactually light
a lamp with the use of electricity generated.

PREPARATION OF MODELS :
Materials used for preparing models may include thermocol, paper, wax, plaster of Paris,
cardboard, etc. In teaching of Mathematics you may like to use straws, card paper, match sticks
and rubber bands and so on. The idea is to convert abstract concepts into reality or near reality.
For example while teaching Euler's formula in Geometry, you may use card paper to prepare
different types of cuboids.
Models (ie recognizable three-dimensional representations of real things or abstract systems)
can play an extremely useful role in a wide range of instructional situations. They are, however,
particularly useful in three specific roles, namely, as visual support materials in mass instruction,
as objects for study or manipulation in individualized learning, and as construction projects for
individuals, small groups or even entire classes. When using models in the first of these roles,
however, it should be remembered that even the best three-dimensional model invariably
appears two-dimensional except to those who are very close, so it is usually worthwhile getting
the learners to gather round the model when its salient features are being demonstrated; unless
you do this, you could probably achieve the same objectives in most cases by using a two-
dimensional representation such as a slide, OHP transparency or projected computer graphic.
Some specific applications of models are listed below:
 They can be used to reduce very large objects and enlarge very small objects to a size
that can be conveniently observed and handled.
 They can be used to demonstrate the interior structures of objects or systems with a
clarity that is often not possible with two-dimensional representations and at a cost that is not yet
matched by virtual-reality products.
 They can be used to demonstrate movement - another feature that it is often difficult
to show adequately using two-dimensional display systems and that is more expensive in
virtual-reality experiences.
 They can be used to represent a highly complex situation or process in a simplified
way that can easily be understood by learners; this can be done by concentrating only on
essential features, eliminating all the complex and often confusing details that are so often
present in real-life systems.

216
Making your own models.

The range of methods available for making models for instructional purposes is enormous,
but readers may find some of the following standard techniques useful.
 Use of commercially-available kits of parts, such as the ball-and-spring systems that
are used to make models of molecules and the various types of tube-and-spigot systems that can
be used to make models of crystals.
 Use of construction systems such as 'Mecca no' and 'Fischer-Price' to make working
models.
 Use of inexpensive materials such as cardboard, hardboard, wood and wire to make
up static models of all types (models of buildings, geometrical bodies, three-dimensional shapes,
and so on).
 Use of materials like modeling clay and plasticize to produce realistic models of
animals, anatomical demonstrations, and so on.
 Use of materials like Plaster of Paris and peppier Mache to produce model landscapes.
Essential qualities of a Model
 Accuracy
 Simplicity
 Utility
 Solidity
 Ingenuity
 Useful
Functions of Model
 It simplifies reality
 Concretizes abstract concepts
 Enables us to reduce or enlarge objects to an observational size
 It provides the correct concept of an real object like dam/bridge etc
 A working model explains the various processes of objects and machines
 Promote creative interest among pupils.
TYPES OF MODELS:
There are four main types of models;
1) Solid models:A solid model is the replica of an original thing made with some suitable
material like clay, plaster ofParis, wood, iron etc. to show the external parts and features of the
thing.
E.g. Globe, clay model of human and animal, a vegetable, dolls, toys etc.
2) Cut away and x-ray models: Cut away and x ray models are the replicas of the original
things to internal parts of a thing. It may be either in the form of a cross sectional model
showing internal parts of a thing or may be composed of detachable parts.
E.g. Cross sectional model of human body, petrol engine, automatic traffic control system.
3) Working model: These models are either actual working things or their miniature
replicas. These models may help for illustrating an operation.
E.g. A motor, a generator, a cycle pump etc.
4) Sand models: These are graphic layout using sand clay, saw dust and other objects to
show trees, buildings, river, etc. Sand models are made using coloured sand in a tray of
convenient size or on a table.
217
E.g. A tribal village, a city area, marketing complex, a forest area.

ADVANTAGES OF MODELS:
1) Models provide an environment for interactive student engagement.
2) Working with models can enhance systems thinking abilities
3) Models are useful for helping students learn quantitative skillssuchas graphing, graphical
analysis, and visualization
4) Models illustrate the application side of certain principles and laws.
5) Models are lasting and ultimately workout to be cheaper teaching aids.
6) Models easy to make with the help of discard materials like empty boxes, pins, clips, nails,
rags and clay.
7) Models are reasonable size and convenient to handle.
8) Models heighten reality of things and make learning direct and meaningful as they are
three dimensional.
9) Models explain the operation in simplified way and this make comprehension easier.
10) Models involve the use of all five senses and thus make learning effective.
LIMITATIONS OF MODELS:
1) All the models cannot be made in the educational institutions.
2) Some of models can be very expensive.
3) The real thing may not be available in that season or may be far away from the school.
4) The real thing may be too expensive or too small to be seen at all or properly.

218
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE & R

ASSIGNMENT ON
FLASH CARDS

SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

FLASH CARDS
219
DEFINITION:
A small compact card, which flashed before the class to bring any idea.
(K.P. Neeraja)
A set cards bearing information , as words or numbers, on either or both sides, used in
classroom drills or in private study .
(web)
Flash cards are small cards of generally 25 x 30 cm size which are shown for a few moments
before the class to send across a message or impart an idea.
(B.T. Basavanthappa)

USES:
 Flash cards exercise the mental process of active recall.
 Used for the drill in various subjects.
 Used for reviewing a lesson with students.
 Used with the other graphic aids to the lesson effective.
 Used for small groups not over 30 people.
 Provides variety and activity in the class.

PREPARATION OF FLASH CARDS:


 Cut a foolscap chart paper and cut it into four equal parts.
 Write the content on it (either in free hand or using stencils and sketch pen).
 The height of writing is approx. 5 cm so that the whole class can see the flash card
properly.
 It is advisable to make a rough card on an ordinary paper first and then transfer it on
the chart paper or cardboard flash cards.

STEPS OF PRESENTING FLASH CARDS:


1. Brief introduction about the lesson.
2. While you flash the cards, give instructions about their actions.
3. Flash the card by holding the card at chest level and hold it against the body.
4. Glance down at card, as you are ready to explain and make sure to give correct
information.
5. Use pointer. Do not cover the matter with hand.
6. Let the students respond as per instructions already given.
7. Add more information to the student responses.
8. Test the learning by additional flash cards.
9. Review the lesson by selectively using flashcards.

ADVANTAGES OF FLASH CARDS:


 Flash card can be used to introduce and present topics.
220
 Flash card can be used to apply information already gained by students to new
situations.
 Flash card can be used to review the topic.
 Flash card can be used for drill and practice in elementary classes.
 Flash card can be used to develop recall of students.
 Flash card can work as useful supplementary aid and can be effectively used with
other materials (ie. it can be used either individually or in combination with other
charts ).

SUMMARY &CONCLUSION :
Flash card is one of the non projected Audio visual aid used in teaching learning process.
Using audio visual is important to maintain an effective teaching learning process.
JOURNAL ABSTRACT:
David P. Pursell
School of Science and Technology, Georgia Gwinnett College, Lawrenceville, GA 30043
J. Chem. Educ., 2009, 86 (10), p 1219
Abstract
Students of organic chemistry traditionally make 3 x 5 in. flash cards to assist learning
nomenclature, structures, and reactions. Advances in educational technology have enabled
flash cards to be viewed on computers, offering an endless array of drilling and feedback for
students. The current generation of students is less inclined to use computers, but they use
their cell phones 24 hours a day. This report outlines these trends and an even more recent
educational technology initiative, that of using cell phone flash cards to help students learn
organic chemistry nomenclature, structures, and reactions. Student attitudes were positive
toward cell phone flash cards in a pilot study and a more detailed study investigating use and
effect on student learning is planned.
BIBLIOGRAPHY:
1. K.P. Neeraja, Textbook of nursing education, 1st edition, Jaypee brothers medical
publishers(P)Ltd.; page no.215 to 216.
2. B.T. Basavanthappa, Nursing Education, Jaypee brothers medical publishers(P)Ltd.;
page no.606.
3. en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Flashcard

221
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
POWER POINT

SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

POWER POINT
222
PowerPoint is a presentation program developed by Microsoft. It is included in the
standard Office suite along with Microsoft Word and Excel. The software allows users to
create anything from basic slide shows to complex presentations.
PowerPoint is often used to create business presentations, but can also be used for
educational or informal purposes. The presentations are comprised of slides, which may
contain text, images, and other media, such as audio clips and movies. Sound effects and
animated transitions can also be included to add extra appeal to the presentation. However,
overusing sound effects and transitions will probably do more to annoy your audience than
draw their

Most PowerPoint presentations are created from a template, which includes a


background color or image, a standard font, and a choice of several slide layouts. Changes to
the template can be saved to a "master slide," which stores the main slide theme used in the
presentation. When changes are made to the master slide, such as choosing a new background
image, the changes are propagated to all the other slides. This keeps a uniform look among all
the slides in the presentation.

When presenting a PowerPoint presentation, the presenter may choose to have the
slides change at preset intervals or may decide to control the flow manually. This can be done
using the mouse,keyboard, or a remote control. The flow of the presentation can be further
customized by having slides load completely or one bullet at a time. For example, if the
presenter has several bullet points on a page, he might have individual points appear when he
clicks the mouse. This allows more interactivity with the audience and brings greater focus to
each point.
PowerPoint presentations can be created and viewed using Microsoft PowerPoint. They can
also be imported and exported with Apple Keynote, Apple's presentation program for the
Macintosh platform. Since most people prefer not to watch presentations on a laptop,
PowerPoint presentations are often displayed using a projector. Therefore, if you are
preparing a PowerPoint presentation for a room full of people, just make sure you have the
correct video adapter.

Points to Remember.....
1. Use a single template for a single presentation. Do not use multiple template design in a
single slide. Consistency is the key to a good PowerPoint presentation.

2. Use standard and simple template with a decent colored background. Too many bright or
glossy slides do not give a professional look. Choose colors that would appeals to the eyes.

3. Title page is very important as it creates the first impression about the whole presentation.
Give a crisp title that would describe the entire presentation.

4. Try to give a table of contents at the starting of the slide so that the user knows what all is
there for them.

5. Give short, direct and well structured sentences. The sentence should normally not exceed
more than 2 lines of the slide.

223
6. Do not crowd your presentation with too much text or too much of images.

7. Give your ideas in the form of bullets or points. You may consider giving numbering in
case you are explaining step by step procedure.

8. When using bullets, try using only one bullet type. Presence of the same bullet types will
maintain the flow all throughout the slide.

9. Your presentation should not only be in the form texts. Convey your ideas with the help of
pictures, flowcharts, audio, video, etc.

10. The Heading should have a larger font than the Text.

11. Choose only one main heading per page.


Preparing a talk always takes far longer than you anticipate.Start early!
 Write a clear statement of the problem and its importance.
 Research. Collect material which may relate to the topic.
 Tell a story in a logical sequence.
 Stick to the key concepts. Avoid description of specifics and unnecessary details. 
 If you are making a series of points, organize them from the most to the least
important. The less important points can be skipped if you run short of time.
 Keep your sentences short, about 10-20 words each is ideal. This is the way people
usually talk.
 Strive for clarity. Are these the best words for making your point? Are they
unambiguous? Are you using unfamiliar jargon or acronyms?
Preparing Your Slides:
Presentation Design
 Let the picture or graphics tell the story - minimize the use of text.
 Don’t overload your slides with too much text or data.
 FOCUS. In general, using a few powerful slides is the aim.
 Type key words in the PowerPoint Notes area listing what to say when displaying the
slide. The notes are printable.
 Number your slides and give them a title.
 Prepare an Agenda or Table of Contents slide. You can reuse the same slide at the end
of the presentation by changing the title to Summary.
 Prepare a company logo slide for your presentation.
 You can add a logo and other graphics to every slide using the slide master feature or
by adding them to the footer.
 Proofread everything, including visuals and numbers.
 Keep “like” topics together.
 Strive for similar line lengths for text.
Visual elements
 A font size of 28 to 34 with a bold font is recommended for subtitles. The title default
size is 44. Use a san serif font for titles.
 Use clear, simple visuals. Don’t confuse the audience.
 Use contrast: light on dark or dark on light.
 Graphics should make a key concept clearer.

224
 Place your graphics in a similar location within each screen.
 To temporarily clear the screen press W or B during the presentation. Press any key to
resume the presentation.
Text
 Font size must be large enough to be easily read. Size 28 to 34 with a bold font is
recommended.
 It is distracting if you use too wide a variety of fonts.
 Overuse of text is a common mistake.
o Too much text makes the slide unreadable. You may just as well show a blank
slide. Stick to a few key words. 
o If your audience is reading the slides they are not paying attention to you. If
possible, make your point with graphics instead of text.
o You can use Word Art, or a clip art image of a sign, to convey text in a more
interesting way.
Numbers
 Numbers are usually confusing to the audience. Use as few as possible and allow
extra time for the audience to do the math.
 Numbers should never be ultra precise: 
o “Anticipated Revenues of $660,101.83” looks silly. Are your numbers that
accurate? Just say $660 thousand.
o “The Break Even Point is 1048.17 units. Are you selling fractions of a unit?
o Don’t show pennies. Cost per unit is about the only time you would need to
show pennies.
 If you have more than 12-15 numbers on a slide, that’s probably too many.
 Using only one number per sentence helps the audience absorb the data.
Statistics
 Use the same scale for numbers on a slide. Don’t compare thousands to millions.
 When using sales data, stick to a single market in the presentation. Worldwide sales,
domestic sales, industry sales, company sales, divisional sales, or sales to a specific
market segment are all different scales. They should not be mixed.
 Cite your source on the same slide as the statistic, using a smaller size font.
Charts
 Charts need to be clearly labeled. You can make more interesting charts by adding
elements from the drawing toolbar.
 Numbers in tables are both hard to see and to understand. There is usually a better
way to present your numerical data than with columns and rows of numbers. Get
creative!
 PowerPoint deletes portions of charts and worksheets that are imported from Excel,
keeping only the leftmost 5.5 inches. Plan ahead.
Backgrounds
 Backgrounds should never distract from the presentation.
 Using the default white background is hard on the viewer’s eyes. You can easily add a
design style or a color to the background.
 Backgrounds that are light colored with dark text, or vice versa, look good. A dark
background with white font reduces glare.
 Colors appear lighter when projected. Pale colors often appear as white.
225
 Consistent backgrounds add to a professional appearance.
 For a long presentation, you may want to change background designs when shifting to
a new topic.
Excitement
 Slides for business presentations should be dull! You don’t want to distract the
audience.
 Sounds and transition effects can be annoying. Use sparingly.
 Animation effects can be interesting when used in moderation.
o Too much animation is distracting.
o Consider using animated clip art
o Consider using custom animation
 You can insert video and audio clips into PowerPoint.
 You can also insert hyperlinks.
Hints for Efficient Practice:
Timing - Practicing Your Presentation,
 Talk through your presentation to see how much time you use for each slide.
 Set the automatic slide transition to the amount of time you want to spend discussing
each slide.
 Are you using the right amount of time per slide? Decide which slides or comments
need alteration to make your presentation smoother.
 Change the automatic slide transition settings for individual slides to fit the amount of
time needed for that slide and practice again. Are you still within the time limit?
 Decide if you want to remove the automatic slide transition feature before giving the
presentation.
Content
 Make a list of key words/concepts for each slide
 Read through the list before you begin.
 Don't attempt to memorize your text;
 Your words will probably be different each time you practice.
 Think about the ideas, and your words will follow naturally.
Delivering Your Talk:
Pre-Talk Preparation
 Plan to get there a few minutes early to set up and test the equipment.
 Dress appropriately for your audience.
 Turn off your cell phone.
Handouts: 
 Edward Tufte, the leading expert on visual presentation techniques, advises speakers
to always prepare a handout when giving a PowerPoint presentation.
 Make about 10% more handouts than you expect to use.
 Distribute handouts at the beginning of your talk.
Opening:
 Jump right in and get to the point.
 Give your rehearsed opening statement; don't improvise at the last moment.
 Use the opening to catch the interest and attention of the audience.

226
 Briefly state the problem or topic you will be discussing.
 Briefly summarize your main theme for an idea or solution.
Speaking
 Talk at a natural, moderate rate of speech
 Project your voice.
 Speak clearly and distinctly.
 Repeat critical information.
 Pause briefly to give your audience time to digest the information on each new slide.
 Don’t read the slides aloud. Your audience can read them far faster than you can talk.
 If you plan to write on the slides to emphasize key points during the presentation,
practice ahead of time. To select the writing tool right-click during the presentation.
Body Language
 Keep your eyes on the audience
 Use natural gestures.
 Don’t turn your back to the audience.
 Don’t hide behind the lectern.
 Avoid looking at your notes. Only use them as reference points to keep you on track.
Talk, don’t read.
Questions
 Always leave time for a few questions at the end of the talk.
 If you allow questions during the talk, the presentation time will be about 25% more
than the practice time.
 You can jump directly to a slide by typing its number or by right-clicking during the
presentation and choosing from the slide titles.
 Relax. If you’ve done the research you can easily answer most questions.
 Some questions are too specific or personal. Politely refuse to answer. 
 If you can’t answer a question, say so. Don’t apologize.“I don’t have that information.
I’ll try to find out for you.”
Length:
 To end on time, you must PRACTICE!
 When practicing, try to end early. You need to allow time for audience interruptions
and questions.
 
Demeanor:
 Show some enthusiasm. Nobody wants to listen to a dull presentation. On the other
hand, don’t overdo it. Nobody talks and gestures like a maniac in real life. How would
you explain your ideas to a friend?
 Involve your audience. Ask questions, make eye contact, and use humor.
 Don’t get distracted by audience noises or movements.
 You’ll forget a minor point or two. Everybody does.
 If you temporarily lose your train of thought you can gain time to recover by asking if
the audience has any questions.
Conclusion:
 Close the sale.
 Concisely summarize your key concepts and the main ideas of your presentation.

227
 Resist the temptation to add a few last impromptu words.
 End your talk with the summary statement or question you have prepared. What do
you want them to do? What do you want them to remember?
 Consider alternatives to “Questions?” for your closing slide. A summary of your key
points, a cartoon, a team logo, or a company logo may be stronger.

Advantage

 easy to create colorful, attractive designs using the standard templates and themes; easy to
modify compared to other visual aids, such as charts, and easy to drag and drop slides to re-
order presentation.
 easy to present and maintain eye contact with a large audience by simply advancing the
slides with a keystroke, eliminating the need for handouts to follow the message.
Disadvantage
• speakers create slides so they have something to present rather than outlining, organizing,
and focusing on their message.
 the linear nature of PowerPoint slides forces the presenter to reduce complex subjects to a
set of bullet items which are too weak to support decision-making or show
the complexity of an issue.
 basic equipment required to present. You will need to have a computer and projection
equipment in place to display the slides to the audience

KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &


RESEARCH

228
ASSIGNMENT ON COMPUTER
APPLICATIONS IN NURSING

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

COMPUTER APPLICATIONS IN NURSING


INTRODUCTION

After 65 years of independence still India is a developing country. All other countries
those are considered as developed countries are using the technology as a major path for their
developmental activities. But still India is lack in using technology to the required level.

229
In the same way for the ultimate development of a profession we need to use the
information technology in appropriate way. But as like India, our nursing profession also lack
in using the information technology, especially in India. It is because of lack of
awareness regarding the use of IT. So let we know how IT or computers are useful in our
nursing profession.

DIFINITIONS

 COMPUTER
A computer is a device that accepts information (in the form of digitalized data) and
manipulates it for some result based on a program or sequence of instructions on how the data
is to be processed and also include the means for storing data (including the program, which
is also a form of data) for some necessary duration.
 NURSING INFORMATICS
Nursing informatics is defined by Ball and Hannah, authors of "Using Computers in
Nursing," as "those collected informational technologies which concern themselves with the
patient care decision-making process performed by health care practitioners." All nurses use
informatics. As a defined field, nursing informatics is relatively new, but the work of the
nursing informatics specialist is not new at all.

According to American Nurses Association (2000) “Nursing informatics is a specialty


that integrates nursing science, computer science and information science to manage and
communicate data, information, and knowledge in nursing practice. Nursing informatics
facilitates the integration of data, information, and knowledge to support patients, nurses and
other providers in their decision making in all roles and settings. This support is
accomplished through the use of information structures and information technology”.

DESCRIPTION OF COMPUTER
A computer is an electronic device, which executes software programs. It consists of
2 parts-hardware and software. The computer processes input through input devices like
mouse and keyboard. The computer displays output through output devices like color monitor
and printer. The size of a computer varies considerably from very small to very big. The
speed of computers also has a very large range. Computers have become indispensable in
today’s world. Millions of people use computers all over the world.
Technically, a computer is a programmable machine. This means it can execute a
programmed list of instructions and respond to new instructions that it is given. Today,
however, the term is most often used to refer to the desktop and laptop computers that most
people use. When referring to a desktop model, the term "computer" technically only refers to
the computer itself -- not the monitor, keyboard, and mouse. Still, it is acceptable to refer to
everything together as the computer. If you want to be really technical, the box that holds the
computer is called the "system unit."

HISTORY OF COMPUTER

230
Most histories of the modern computer begin with the Analytical Engine envisioned
by Charles Babbage following the mathematical ideas of George Boole, the mathematician
who first stated the principles of logic inherent in today's digital computer. Babbage's
assistant and collaborator, Ada Lovelace, is said to have introduced the ideas of program
loops and subroutines and is sometimes considered the first programmer. Apart from
mechanical calculators, the first really useable computers began with the vacuum tube,
accelerated with the invention of the transistor, which then became embedded in large
numbers in integrated circuits, ultimately making possible the relatively low-cost personal
computer.

Modern computers inherently follow the ideas of the stored program laid out by John
von Neumann in 1945. Essentially, the program is read by the computer one instruction at a
time, an operation is performed, and the computer then reads in the next instruction, and so
on. Recently, computers and programs have been devised that allow multiple programs (and
computers) to work on the same problem at the same time in parallel. With the advent of the
Internet and higher bandwidth data transmission, programs and data that are part of the same
overall project can be distributed over a network and embody the Sun Microsystems slogan:
"The network is the computer."

USES OF COMPUTERS : There are several uses of computers: -

 Word Processing - Word Processing software automatically corrects spelling and grammar
mistakes. If the content of a document repeats we don’t have to type it each time. We can use
the copy and paste features. We can printout documents and make several copies. It is easier
to read a word-processed document than a handwritten one. We can add images to our
document.

 Internet - It is a network of almost all the computers in the world. We can browse through
much more information than we could do in a library. That is because computers can store
enormous amounts of information. We also have very fast and convenient access to
information. Through E-Mail we can communicate with a person sitting thousands of miles
away in seconds. There is chat software that enables one to chat with another person on a
real-time basis. Video conferencing tools are becoming readily available to the common man.

 Digital video or audio composition – Audio or video composition and editing have been
made much easier by computers. It no longer costs thousands of dollars of equipment to
compose music or make a film. Graphics engineers can use computers to generate short or
full-length films or even to create three-dimensional models. Anybody owning a computer
can now enter the field of media production. Special effects in science fiction and action
movies are created using computers.

 Computers in Medicine – We can diagnose diseases. We can learn the cures. Software is
used in magnetic resonance imaging to examine the internal organs of the human body.
Software is used for performing surgery. Computers are used to store patient data.

231
 Mathematical Calculations - Thanks to computers, which have computing speeds of over a
million calculations per second we can perform the biggest of mathematical calculations.

 Banks - All financial transactions are done by computer software. They provide security,
speed and convenience.

 Travel - One can book air tickets or railway tickets and make hotel reservations online.

 Telecommunications - Software is widely used here. Also all mobile phones have software
embedded in them.

 Defence - There is software embedded in almost every weapon. Software is used for
controlling the flight and targeting in ballistic missiles. Software is used to control access to
atomic bombs.

 E-Learning – Instead of a book it is easier to learn from E-learning software.

 Gambling-You can gamble online instead of going to a casino.

 Examinations-You can give online exams and get instant results. You can check your
examination results online. Also it helps in prevention of question paper leakage.

 Computers in Business - Shops and supermarkets use software, which calculate the bills.
Taxes can be calculated and paid online. Accounting is done using computers. One can
predict future trends of business using artificial intelligence software. Software is used in
major stock markets. One can do trading online. There are fully automated factories running
on software.

 Certificates- Different types of certificates can be generated. It is very easy to create and
change layouts.

 ATM machines - The computer software authenticates the user and dispenses cash.

 Marriage - There are matrimonial sites through which one can search for a suitable groom or
bride.

 News-There are many websites through which you can read the latest or old news.

 Classmates-There are many alumni websites through which you can regain contact with your
classmates

 Robotics - Robots are controlled by software.


 Washing Machines - They operate using software.
 Microwave Oven - They are operated by software.

232
 Planning and Scheduling - Software can be used to store contact information, generating
plans, scheduling appointments and deadlines.

 Plagiarism- Software can examine content for plagiarism.


 Greeting Cards - You can send and receive greetings pertaining to different occasions.

 Sports – Software is used for making umpiring decisions. There are simulation software
using which a sportsperson can practice his skills. Computers are also to identify flaws in
technique.

 Aero planes – Pilots train on software, which simulates flying.


 Weather analysis – Supercomputers are used to analyze and predict weather.

USES OF COMPUTERS IN NURSING


Computers can help in following areas:
1. Planning Nursing Care:
Since each patient's and ward's nursing needs are different, computers can assist in
effective planning. For each patient a nursing care plan can be constructed which will have all
information about the health history of the patient, medicines to be administered, dosage, diet
and therapies. This will help the physicians and surgeons, besides the nursing personnel to
enhance the quality of care.
2. Monitoring and Interpreting Physiologic Variables
E.g.TPR, BP, Cardiac rate, Rhythm, etc
3. Administering medications
Computers assist in calculating drug dosage according to age, weight and body
surface area of the patient.
4. Patient Classification System
Patients can be classified as per their acuteness with the help of the computer. Based
on this, number of nursing personnel required can be computed.
5. Scheduling Staff
Work schedules can be prepared keeping in view the inpatient and outpatient load,
acuteness, number of operations to be performed, camps to be conducted, staff location,
preferences for shifts or availability of the consultants, policy guidelines, etc.
6. Record Keeping
All admissions, discharges, materials, equipment, personnel, payroll, insurance,
billing, inventories, referrals and all other information can be easily handled by the computer.
FOR STAFF NURSES
 Accurate documentation of nursing care according to the nursing process model.
 Facilitate continuity of care of patients.
 Reduce errors.
 Computers get relieved of routine documentation. Clerical functions reduce paper
work, sparing more time with professional for patient care.

233
 Easy access to valuable medical information.
 Easy for job rotation.
 Sets standards for procedures.
FOR NURSING ADMINISTRATORS AND ADMINISTRATION
 Emphasize the need to measure nursing care and resources consumed.
 Develop computerized nursing information systems.
 Recognize the research needs.
APPLICATIONS OF COMPUTERS IN NURSING EDUCATION
1) In Developing The Nursing Curriculum
a) Information Management
The management of information is and will continue to become one of the
most daunting challenges for faculty, students and nurses. So the successful
integration of information management in education is an organizational
infrastructure that supports both human and technical, promotes faculty development,
and incorporates informatics in to the curriculum.
b) Faculty Development
For faculty development programs to be successful at integrating information
technology into the curriculum, they must be sensitive to both faculty interests and
time limitations.Faculty values and pedagogic methods can be used to improve
student learning, research projects, and clinical practice. But we are currently faced
with a severe faculty shortage, an aging faculty, and rapid deployment of information
technology with in academic settings (AACN, 2003). So this suggests that technical
aspects should be taught before moving on to instructional applications of information
technology.
c) Nursing Education Informatics Model
The current focus of informatics is on mastering information technology and
information management as it applies to information and knowledge. So the change in
education and informatics has been from computer literacy to information literacy and
management (Nelson, 2000).
A number of models have been presented for educators to emulate in
designing curriculum for the inclusion of nursing informatics.
i. Travis and Brennan (1998) propose a model that emphasizes the inclusion of
information science as essential in the undergraduate curriculum. This model
focused on three concepts such as information, technology and clinical care
processes. It emphasizes the smooth integration informatics into courses
sequencing. Mastering the basics of information technology in the first and second
year, students progress to the actual application of information technology to the
science of nursing in the third year. The correlation between the information
technology and patient care is reinforced in the clinical environment.
ii. The Riley and Saba (1996) developed a model to integrating nursing informatics
into the curriculum. Here the domains of computer science, information science

234
and nursing science are integrated throughout the curriculum in a progressive level
to ensure the development of nursing informatics competencies. In this model,
undergraduate students master computer literacy and progress to information
management and its application to the clinical setting.

Nursing science
Integrate nursing
informatics

Information science Coordinate and


evaluate data and
information systems

Utilize data and information


systems
Access information systems

Basic concepts and applications

Computer Science
Nursing Informatics Education Model

2) Accessible, effective distance education


a) The evolution of distance education
The distance education has experienced bumps and surges with the evolving presence
of print, audio, television and the various computer-interactive technologies. Distance
education courses started out focusing on vocational training, but now different
disciplines have capitalized on distance education as an option of instruction (Neal,
1999).

b) Educational Electronic Platforms


An educational platform is an electronic product that assists the delivery of
internet courses. As colleges are faced with decisions regarding which educational
platform to use for facilitation of online instruction, education tools has done a
thorough assessment.

235
Progress review, assessment capabilities and online grading features are
valued by the instructor and learner in distance education due to their convenience
and feedback.

3) Computer is a useful tool in Education because it allows for an individual a self paced
learning. Computed Assisted Instruction (CAI) is a method of teaching that involves
interaction between the learner and the computer. The computer takes on the role of a
teacher.

4) There are three different types of CAI programmes:


a) Drill and Practice: It is the most common and least complex type of CAI. A learner is
presented with a series of questions or problems about materials that have already been
learnt. Drug dosage calculation, intravenous drip rate calculation and medical
terminology and abbreviations are some of the topics that drill and practice CAT is well
suited for.
b) Tutorial Programs: Display new materials that are similar to programmed instructions.
Tutorials present information and provide the learner the feedback.
c) Simulations: Present before learners the 'real - life' situations that are designed to assist
learners in developing problem solving and decision making skills in a safe environment.
Interactive Video Instruction (IAV) can provide learners. With "true - to- life" simulation.
IAV combines CAI with a videotape or videodisc player so that video pictures as well as
graphics can be incorporated in the design of the software.

APPLICATIONS OF COMUTERS IN NURSING RESEARCH


Computers facilitate the research process in a number of ways. Computerized literature
searches are a particular advantage to the researchers because they save time and can increase
the scope of the search and the number of data base that can be searched. The computer can
also help researchers collect and analyze data, prepare research reports, and disseminate
research findings
Computer applications that support nursing research are:
 Topic identification:through online literature searches, email and discussion groups,
and visiting websites.
 Literature searches: Once a topic is chosen, the literature review can be greatly
enhanced from current research available on the Web, in databases, and on CD-ROMs,
often with full text retrieval.
 Resource Files:Historically, index cards and paper were used to keep notes of various
research searches and observations. Computers can now be used for these clerical tasks.
 Data collection tools:can be retrieved through online searches or created using various
graph, spreadsheet, and word processing and database applications.
 Proposal preparation:Word processing programs greatly facilitate the editing and
writing.
 Budgets:Both the preparation and management of research budgets are made easier with
spreadsheet programs.

236
 Data collection: Various programs can be used to sort and actually collect data,
including hospital information systems, spreadsheets, databases, and word processing.
 Data Analysis: Statistical and thematic software can greatly reduce the time and stress
of processing both quantitative and qualitative data.
 Final report: Word processing, charts and tables and statistical graphs can all be easily
and quickly done on a computer.
 Sharing of results: Current research findings can be shared with the public at large far
quicker using the web and other electronic venues. Print reports often take one to five
years to be circulated.

APPLICATIONS OF COMPUTERS IN NURSING ADMINISTRATION


There are three issues which have an impact on the profession and future of the nurse
managers and administrators such as the nursing shortage, increased demand for patient
safety and the need for visibility. These issues have created a wealth of opportunity for
nursing in terms of IT. At the same time they have created a challenge: When faced with
limited time, personnel and financial resources, should nursing pursue its mission to provide
care or should it concentrate on mastering emerging technology?
In 2002, American Healthcare Association had conducted a survey of the some
American hospital about their patient care and paperwork experiences. The results were
disturbing:
 In the emergency department, every hour of patient care requires one hour of
paperwork.
 For surgery and inpatient acute care, every hour of patient care requires 36 minutes of
paperwork.
 For skilled nursing care, every hour of patient care requires 30 minutes of paperwork.
 For home healthcare, every hour of patient care requires 48 minutes of paperwork.

The computerized nursing system can help nursing administrators for the nursing
management and to use information to fulfill its data requirements in following aspect.
 Clinical needs: individual patient care, documentation, implementing services.
 Business/strategic needs: organizational performance, management, and support
processes.
 Quality management needs: outcomes measurement and regulatory compliance.
 Resource and personnel management needs: scheduling, costing, and allocating
nursing staff, managing productivity, continuing education/ staff development.

Several administrative applications are available in computer for nurse administrators.


They are

1. Nurse managers data needs


The nursing managers use computer system to collect data needed for planning,
budgeting, and reporting, which ensures quality care. Their needs and the applications
they used are:

237
a. Allocating available resources to provide efficient and effective nursing care and
implementing clinical nursing services.
 Nursing intensity
 Patient classification system
 Acuity system
 Staffing and scheduling system
 Inventory
 Budgeting and payroll
 Claims processing and reimbursement
 Patient billing

b. Providing input into executive level decisions and collaborating with the nurse
executive and others in organizational programming and committee work.
Implementing the philosophy, goals and standards of the healthcare organization
 Unit activity reports.
 Utilization review.
 Shift summary reports.

c. Planning, organizing, implementing and controlling the care of individual and


aggregates across the spectrum of healthcare settings. This includes, but is not
limited to, aspects of quality outcomes, staff development, care management, and
research.
 Computer based patient record
 Census
 Poison control
 Allergy and drug reactions
 Errors reports
 Incident reports
 Infection control
 Communication networks
 Training and education

2. Nurse executive’ data needs


The nurse executive’s needs and applications they use include:

a. Managing organized nursing services and the environment in which clinical


nursing is practiced. Collaborating with other healthcare organization executives to
make decisions about healthcare services and organizational priorities.
 Forecasting and planning
 Financial planning
 Hospital expansion
 Preventive maintenance

238
 Planning systems
b. Ensuring that standards of nursing practice are established and implemented, and
are consistent with standards of professional organizations and regulatory services.
 Quality assurance
 Regulatory reporting
 Consumer surveys
 Evidenced base practice

c. Evaluating care delivery models and of services provided to individuals and


aggregates.
 Personnel files
 Risk pooling
 Costing nursing care
 Case mix

FACTORS THAT INHIBIT THE USE OF COMPUTERS IN NURSING


PROFESSION

1. Faculty do not want to change


2. Faculty do not want to learn
3. Faculty's lack of opportunities to learn
4. Faculty's lack of skill
5. Hardware costs
6. Software costs
7. Lack of useful software
8. Lack of information about software
9. Lack of faculty time and interest
10. Lack of evaluative evidence of worth
11. Who should take responsibility of maintenance if problem arises?
12. In many hospitals physical environment is inadequate for computers
13. Wiring may be difficult in the existing structure

CONCLUSION
Computers are most powerful means of information devices in any profession. Also
these are most useful in our nursing profession. But the lack of awareness regarding the
use and advantages of computers in nursing professionals still we are unable to make
proper use IT. So we the nursing professionals need to know more about the IT and use
of computers and need to bring changes in our profession.

239
BIBLIOGRAPHY

1. Virginia KS, Kathlene AM. Essentials of nursing informatics. 4 th ed. Boston:


McGraw-Hill companies; 2006. p. 3-6, 443-585.
2. Ball MJ, Jelger UG, Peterson editors. Nursing informatics. New York: springer-
verlag; 1988.
3. Barbara C, Susan RJ. Contemporary nursing: issues trends and management. 4th ed.
St. Louis: Mosby Elsevier; 2008. p. 289-304.
4. http://www.techterms.com/definition/computer
5. http://www.buzzle.com/chapters/computers-and-the-internet_computer-uses-and-
related-resources.asp
6. www.buzzle.com/articles/uses-of-computer.html
7. http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Health_informatics

KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &


RESEARCH
240
Annotated
Bibliography
SUBJECT : EDUCATION AND NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

ANNOTATED BIBLIOGRAPHY

241
Introduction
An annotated bibliography is a bibliography that gives a summary of the
research that has been done. It is still an alphabetical list of research sources. In
addition to bibliographic data, an annotated bibliography provides a brief
summary or annotation.
The purpose of annotations is to provide the reader with a summaryand
an evaluation of the source. In order to write a successful annotation,each
summary must be concise. An annotation should display the source'scentral
idea(s) and give the reader a general idea of what the source is about.
An annotation should include the complete bibliographic information for
the source. It should also include some or all of the following:
• An explanation about the authority and/or qualifications of the author.
• Scope or main purpose of the work.
• Any detectable bias.
• Intended audience and level of reading
• A summary comment
Ideally, an annotation should be between 100 to 200 words.

Definitions
A bibliography is a list of sources (books, journals, websites, periodicals,
etc.) one has used for researching a topic. Bibliographies are sometimes called
“references” or “works cited” depending on the styleformat you are using. A
bibliography usually just includes the bibliographic information (i.e., the author,
title, publisher, etc.).

An annotation is a summary and/or evaluation.

242
Therefore, an annotated bibliography includes a summary and/or
evaluation of each of the sources. Depending on your project, your annotations
may do one or more of the following:
• Summarize:Some annotations merely summarize the source. What are
the main arguments? What is the point of this book or article? What
topics are covered? If someone asked what this article/book is about,
what would you say? The length of your annotations will determine how
detailed your summary is.
• Assess:After summarizing a source, it may be helpful to evaluate it. Is it a
useful source? How does it compare with other sources in your
bibliography? Is the information reliable? Is this source biased or
objective? What is the goal of this source?
For more help, see our handouts on evaluating resources.
• Reflect:Once you've summarized and assessed a source, you need to ask
how it fits into your research. Was this source helpful to you? How does
it help you shape your argument? How can you use this source in your
research project? Has it changed how you think about your topic?Your
annotated bibliography may include some of these, all of these, or even
others. If you're doing this for a class, you should get specific guidelines
from your instructor.

Types of annotations
Annotations may be written with different goals in mind.

Indicative annotations

243
This type of annotation defines the scope of the source, lists the
significant topics and explains what the source is about. In this type of entry,
there is no attempt to give actual data such as hypotheses, proofs, etc.[3]

Informative annotations
This type of annotation is a summary of the source. An informative
annotation should include the thesis of the work, arguments or hypotheses,
proofs and a conclusion.

Evaluative annotations
This type of annotation assesses the source's strengths and weaknesses—
how the source is useful and how it is not. Simply put, an evaluative annotation
should evaluate the source's usefulness.

Combination annotations
Most annotated bibliographies contain combination annotations. This
type of annotation will summarize or describe the topic, and then evaluate the
source's usefulness.[3]

Writing styles
No matter which writing style is used for annotations, all entries should
be brief. Only the most significant details should be mentioned. Information that
is apparent in the title can be omitted from the annotation. In addition,
background materials and any references to previous work are usually excluded.
[4]

Telegraphic
244
A telegraphic writing style gets the information out quickly and
concisely. Maintaining clarity, complete and grammatically correct sentences
are not necessary.[4]

Complete sentences
A complete sentences writing style utilizes coherent sentences that are
grammatically correct. Subjects and conjunctions are not eliminated even
though the tone may be terse. Long and complex sentences are to generally be
avoided.[4]

Paragraph
A paragraph writing style utilizes a full, coherent paragraph. This can
sometimes be similar to the form of a bibliographic essay. Complete sentences
and proper grammar must be used.[4]
Purpose
There are three main purposes behind writing an annotated bibliography.
Each purpose can serve anyone in a different manner, depending on what they
are trying to accomplish.

Learning about a topic


Writing an annotated bibliography is an excellent way to begin any
research project. While it may seem easier to simply copy down bibliographical
information, adding annotations will force the researcher to read each source
carefully. An annotation requires the source to be critically analyzed, not simply
read over.[5]

Formulating a thesis

245
Any form of research paper or essay will require some form of argument.
This is called a thesis. A developed thesis needs to be debatable, interesting and
current. Writing an annotated bibliography will give the researcher a clear
understanding about what is being said about their topic. After reading and
critically analyzing sources, the researcher will be able to determine what issues
there are and what people are arguing about. From there, the researcher will be
able to develop their own point of view.[5]

To assist other researchers


Extensive and scholarly annotated bibliographies are sometimes
published. The purpose of these annotated bibliographies is to provide a
complete and comprehensive overview of any given topic. While any normal
researcher may not get their own annotated bibliography published, it could be a
good idea to search for previously published annotated bibliographies that are
related to their topic.[5]

246
BIBLIOGRAPHY
1. Carlson, Laurie. “Annotated Bibliographies”. KU Writing Center.
University of Kansas.
http://www.writing.ku.edu/~writing/guides/bibs.shtml. Retrieved 15 April
2009.
2. “How to Write Annotated Bibliographies”, http ://www. 1 ibrary.
mun.ca/guides/howto/annotated_bibl .php. Retrieved 2008-03-02.
3. “AnnotatedBibliographies:Content”.Writer's Handbook. The Writing
Center. http://www.wisc.edu/writing/Handbook/AnnBib_content.html.
Retrieved 2008-03-02.
4. “Annotated Bibliographies: Style”. Writer's Handbook. The Writing
Center. http://www.wisc.edu/writing/Handbook/AnnBib_style.html.
Retrieved 2009-10-06.
5. Geoff Stacks, Erin Karper (2001).“Annotated Bibliographies”. Purdue
University.
http://owl.english.purdue.edu/handouts/general/gl_annotatedbib.html.
Retrieved 2009-10-06

247
ANNOTATED BIBLIOGRAPHY (RESEARCH)
Stem Cell Research: An Annotated Bibliography
Holland, Suzanne. The Human Embryonic Stem Cell Debate : Science, Ethics,
and Public Policy. Boston: MIT Press, 2001. Print.
This is the annotation of the above source. In this example, I am
following MLA 2009 (3rd ed.) guidelines for the bibliographic information
listed above. If I were really writing an annotation for this source, I would offer
a brief summary of what this book says about stem cell research.
After a brief summary, it would be appropriate to assess this source and
offer some criticisms of it. Does it seem like a reliable and current source?
Why? Is the research biased or objective? Are the facts well documented? Who
is the author? Is she qualified in this subject? Is this source scholarly, popular,
some of both?
The length of your annotation will depend on the assignment or on the
purpose of your annotated bibliography. After summarizing and assessing, you
can now reflect on this source. How does it fit into your research? Is this a
helpful resource? Too scholarly? Not scholarly enough? Too general/specific?
Since “stem cell research” is a very broad topic, has this source helped you to
narrow your topic?

Senior, K. “Extending the Ethical Boundaries of Stem Cell


Research.”Trends in Molecular Medicine. 7 (2001): 5-6. Print.
Not all annotations have to be the same length. For example, this source
is a very short scholarly article. It may only take a sentence or two to

248
summarize. Even if you are using a book, you should only focus on the sections
that relate to your topic.
Not all annotated bibliographies assess and reflect; some merely
summarize. That may not be the most helpful for you, but, if this is an
assignment, you should always ask your instructor for specific guidelines.

Wallace, Kelly. “Bush Stands Pat on Stem Cell Policy.”CNN. 13 August


2001. 17 August 2001. Television.
Notice that in this example, I chose a variety of sources: a book, a
scholarly journal, and a web page. Using a variety of sources can help give you
a broader picture of what is being said about your topic. You may want to
investigate how scholarly sources are treating this topic differently than more
popular sources. But again, if your assignment is to only use scholarly sources,
then you will probably want to avoid magazines and popular web sites.
Notice that the bibliographic information above is proper MLA format
(use whatever style is appropriate in your field) and the annotations are in
paragraph form.

249
250
ANNOTATED BIBLIOGRAPHY (JOURNALS)
Review Articles
For this bibliography we have chosen to concentrate on review articles
because they provide a broad overview of the topic and discussion of current
debates in the literature. Review articles are also useful for identifying seminal
writings and providing extensive bibliography.
An analysis of the concept of empowerment I C. M. Rodwell. Journal of
AdvancedNursing1996;23(2):305-13.
This paper is an analysis of empowerment and its use in nursing practice,
education, research and health promotion.
Childdevelopmentandlong-termoutcomes:Apopulation healthperspective
and summary of successful interventions I C. Hertzian and M. Weens.
SocialScience & Medicine1996;43(7): 1083-95. Discusses the evidence
derived from intervention studies in the post-neonatal, reschool, and school age
periods which suggest that child development can be modified in ways which
improve health and competence in the long-term.
Community health promotion: Concepts and lessons from contemporary
sociology I O. Nilsen. Health Policy1996;36(2): 167-83. Argues that
community specifics have not been adequately taken into account in planning
health promotion initiatives.
Cultural influences in community participation in health I L. Stone.
Social Science& Medicine1992;35(4):409-17.
This paper traces changes in the way that the role of culture has been
analysed in relation to community health issues and in particular with respect to
'community participation'.
Determinants of a health-promoting lifestyle: An integrative review I A.F.
Gillis. Journal of Advanced Nursing1993;18(3):345-53. Reviews literature

251
published between 1983 and 1991 that focused on identifying the determinants
of a health-promoting lifestyle.
Dissemination and utilization of health promotion and disease prevention
knowledge: Theory, research and experience I L.W. Green and J.L. Johnson.
Canadian Journal of Public Health. Revue/Canadienne de
SantePublique1996;87 Supple 2:S11-17.
Economic impoverishment as a health risk: Methodologic and conceptual
issues I M.A. Nelson. Advances in Nursing Science 1994; 16(3): 1-12. Argues
that a number of methodologic and conceptual issues have impeded
understanding of the relationship between socioeconomic status and health.
Effective mental health promotion: A literature review I R. Hodgson, T.
Abbasi and J. Clarkson. Health Education Journal 1996; 55(l):55-74.
The effectiveness of community health nursing interventions: A
literaturereview I L.W. Deal. Public Health Nursing 1994; 11(5):315-23.
This article describes services provided by community health nurses
anddocuments the effectiveness of these interventions based on
availableliterature.
The evolution, impact and significance of the Healthy Cities/ Healthy
Communities movement I T. Hancock. Journal of Public Health Policy
1993;14(1):5-18.
Reviews the concept of Healthy Cities, its evolution and current practice,
considers some of the problems in applying the concept, and speculates on its
potential future development.
From preventive health behaviour to health promotion: Advancing a
positive construct of health/ P.A. Kulbok and J.H. Baldwin. Advances in
Nursing Science 1992;14(4):50-64.
A review of health promotion research in nursing, focussing on the
conceptualization and measurement of health promotion behaviours.
General strategies for motivating people to change their behaviour I S.
Damrosch. Nursing Clinics of North America 1991;26(4):833-43.
252
Discusses the cumulative findings of numerous studies of motivation to
change behaviour.
Health promotion and the older population: Expanding our theoretical
horizons I M.S. Caserta. Journal of Community Health 1995;20(3):283-92.
Explores the challenges of gerontological health education to traditional models
of health promotion.
Health promotion, community development and the tyranny of
individualism I A. Shiell and P. Hawe. Health Economics 1996;5(3):241-7.
The Healthy Cities Project: A challenge for health education I J. Ashton.
Health Education Quarterly 1991; 18(1 ):39-48.
Healthy Cities: Toward worldwide health promotion I B.C. Flynn.
Annual Review of Public Health 1996;17:299-309.
This review describes the status of Healthy Cities globally and presents
case studies.
Healthy Cities vision—An emerging global awareness and Indian
perspective I' V'.M. Gupta. Indian Journal of Public Health 1995;39(2):50-7.
A holosphere of healthy and sustainable communities I R. Labonte.
Australian Journal of Public Health 1993; 17( 1 ):4-12.
Learning to 'walk our talk': The implications of sociological theory for
research methodologies in health promotion I B.D. Poland. CanadianJournal
of Public Health. Revue Canadienne de SantePublique1992; 83 Suppl 1:S31-
46.
A discussion of the implications of recent shifts in health promotion
research for methodology.
New health promotion movement: A critical examination I A. Robertson
and M. Minkler. Health Education Quarterly 1994;21(3):295-312. This paper
explores the meanings of the ideas of the new health promotion movement and
explores implications for practice.

253
Nursing and health promotion: Conceptual concerns I F.G. Delaney.
Journal of Advanced Nursing 1994;20(5):828-35.
This essay considers the contribution of nursing to health promotion and
the usage of concepts of health promotion in nursing literature.
Older adults' experience of health promotion: A theory for nursing
practice I M. Frenn. Public Health Nursing 1996;13(1):65-71.
An outcomes approach to population health at the local level in NSW:
Practical problems and potential solutions I C. Rissel, J. Ward and P.
Sainsbury.AustralianHealth Review 1996; 19(2):23-39. Describes how the
Central Sydney Area Health Service has established a Needs Assessment &
Health Outcomes Unit to help improve health outcomes. Issues in working with
population health outcomes at the local level are discussed.
Powerlessness, empowerment, and health: Implications for health
promotion programs I N. Wallerstein. American Journal of Health
Promotion 1992;6(3): 197-205.
Reviews the health and social science research on the role of
powerlessness as a risk factor for disease, and the role of empowerment as a
health-enhancing strategy.
Program evaluation within a health promotion framework I J.C.
Thompson. Canadian Journal of Public Health/ Revue Canadienne de
SantePublique1992;83 Suppl 1:S67-71.
Realities of Health For All by the year 2000 I T. Rathwell. Social Science
& Medicine 1992;35(4):541-7.
Reviews the progress of Member States towards the Regional Health For
All goal.
Research in dental health education and health promotion: A review of
the literature. I L.F. Brown. Health Education Quarterly 1994;21(1):83-102.

254
Strategies for maintenance of health-promoting behaviours I A.R.
Redland and A.K. Stuifbergen. Nursing Clinics of North America
1993;28(2):427-42.
Strengthening individual and community capacity to prevent disease and
promote health: In search of relevant theories and principles I N. Freudenberg,
E. Eng, B. Flay, G. Parcel, T. Rogers, and N. Wallerstein. Health Education
Quarterly 1995;22(3):290-306.
A discussion of the relationship between theory and practice and its effect on
the current research agenda in health promotion.
Towards a research strategy to support public health programs
forbehaviour change I S. Redman. Australian & New Zealand Journal of
Public Health 1996;20(4):352-8.An analysis of research published by the
Australian Journal of Public Health and its utility for practitioners in building
effective programs

255
ANNOTATED BIBLIOGRAPHY (ARTICLES)
Advances in public health communication I E. Maibach& D.R. Holtgrave.
Annual Review of Public Health 1995;16:219-238.
Outlines the use of communication techniques and technologies to
influence individuals, populations and organizations for the purpose of
promoting conditions conducive to human and environmental health. Social
marketing, risk communication, behavioural decision theory, entertainment
education, media advocacy and interactive decision support systems are
discussed.
Canadian Conference on Dissemination Research: Strengthening health
promotion and disease prevention. Canadian Journal of Public Health
1996;87(suppl. 2).
Delivering the goods, showing our stuff: The case for a constructivist
paradigm for health promotion research and practice I R. Labonte and A.
Robertson. Health Education Quarterly 1996;23(4):431-47. This article
argues that there has been a tendency to empower the “conventional” positivist
paradigm in health promotion research, often at the expense of confounding or
ignoring much of health promotion practice. This article argues further that a
“constructivist” research paradigm not only has the potential to resolve some of
the tensions between research and practicein health promotion but also is
inclusive of knowledge generated by the conventional paradigm. The usefulness
of a constructivist paradigm is demonstrated through the use of four practice-
based case examples drawn from actual community-based health promotion
efforts. The congruence of a constructivist paradigm with the health promotion

256
principles of empowerment and community participation are discussed. Finally,
this article argues for the acceptance of the legitimacy of knowledge generated
from the constructivist paradigm and concludes that this paradigm is more
suited to the goals of current health promotion.
The effects of socio-economic status on exercise and smoking: Age-
related differences I Andrew V. Wister. Journal of Aging and Health,
1996;8(4):467-488.
Logistic regression analyses are performed on the 1990 Canadian Health
Promotion Survey to test whether: a) socio-economic status is associated with
risky life-style behaviours; and b) the effect of socio-economic status is greater
for younger and middle-aged groups than for older age groups. The results
indicate that socio-economic status affects health behaviours in relatively
important ways, but this depends on the measure (education, income, work
status), the specific behaviour, and the age group.
Health outcomes and health promotion: Defining success in health
promotion I D. Nutbeam.Health Promotion Journal of
Australia1996;6(2):58-60.
Health-promoting schools. Special Issue of World Health 1996; (July-
August): 3 lp.(English, French and Spanish)
This issue covers 23 articles advocating for increased investments in
school health promotion and for diffusing the concept of Health-Promoting
Schools on a global scale.
Intentions and changes in exercise behaviour: A life-style perspective I
Jean Q. Lock and Andrew V. Wister. Health Promotion International
1992;7(3):195-208.
This article analyzes intentions and reported improvement in exercise
behaviour using a set of explanatory variables for the purpose of comparing
several theoretical approaches: the social psychological approach; the
materialist framework; and the life-style/life-cycle perspectives.

257
Population health and health promotion: What do they have to say to
each other? Ron Labonte. Canadian Journal of Public Health
1995;86(3):165-68.
The author asserts that much of what is claimed in the name of population
health supports the concerns of health promotion. However he also argues that
there are some assumptions that may be at odds with those in health promotion
and that these assumptions should be debated. These concerns include
population health's emphasis on epidemiological methods, its economic
conservativism and its silence on ecological questions of overall economic
scale. Labonte's discussion outlines how population health differs from health
promotion in its underlying philosophy of approach.
Proceedings of the first International Seminar on National Health
Promoting Policies, Strategies, and Structures held in Paris from Nov. 21 -23,
1994. International Journal of Health Promotion and
Education1995;2(2/3).
The relationship between self-help group participation and other health
behaviours among older adults I Andrew V. Wister. Canadian Journal of
Community Mental Health 1995;14(2):23-38. (English with French abstract).
This paper provides an exploratory analysis of the relationship between
participation in self-help groups and other informal and formal strategies by
which individuals cope with stressful life events during later life.
Strengthening individual and community capacity to prevent disease and
promote health: In search of relevant theories and principles I N. Freudenberg,
E. Eng, B.R. Flay, G. Parcel, T. Rogers, N. Wallerstein. Health Education
Quarterly 1995;22(3):290-306.
The dominant theoretical models used in health education today are based
in social psychology. While these theories have increasingly acknowledged the
role of larger social and cultural influences in health behaviour, they have many
limitations. Theories seek to explain the causes of health problems, whereas

258
principles of practice, which are derived from practical experience, assist
intervenors to achieve their objectives. By elucidating the relationships between
theory and practice principles, it may be possible to develop more coherent and
effective interventions. The key research agenda for health education is to link
theories at different levels of analysis and to create theory-driven models that
can be used to plan more effective interventions in the complex environments in
which health educators work.
The World Health Organization Quality of Life Assessment (WHOQOL):
Position paper from the World Health Organization. The WHOQOL Group.
Social Science and Medicine 1995; 41(10): 1403-1409.
This paper describes the World Health Organization's project to develop a
quality of life instrument (the WHOQOL). It outlines the reasons that the
project was undertaken, the thinking that underlies the project, the method that
has been followed in its development and the current status of the project. The
WHOQOL assesses individuals' perception of their position in life in the
context of the culture and value systems in which the live and in relation to their
goals, expectations, standards and concerns. It has been developed
collaboratively in several culturally diverse centres over four years. Piloting of
the WHOQOL on some 4500 respondents in 15 culturally diverse settings has
been completed. On the basis of this data the revised WHOQOL Field Trial
Form has been finalized, and field testing is currently in progress. The
WHOQOL produces a multi-dimensional profile of scores across six domains
and 24 sub-domains of quality of life.

259
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

Evaluation
Tools
SUBJECT :NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

260
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

Preparation of
question paper
SUBJECT :NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

261
BLUE PRINT
FINAL YEAR BSC (NURSING) DEGREE EXAMINATION (Aug /Sep)
Gynaecological Nsg and Midwifery
SECTION A
Long Essays ( Answer and Two):---2 x 10= 20 marks
1) Discuss the current trend in MCH programme in India and explain the role of nurse in
MCH programme.
2) Defined Placenta, how it develop and its type. List out the abnormalities and functions
of placenta.
3) A 24yrs old Primi mother with 36 weeks of gestation came to the maternity clinic.
She has a complaint of back pain and sleep lost due to her pregnancy. Which areas
you will focus more while doing assessment and what health education you will give
to her.
SECTION B
Short Essays ( answer any eight) :---8 x 5=40marks.

1) Breast care
2) Ante natal exercises
3) Episiotomy and care
4) Infertility
5) Breast care
6) Newborn appraisal
7) Displacement of uterus
8) Ectopic pregnancy
9) Prolong labour
10) Explain in detail what are all the articles come under midwifery kit.
SECTION C
Short answers :---10 x 2=20 marks

1) Perineal care
2) Nursing care of patients with menstrual irregularities
3) Vaginal examination
4) VVF
5) Drugs used in obstetrics.
6) Breast feeding techniques
7) List out the complications of third stage of labour.
8) List out the causes of ectopic pregnancy.

262
9) Amniocentesis
10) Non stress Test.
BLUE PRINT FOR COGNITIVE DOMAIN:
Domains Total number Percentage

Knowledge 8 36%

Skill 7 31.8%

Comprehensive 3 13.6%

Understanding 2 9%

Application. 2 9%

BLUE PRINT FOR KNOWLEDGE QUESTIONNAIRE:


SL.NO UNIT DOMAINS QUESTION NOS.

1. Unit – I Knowledge (A) 1

(A) 2
2. Unit – Iv Comprehensive
(A)3,
(B) 1,2.
3. Unit—V Application
Skills
(B) 3
(B)3
4. Unit – VI Knowledge
Skills
(C)3
(C)5
5. Unit – VII Skills

263
skills (B) 6

(C) 1
6. Unit – VIII Skills
(B) 6
(B)7
7. Unit – XXI knowledge
Comprehensive
(C)
Knowledge

(C)7
8. Unit – X Understanding
(B)8

9. Unit – XII knowledge


(B)9
Knowledge

(C) 5
10. Unit – XV Knowledge
(B)10

11. Unit – XVI Comprehensive


(C) 2
Understanding (D)
(C) 4

12. Unit –XVII Application


(C) 9
(C) 10
13. Unit – XVIII Knowledge

14. Unit – XXVI Skills


Skills

264
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

OBJECTIVE TYPE TEST

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

265
OBJECTIVE TYPE TESTS

INTRODUCTION
When questions are formed with references to the objectives of instructions, the test
becomes objective centered or objective based. This type of test may contain essay type and
objective test items. To overcome some of the evil effects of essay type test, objective type
test seem to be very useful. Most of the modern educationalists lay much stress on objective
type tests to supplement the essay type it may not be objective centered if it is not planned
with reference to the objectives of instruction.

DEFINITION

Objective test items are items that can be objectively scored items on which persons
select a response from a list of options.
“W WIERSMA and G JURS, 1990”

ADVANTAGES OF OBJECTIVE TYPE TEST

 It can be scored objectively and easily. The scoring will not vary from time to time or
from examiner to examiner. The mood of the examiner in no way affects scoring.
 In this type, more extensive and representative sampling can be obtained. This
reduces the role of luck and cramming of expected question. They can be made to
cover more materials than traditional type.
 It possesses economy of time. It also saves a lot of time of the scorer.
 Students like them very much, because there is no question as to the accuracy of
marks they receive and there is no choice of bias or favoritism by teacher.
 It eliminates extraneous (irrelevant) factors such as speed of writing, fluency of
expression, literacy style, good hand writing neatness, etc.
 They discourage cramming and encourage thinking observation and scrutiny.
 It creates an incentive for pupils to building a broad base of knowledge, skills and
abilities.
 It measures the higher mental processes of understanding, application, analysis,
prediction and interpretation.

DISADVANTAGES OF OBJECTIVE TYPE TESTS


 Objectives like ability to organize matter, ability to present matter logically and in a
coherent fashion, etc. cannot be evaluated.
 Guessing is possible.
 The construction of adequate objective type test items is difficult. It requires special
abilities and is time consuming.

266
 Printing cost is considerably greater than that of an essay type test. Use of this type
test is very expensive.
CLASSIFICATION OF OBJECTIVE TYPE TESTS

1. Supply type or recall type:


 Short answer
 Completion
 Association
2. Selection type or recognition type:
 Alternate response test
 Matching
 Multiple choices
3. Context-dependent type:
 Pictorial form
 Interpretative

SHORT ANSWER TYPE ITEMS

The 3 common varieties of the short answer form are:-

 The question variety: here the item is presented as direct question. e.g. who is the
founder of modern nursing.
 The completion variety: here an incomplete statement is used. E.g.
sphygmomanometer is used to measure blood pressure.
 The association variety: here a few items are given outside the bracket. Students are
expected to write the exactly related response in the bracket. e.g. write the name of the
common instrument which measures the following temperature (…..), Blood pressure
(…..)

ALTERNATE-RESPONSE TYPE TESTS

An alternate response test item consist of a declarative statement that pupils is asked
to mark true or false, right or wrong, correct or incorrect, yes or no, fact or opinion, agree or
disagree and the like.
- The test items in this classification ask the students to match one meaning of a fact,
idea, concept, convention, or definition, with the one presented to him/her.
- The student is asked to accept or reject the statement given to them.
- This form of test item is used most often in relation to the recall level of cognition.

MULTIPLE CHOICE TYPE TEST ITEMS

A multiple choice item consists of a problem and a list of suggested solutions. The
problem may be stated as a direct question or an incomplete statement and is called the stem

267
of the item. The test of suggested solution may include words, number, phrases or symbols
and are called alternatives (also called choices or options). The student is typically requested
to read the stem and the list of alternatives and to select the one correct/best alternative.

A multiple choice item has 2 parts:


1. STEM: consisting of direct question or an incomplete statement, this is answered or
completed by one of the alternatives.

2. OPTIONS OR RESPONSES: There will be two or more alternatives consisting of


answers to questions or completion of the statement. In which there are ‘distracters’
and ‘key’. All incorrect and less appropriate alternatives are called as “distracters” or
foils. And the student task is to select the correct or best alternatives forms all options,
the correct or best alternatives called as ‘key’.

MATCHING TYPE TEST ITEMS

These items require students to match information in 2 columns. Items of left


hand column are called premises and those in the right hand column are called
responses. Students are required to locate the correct response for each premise.

CONCLUSION

To overcome some of the evil effects of essay type test, objective type test seems to
be very useful. Objective test items require students to work or select a correct or best
answer.

Objective type items are mainly divided into short answer type tests, alternate-
response type tests, multiple recognition choice and matching type test. Each of these has got
their own advantages and disadvantages.

268
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON
EASSAY TYPE TEST

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

269
SUBMITTED ON:

ESSAY TYPE TESTS


INTRODUCTION
Essay test is one of the oldest types of tests and have a long history that dates back to
more than four thousand years. Essay tests emphasize recall rather than recognition of the
correct alternative. Essay tests may require relatively brief responses or extended responses.
They have been used so widely that it is assumed that everybody understands their meaning.
USES OF ESSAY QUESTIONS
The distinctive feature of essay questions is the freedom of response.Students are free
to select, relate and present ideas in their own words.Although this freedom enhances the
value of essay questions it is a measure of factual knowledge. For most purposes, knowledge
of factual information can be more efficiently measured by some type of objective item. They
should be primarily used to measure those learning outcomes concerned with the abilities to
select, organize, integrate relate and evaluate ideas that require the freedom of response and
originality provided by essay question.
Essay questions allow varying degree of freedom of response. At one extreme, the
response is almost as restricted as that in the short-answer objective item, in which a sentence
or two may be all that is required. At the other extreme, the students are given almost
complete freedom in making their responses and their answers may require several pages.
And the variations in freedom of response tend to fall along a continuum between theses
extremes.
TYPES
Essay questions can be conveniently classified into two types:-
 The restricted response type
 The extended response type.
Restricted Response Questions
The restricted response question usually limits both the content and the response. The
content is usually restricted by the topic to be discussed. Limitations on the form of response
are generally indicated in the question.
Example
 State the main differences between Kwashiorkar and Marasmus.
 How good nutrition prevents pressure sore?

Because the restricted response question is more structured, it is most useful for
measuring learning outcomes requiring the interpretation and application of data in a specific
area. Unfortunately, the same restrictions make them less valuable as a measure of those

270
learning outcomes emphasizing integration, organization and originality.
Extended Response Questions
The extended response question allows pupils to select any factual information that
they think is pertinent, to organize the answer in accordance with their best judgment and to
integrate and evaluate ideas as they deem to appropriate. This freedom enables them to
demonstrate their ability to select, organize, integrate and evaluate ideas. On the other hand,
this same freedom makes the extended response question inefficient for measuring more
specific learning outcomes and introduces scoring difficulties that severely restrict its use as a
measuring instrument.
ADVANTAGES OF ESSAY TYPE QUESTIONS
 The main advantage of the essay question is that it measures complex learning
outcomes that cannot be measured by other means.
 It emphasizes on the integration and application of thinking and problem solving
skills.
 Because the students must present their answers in their own handwriting, the essay
test is often regarded as a device for improving writing skills.
 Another commonly cited advantage of the essay questions is its ease of construction.
LIMITATIONS
 The most serious limitation of the essay question is the unreliability of the scoring.
 Another limitation of essay questions is the amount of time required for scoring the
answers.
 Another shortcoming of essay questions is the limited sampling they provide. Only
few questions can be included in a given test so that some areas are measured
thoroughly, but others are neglected.
TIPS FOR CONSTRUCTING ESSAY TYPE QUESTIONS
i. Restrict the use of essay questions to those learning outcomes that cannot be
satisfactorily measured by objective items.
ii. Formulate questions that will call forth the behavior specified in the learning
outcomes.
iii. Phrase each question so that the student’s task is clearly indicated.
iv. The expected length of the answer of each question should be indicated on the test
form.
v. While preparing questions, it should be kept in mind that the maximumsubject matter
content is covered.
vi. The question should clearly indicate the significance of each part so that students may
determine the time to be devoted to each part. This can be done by dividing
thequestion into component parts and offering marks according to the significance.
vii. Avoid the use of optional questions.

SCORING ESSAY QUESTIONS


1. Prepare an outline of the expected answer in advance:
271
This should contain the major points to be included, the characteristics of the
answer to be evaluated and the amount of marks to be allotted to each preparing a
scoring key provides a common basis for evaluating the students’ answers and keeps
the standard stable throughout the scoring.

2. Use the scoring method that is most appropriate:


There are two common methods of scoring essay questions.One is called the
point method and the other the rating method. With the point method, each answer is
compared with the ideal answer in the scoring key and a given number of points are
assigned according to the adequacy of the answer. With the rating method, each paper
is placed in one of a number of piles as the answer is read.These piles might be used
ranging in value from eight points to none. Usually between five and ten categories
are used with the rating method. Restricted response questions can generally be
satisfactorily scored by the point method. The extended response question, however,
usually requires the rating method.

3. Decide how to handle factors that are irrelevant to the learning outcomes
beingmeasured:
Several factors influence our evolutions of answers to essay questions that are
not directly pertinent to the purposes of measurement. Prominent among these are
legibility of handwriting, spelling, sentence structure, punctuation and neatness. We
should make an effort to keep such factors from influencing our judgment when
evaluating the content of the answers. In some instances, such factors may, of course,
be evaluated for their own sake. When this is done, we should obtain a separate score
for written expression or for each of the specific factors. As far as possible, however,
we should not let such factors contaminate the extent to which our test scores reflect
the achievement of other learning outcomes. Another decision concerns the presence
of irrelevant factors is to decide in advance approximately how much the score on
each question is to be lowered when the inclusion of irrelevant material is excessive.

1. Evaluate all answers to one question before going to the next one:
One factor that contributes to unreliable scoring of essay questions is a shifting
of standards from one paper to the next. A paper with average answers may appear to
be of much higher quality when it follows a failing paper than when it follows one
with near perfect answers. One way to minimize this is to score all answers to the first
question, shuffle the papers, then score all answers to the second question and so on,
until all of the answers have been scored. A more uniform standard can bemaintained
with this procedure, because it is easier to remember the basis for judging each
answer and answers of various degrees of correctness can be more easily compared.
Evaluating all answers to one question at a time helps counteract another type
of error that creeps into the scoring of essay questions. When we evaluate all of the
answers on a single paper at one time, the first few answers create a general
impression of the student’s achievement that influence our judgment concerning the
remaining answers.Thus, if the first answers are of high quality, we tend to overrate
the following answers; whereas if they are of low quality, we tend to underrate them.
This “halo effect” is less likely when the answers for a given student are not evaluated

272
in continuous sequence.

5. Evaluate the answers without looking at the student’s name:


The general impression we form about each student during our teaching is also
a source of bias in evaluation essay questions. When possible, the identity of the
students should be concealed until all answers are scored.

6. If especially important decisions are to be based on the results, obtain two or


moreindependent ratings:
Sometimes essay questions are included in tests used to select students for
awards, scholarships, special train and the like. In such cases, two or more competent
persons should score the papers independently and their ratings should be
compared.After any large differences have been satisfactorily arbitrated the
independent ratings may be averaged for more reliable results.

CONCLUSION
Essay type evaluation provides an opportunity to demonstrate knowledge and ability
to organize ideas and express them effectively. It encourages the students to concentrate on
larger units of subject matter with special emphasis on the ability of the student to organize,
integrate and express ideas effectively.

273
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

PREPARATION OF
CLINICAL
EVALUATION TOOL
IN THE FORM OF
SUBJECT :NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:
274
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

RATING SCALE

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:
275
RATING SCALES
A rating scale is a method by which we systematize the expression of opinion
concerning a trait. The ratings are done by parents, teachers, a board of interviewers and
judges and by the self as well. The rating scale given an idea of the personality of an
individual.
ADVANTAGES OF RATING SCALES
 Rating scale is standard tool for recording qualitative and quantitative judgments
about observed performance.
 They measured specified outcomes or objectives of education deemed to be
significant or important to teacher.
 They evaluate procedures such as playing an instrument, operating an equipment or
machine, demonstrating the nursing procedures.
 They evaluate products such as typed letter, responses of demonstration, sample of
diagram, charts etc.
 They help teachers to rate their students periodically on various characteristics such as
punctuality, honesty, enthusiasm, cheerfulness, co-cooperativeness and other personal
traits.
 They can used by a student to rate him.
 They tend to be adaptable and flexible.
 They can use with a large number of students.
 They can help to reduce the subjectivity and unreliability that are usually associated
with observations method.

DISADVANTAGES OF RATING SCALE.


Rating scales have certain limitations that must be considered when a practice
evaluator is determining their use within the program.
 Since the scales are standardized procedures the item(behavior) listed may or may not
be consistent with stated objectives for a particular course or learning experience.
 There is a lack of uniformity with which terms are interpreted by the evaluator.
 There are several common sources of errors in rating scales. All of these sources
affect the validity of a rating, they are
1. Ambiguity.
2. Attitude of the rater.
3. Personality of the rater; Halo effect; personal bias; logical errors
4. Opportunity for adequate observation.
TYPES OF RATING SCALES.

Numerical rating scale:- This is one of the simplest types of the rating scales. The
rater simply marks a number that indicates the extent to which a characteristics of the

276
trait is present. The trait presented is a statement to each trait that is rated. Typically
common key is used throughout, the key providing verbal description.
Direction ;- encircles the appropriate number showing the extent to which the pupil
exhibits his skill in questioning.
5- outstanding, 4- above average., 3- average, 2- below average, 1- unsatisfactory.

Skill
I. Questions were specific 12345
II. Questions were relevant to topic discussed. 12345
III. Questions were grammatically correct 12345

Graphic rating scale;- the rater indicate the performer’s standing in respect to each
trail by placing a check mark at an appropriate point along the line. Here degree of
each characteristics is arranged so that the rater can make a time distinctions as he
wishes to make.
Eg;Graphic rating scale ;-
a) Were the illustrations used interesting ?
1 2 3 4 5
Too little little adequate much too much
b) How attentive were you in the class?

1 2 3 4 5
Very attentive inattentive - attentive very attentive.
Descriptive graphic rating scale - It provides for each trait a list of descriptive form which
the rater selects the one most applicable to the person on the item being rated. The description
also helps to clarify and further define a particular dimension.

Ranking -; in the ranking procedure the rater, instead of assigning a numerical value of each
student with regard to a characteristic, ranks a given set of individuals from high to low on
the characteristics is rated. To ensure that the pupils are validly ranked the ranks from both
extremes towards middle. This simplifies the task of a teacher. The ranking procedures
become very cumbersome when a large number of students or characteristics per student are
to be ranked.
DEVELOPING RATING SCALE FOR PERFORMANCE EVALUATION.
Steps in developing a rating scale for performance evaluation;
 Identify the course objectives.
 List the specific objectives.
 Enumerate the terminal/behavioral objectives.
 Describe the rating in qualitative and quantitative terms .
 Summarize the ratings by adding the scores.

277
 In order to place the student in different categories calculate total score

KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE & RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

CHECK LIST

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

278
CHECKLIST
Check list is a prepared list of statement selecting to behaviors traits, performance is some area or
practical work or a product of some performance life an art work. A list of statement is made which
are important in evaluation aspec
t of behaviors and checked to indicate presence or absence of particular quality.
Check list consist of listing of steps, activities or behaviors with the observers records when
an incident occurs. Check list can be systematic organized. They are used in evaluating
procedures products and aspects of personal social development, where an simple “present
absent’’ judgment.The check list enables the observer to note only whether or not trial or
characteristics in present. The observed action can be systematic, organized, step by step
procedures like doing laboratory procedures. It does not permit the observer to rates the
quality of a particular behavior or its frequency of occurrence or extract the particular
characteristics’ present.
UTILIZATION OF CHECK LIST.
While using checklists, evaluator should keep in mind the following.
 Use checklist only when you are interested in ascertaining whether a particular trait or
characteristic is present or absent.
 Use only carefully prepared check list for more complex kind of trait.
 Clearly specify the traits or characteristics of behavior, to be observed.
 Observe only one student at a time and confine your observation to the paints
specified in the check list.
 Check list the observers must be trained how to observe, what to observe and how to
recordthe observed behavior.

OBSERVATIONALCHECKLIST FOR EVALUATION OF STUDENT’S


PERFORMANCE DURINGI.V INFUSION ADMINISTRTION.
Name of the student; Date & time.
Year. Subject;
SI.NO BEHAVIOURS YES NO

1 Prepares patient psychologically and physically


a) Explains the procedure to the patient.
b) Review the physicians order for type and amount of I.V
fluid , rate of fluid administration and purpose of infusion.
c) Provides comfortable positions, and privacy if necessary.
d) Wash hands.
Organize equipments in the following way;

279
 Open sterile packets using aseptic techniques.
 Check the solution for color, clarity, and expiry date.
2.
 Check bag for leak.
 Open infusion set, maintain sterility of both ends of tubing.
 Place roller clamps about 2-5 cm below drip chamber and
move roller clamp to off position.
 Insert the canula into the bottle through the bottle cap after
cleaning with sprit swab.
 Hang the bottle on the IV stand.
 Removes the IV needle from the tubing’s allow the fluid to
run through the tubing to the kidney tray.
 Check the entire length of tubing to ensure that all air bubbles
are removed and keep it ready for fluid administrations.
 Select the vein.
 Place a small mackintosh under selected IV site
 Apply tourniquet 4-6 inches above the proposed insertion
site.
 Wash and dry hands.
 Clean the site with spirit swab using firm, circular
motion(middle to outward.)from touching the cleansed site.
 Insert the needle into the vein and remove the tourniquet.
 Look for blood return, quickly connect the needle adapter to
administration set.
 Release the roller clamp slowly to begin infusion at the rate
to maintain the patency of IV line.
 Tape or secure catheter or needle to the tubing with adhesive
plaster on the hug of the needle.
 Adjust the infusion to the desired rate,
 Removethe articles & replace it.
 Record the procedure.

Remarks

Signature of the clinical instructor :-

Signature of the student:-

280
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

ATTITUDE SCALE

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

281
ATTITUDE SCALE
Attitude 
In psychology, a mental position with regard to a fact or state. Attitudes reflect a tendency to
classify objects and events and to react to them with some consistency. Attitudes are not
directly observable but rather are inferred from the objective, evaluative responses a person
makes. Thus, investigators depend heavily on behavioral indicators of attitudes — what
people say, how they respond to questionnaires, or such physiological signs as changes in
heart rate. Attitude research is employed by social psychologists, advertising professionals,
and political scientists, among others. Public-opinion researchers often attempt to distinguish
attitudes from related concepts such as values, opinions, and knowledge.

Attitude Scales - Presentation Transcript


1. Types of Attitude Scales :
o Single item Scale

o Multi-item Scales

 Single item scales are those with which only one item is measured. The following are
the important single item scales:

1. Itemized Category Scales:


Are those in which respondents have to select an answer from a limited number of
ordered categories.
o Eg. A hotel customer is asked to indicate the level of satisfaction for the
service providedHighly Considerably Reasonably Unsatisfied
HighlySatisfied

2. Rank Order Scales : They are comparative scales where respondents were asked to rate an
item in comparison with another item or a group of items on a common criterion.
Example: Rank order scale for analysing Motor Cycles Rank the brands with 1 being the
brand that best meets the characteristics , 7 being the worst of the characteristics Brand
Affordable Cost High Mileage Stylish Great Pick up Hero Honda TVS Bajaj

3. Comparative Scales : The Researcher provides a point of comparison for respondents to


provide answers. Therefore, all respondents will have a uniform point of comparison for
selecting answers. Example: Respondent is asked to rate the sweet shop ‘X’ in
comparison to sweet shop ‘Y’ in Kochi: Excellent Very Good Good Both are same Poor
Very poor

282
4. Multi-item Scales : These are applied when it is difficult to measure people’s attitude
based on only one attribute. Eg. Ask a person whether he/she is satisfied with Indian
Railway. ‘ Overall I am satisfied’. ‘But there are many factors with which I am
dissatisfied.’ In such cases it is impossible to capture the complete picture with one
overall question.
5. Semantic Differential Scale :It is used to describe a set of beliefs that underline a
person’s attitude towards an object.This scale is based on the principle that
individuals think dichotomously or in terms of polar opposites such as reliable-
unreliable, modern-old fashioned etc.
Eg. Comparing four brands of car :
Mitsubishi(L) ; Hyundai(E) ; Skoda(O) ; Honda
o Fast -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Slow

o Large -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Small

o Plain -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Stylish

o In------------------------Out

o Expensive -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Expensive

6. Staple Scales : It is an attitude measure that places a single adjective or an attitude


describing an object in the centre of an even number of numerical values. Generally it is
constructed on a scale of 10 ranging from -5 to +5, without a neutral point ( zero ). It is
similar to Semantic Scale, except for it is single polar. This scale is useful for the
Researchers to understand the positive and negative intensity of attitudes of respondents.

7. Staple Scale Example - Measuring the attitude of Flight Passengers: +5 +5 +5 +4 +4 +4


+3 +3 +3 +2 +2 +2 +1 +1 +1 Friendly Cabin Comfortable Accurate Timings Crew
Interiors -1 -1 -1 -2 -2 -2 -3 -3 -3 -4 -4 -4 -5 -5 -5

8. 3) LikertScale : This scale consists of a series of statements where the respondent


provides answers in the form of agreement or disagreement. The respondent selects a
numerical score for each statement to indicate the degree of agreement or otherwise. Each
such score is finally added up to measure the respondents attitude.

9. Eg. of Likert Scale for evaluating the attitude of customers who have not used Vacuum
cleaner, but who have aware of its existence: Strongly Agree Agree Neutral Disagree
Strongly disagree The Product is costlier 1 2 3 4 5 I don’t find time to use it 1 2 3 4 5
Advt. is not convincing 1 2 3 4 5 Never use a V C 1 2 3 4 5 I am satisfied with the present
way of cleaning 1 2 3 4 5 Its use is cumbersome 1 2 3 4 5

283
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

OBJECTIVE STUCTURED CLINICAL


EXAM
SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

284
OBJECTIVE STUCTURED CLINICAL
EXAMINATION (OSCE)

DEFINITION
OSCE is an assessment tool in which the components of clinical competence such as history
taking, physical examination, simple procedures, interpretation of lab results, patient
management problems, communication, attitude etc. are tested using agreed checklists and
rotating the student round a number of stations some which have observers with check lists.
OSCE DESIGN
An OSCE usually comprises a circuit of short stations, in which each candidate is rated one-
to-one basis with one or two impartial examiners and either real or simulated patients actors.
Each station has a different examiner, as opposed to the traditional method of clinical
examinations where a candidate would be assigned to an examiner for the entire examination.
Candidates rotate through the stations, completing all the stations on their circuit.In this way
all candidates take the same stations. It is considered to be an improvement over traditional
examination methods because the stations can be standardized enabling fairer peer
comparison and complex procedures can be assessed without endangering patients health.
CHARACTERISTICS OF OSCE
As the name suggests , an OSCE is designed to be:
 Objective: All candidates are assessed using exactly the same stations with the same
marking scheme.
 Structured: OSCE is carefully structured to include parts of the elements of the
curriculum as well as a wide range of skills.
 A clinical examination: The OSCE is designed to applied clinical and theoretical
knowledge.
OSCE MARKING
Marking in OSCEs is done by the examiner.Ocassionally written stations are used and these
are marked like written examinations, again usually using a standardized mark sheet. One of
the ways an OSCE is made objective is by having a detailed mark scheme and standard set of
questions.The examiner is usually asked to rate the candidate as excellent/ good/ pass/
borderline/ fail.This is often then used to determine the individual pass mark for each station.

285
Many centres allocate each station an individual pass mark. The sum of the pass marks of all
the stations determines the overall pass mark for the OSCE. Many centres also impose a
minimum number of stations required to pass which ensures that a consistently poor
performance is not compensated by a good performance on a small number of stations.

PREPARATION
Preparing for OSCE is very different from preparing for an examination on theory. In AN
OSCE, clinical skills are tested rather than pure theoretical knowledge. It is essential to learn
correct clinical methods and then practice repeatedly until one perfects the methods. Marks
are awarded for each step in the method. It is often very helpful to practice in small groups
with colleagues,setting a typical OSCE scenario and timing it with one person role playing a
patient, one person doing the task and one person either observing and commenting on
technique or even role playing the examiner using a sample marksheet. In many OSCEs the
stations are extended using data interpretations.
OSCE METHODOLOGY
The OSCE examinations consisits of 15-20 stations each of which require about 4-5minutes
of time. All stations should be capable of being completed in the same time. The students are
rotated through all stations and have to move to the next station at the signal. Since the
stations are generally independent students can start at any procedure stations and complete
the cycle. Thus, using 15 stations of 4 minutes each, 15 students can complete the
examination within 1 hour.
Each station is designed to test a component of clinical competence . At some stations called
the procedure stations students are given tasks to perform on the patients. At all such stations
there are observers with agreed check lists to score the student’s performance. At other
stations called “responsive stations”, students respond to questions of the objective type or
interpret data or record their findings of the previous procedure station.
EXAMPLE
Task- Examine the specimen of urine provided for proteins.
Checklist-
1. Does he take a urine sample to 2/3rd level in the test tube?
2. Does he boil upper 1/3rd of the column?
3. Does he add 2% acetic acid drop by drop?
4. Does he compare changes in the top layer with the bottom layer of urine?
FEATURES OF OSCE
In summary, the main features of OSCE is that both the process and the product are tested
giving imporatance to individual competencies. The examination covers a broad range of
clinical skills much wider than a conventional examination. The scoring is objective, since
standards of competence are present and agreed check lists are used for scoring. Where
questions are asked in response stations, these are always objective. Simulations can be used

286
for acute cases and there is scope for immediate feedback. Patient variability and examiner
variability are eliminated thus increasing the validity of the examination.

ADVANTAGES
In addition to the above points, OSCE ensures integration of teaching evaluation. Variety
maintains students interest. There is increased faculty-student interaction. OSCE is adaptable
to local needs. A large number of students can be tested within a relatively short time.
LIMITATIONS
There is risk for observer fatigue if the observer has to record the performance of several
candidates on lengthy checklists. All stations must invariably demand only equal time.
Ensuring this, therefore, requires careful observation. Also, it is considered by many that
breaking clinical skills into individual competencies is artificial and not meaningful.

287
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

DEFFERENTIAL SCALE

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur
288
SUBMITTED ON:

DIFFERENTIAL SCALE
INTRODUCTION

The semantic differential (SD) is a technique developed during the 1940s and 1950s by
Charles E. Osgood to measure the meaning of language quantitatively. Words may have
different meanings to different individuals as a function of their experiences in the world. For
example, "poverty" has been experienced differently by 7-and 70-year-olds, and by the rich
and the homeless. Their expressions of understanding of poverty are modified by these
experiences. The SD captures these different meanings by providing some precision in how
our understanding of words differs.

DEFINITION:The Semantic Differential (SD) measures people's reactions to stimulus


words and concepts in terms of ratings on bipolar scales defined with contrasting adjectives at
each end.

DESCRIPTION

Semantic differential is a type of a rating scale designed to measure the connotative meaning
of objects, events, and concepts. The connotations are used to derive the attitude towards the
given object, event or concept. Osgood's semantic differential was designed to measure the
connotative meaning of concepts. The respondent is asked to choose where his or her position
lies, on a scale between two bipolar adjectives (for example: "Adequate-Inadequate", "Good-
Evil" or "Valuable-Worthless"). Semantic differentials can be used to describe not only
persons, but also the connotative meaning of abstract concepts—a capacity used extensively
in affect control theory. The Semantic Differential (SD) measures people's reactions to
stimulus words and concepts in terms of ratings on bipolar scales defined with contrasting
adjectives at each end.

The typical semantic differential test requires a subject to assess a stimulus word in terms of a
series of descriptive bipolar (e.g., good-bad) scales. The subject is asked to rate the stimulus
between the extreme and opposing adjectives that define the ends of these scales. Typically,
these bipolar scales have 5 or 7 points. The odd number allows the subject to choose a
midpoint or neutral ...

An example of an SD scale is:

289
Usually, the position marked 0 is labeled "neutral," the 1 positions are labeled "slightly," the
2 positions "quite," and the 3 positions "extremely." A scale like this one measures
directionality of a reaction (e.g., good versus bad) and also intensity (slight through extreme).
Typically, a person is presented with some concept of interest, e.g., Red China, and asked to
rate it on a number of such scales. Ratings are combined in various ways to describe and
analyze the person's feelings.

USE OF ADJECTIVES

The development of this instrument provides an interesting insight into the border area
between linguistics and psychology. People have been describing each other since they
developed the ability to speak. Most adjectives can also be used as personality descriptors.
The occurrence of thousands of adjectives in English is an attestation of the subtleties in
descriptions of persons and their behavior available to speakers of English. Roget's Thesaurus
is an early attempt to classify most adjectives into categories and was used within this context
to reduce the number of adjectives to manageable subsets, suitable for factor analysis.

EVALUATION, POTENCY, AND ACTIVITY

Osgood and his colleagues performed a factor analysis of large collections of semantic
differential scales and found three recurring attitudes that people use to evaluate words and
phrases: evaluation, potency, and activity. Evaluation loads highest on the adjective pair
'good-bad'. The 'strong-weak' adjective pair defines the potency factor. Adjective pair 'active-
passive' defines the activity factor. These three dimensions of affective meaning were found
to be cross-cultural universals in a study of dozens of cultures.

This factorial structure makes intuitive sense. When our ancestors encountered a person, the
initial perception had to be whether that person represents a danger. Is the person good or
bad? Next, is the person strong or weak? Our reactions to a person markedly differ if
perceived as good and strong, good and weak, bad and weak, or bad and strong.
Subsequently, we might extend our initial classification to include cases of persons who
actively threaten us or represent only a potential, danger, and so on. The evaluation, potency
and activity factors thus encompass a detailed descriptive system of personality. Osgood's
semantic differential measures these three factors. It contains sets of adjective pairs such as
warm-cold, bright-dark, beautiful-ugly, sweet-bitter, fair-unfair, brave-cowardly, meaningful-
meaningless.

The studies of Osgood and his colleagues revealed that the evaluative factor accounted for
most of the variance in scalings, and related this to the idea of attitudes.

METHODOLOGY

A number of basic considerations are involved in SD methodology:

290
(1) Bipolar adjective scales are a simple, economical means for obtaining data on people's
reactions. With adaptations, such scales can be used with adults or children, persons from all
walks of life, and persons from any culture.

(2) Ratings on bipolar adjective scales tend to be correlated, and three basic dimensions of
response account for most of the co-variation in ratings. The three dimensions, which have
been labeled Evaluation, Potency, and Activity (EPA), have been verified and replicated in an
impressive variety of studies.

(3) Some adjective scales are almost pure measures of the EPA dimensions; for example,
good-bad for Evaluation, powerful-powerless for Potency, and fast-slow for Activity. Using a
few pure scales of this sort, one can obtain, with considerable economy, reliable measures of
a person's overall response to something. Typically, a concept is rated on several pure scales
associated with a single dimension, and the results are averaged to provide a single factor
score for each dimension. Measurements of a concept on the EPA dimensions are referred to
as the concept's profile.

(4) EPA measurements are appropriate when one is interested in affective responses. The
EPA system is notable for being a multi-variate approach to affect measurement. It is also a
generalized approach, applicable to any concept or stimulus, and thus it permits comparisons
of affective reactions on widely disparate things. EPA ratings have been obtained for
hundreds of word concepts, for stories and poems, for social roles and stereotypes, for colors,
sounds, shapes, and for individual persons.

(5) The SD has been used as a measure of attitude in a wide variety of projects. Osgood, et
al., (1957) report exploratory studies in which the SD was used to assess attitude change as a
result of mass media programsand as a result of messages structured in different ways . The
SD has been used by other investigators to study attitude formation , attitudes toward
organizations , attitudes toward jobs and occupations and attitudes toward minorities. The
results in these, and many other studies, support the validity of the SD as a technique for
attitude measurement.

COMPARISON OF LIKERT SCALE WITH SEMANTIC DIFFERENTIAL

Both types of scales can assess attitudes, but have different formats.

Likert (summated rating) scale

Fixed response choices (e.g., agreement or frequency)

Items concern different aspects or descriptions of target

Semantic differential

Fixed target for attitude evaluation

Items are bipolar adjectives that concern target

291
Example

Objective: Determine attitudes about USF

Likert

1 = Strongly disagree4 = Slightly agree

2 = Moderately disagree5 = Moderately agree

3 = Slightly disagree6 = Strongly agree

1. USF is an interesting place 123456

2. USF is a good university 123456

3. Going to USF was a mistake on my part 123456

4. I’m glad I’m attending USF 123456

5. USF is a great school 123456

6. The quality of classes at USF is poor 123456


Semantic Differential

 The following items refer to: USF

 Good __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ Bad

Boring __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ Interesting

Weak __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ Strong

Active __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ Passive

Like __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ Dislike

Large __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ Small

292
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

SUMMATED SCALE

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

293
SUBMITTED ON:

Summated Scales
Introduction
• The numerical values assigned to the response categories for each question are simply
added to produce a single scale score. The summated scale approach theoretically
works because persons who are very strongly favorable toward some idea, will more
often select positive response categories, while those who have more neutral ideas
will select some positive and some negative categories. Finally, it is assumed that
those persons who are opposed to the concept being measured will respond by
selecting those statements which reflect a negative position.

• The most common form of summated scale is the Likert Scale, developed by Rensis
Likert in 1932. Typically, a number of statements are developed which are thought to
reflect positive and negative attitudes toward some concept

Meaning
ALikertscaleconsists of severaldeclarative items that express a viewpoint on a
topic respondents are asked to indicate the degree to which they agree to which they
agree or disagree with the opinion expressed by the statement.
Definition
• “Summated scale consists of a series of scalded items where each item is scored in
approximately the same way the scale scores are added to derive a total score.”

• Each question is then written with a number of response categories. The most
common type is the 4 point Likert Scale-

(1) strongly agree,


(2) agree,
(3) disagree, and
(4) disagree.
An individual's score would be computed by adding the values assigned to
each of the responses selected for all of items of the scale.

294
Construction of summated scale
• The researcher gathers a large number of statements which clearly indicate
favorableor unfavorable attitude towards the issue inquestion.

• The responseswill imply various scores. The scores are consistently arranged either
from the highest to the lowest ,or from the lowest to the highest.

• By adding up the different scores of an individual , his total score is calculated.


(summation of different scores for different statements)

• The questionnaire consisting of the five points scale which respect to a statement are
administered to the respondents who indicate their responses.

COMPARISON OF LIKERT SCALE WITH SEMANTIC DIFFERENTIAL

Both types of scales can assess attitudes, but have different formats.

Likert (summated rating) scale

Fixed response choices (e.g., agreement or frequency)

Items concern different aspects or descriptions of target

Semantic differential

Fixed target for attitude evaluation

Items are bipolar adjectives that concern target

Example

Objective: Determine attitudes about USF

Likert

1 = Strongly disagree4 = Slightly agree

2 = Moderately disagree5 = Moderately agree

3 = Slightly disagree6 = Strongly agree

1. USF is an interesting place 123456

2. USF is a good university 123456

295
3. Going to USF was a mistake on my part 123456

4. I’m glad I’m attending USF 123456

5. USF is a great school 123456

6. The quality of classes at USF is poor 123456

KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &


RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

ANECDOTAL RECORD

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

296
SUBMITTED ON:

ANECDOTAL RECORD.
DEFINITION.
‘’Anecdotal record is a record of some significant item of conduct, a record of an episode in
the life of student, a word picture of the student in action, a word snapshot at the moment of
the incident, any narration of event in which may be significant about the personality.’’

-Randall.
Anecdotal record, as the name implies, involves setting down an anecdote concerning some
aspects of student behavior which seems significant to the observer.

CHARECTERISTICS OF ANECDOTAL RECORDS;-


Anecdotal records must possess certain characteristics ‘as given below.-
1) They shouldcontain a factual description of what happened, when it happened, and
under what circumstances the behavior occurred.
2) The interpretations and recommended action should be noted separately from the
description.
3) Each anecdotal record should contain a record of single incident.
4) The incident recorded should considered significant to the students growth and
development.

MERITS OF ANECDOTAL RECORDS;-


 These records help in clinical service practices.
 They provided factual record.
 They stimulate teacher to use the records and contribute to them.
 They record critical incidents of spontaneous behavior in natural selling.
 They provide the teacher with objective description.
 They are very good for young children, who are unable to prepare pencil test.
 They direct the teachers attention to a single student.
 They provide commutative record of growth and development.

297
 They provide specific and exact description of personality and minimize
generalizations.
 The new members may use these records and acquaint themselves with the student.

DEMERITS OF ANECDOTAL RECORDS;-

 They tend to be less reliable than other observational tools as they lent to be
less formal and systematic.
 They are time consuming to write.
 It is difficult for the observer to maintained objectivity when he/she records
the incident observed.
 When incidents are noted and read out of context, they may lose.(meaning.
 They do not reveal the cause.
 The observer tends to record only undesirable incidents and neglect a positive
incidents.

FORMAT OF THE ANECDOTAL RECORD.

Name of the school/college :-

Name of the student observed :- Class :- Subject:-


Name of the observer :- Date & place :-
Objective description :-

Comments of the observer :-

Interpretation :-

Recommendations :-

Signature of the observer :-

Signature of the student ;-

298
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

Observe
&Practice
SUBJECT :NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

299
SUBMITTED ON:

KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &


RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

INTELLIGENCE TEST

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur
300
SUBMITTED ON:

INTELLIGENCE TEST

INTRODUCTION
The use of intelligence tests has greatly increased in these days. People have started to
realise the importance of the measuring intelligence tests.
DEFINITION
A questionnaire or series of exercises designed to measure intelligence. It is generally
understood that intelligence tests are less a measure of innate ability to learn as of what the
person tested has already learned. There are many types of intelligence tests, and they may
measure learning and/or ability in a wide variety of areas and skills. Scores may be presented
as an IQ (intelligence quotient), a mental age, or on a scale.
PURPOSE
The goal of intelligence tests is to obtain an idea of the person's intellectual potential.
The tests center around a set of stimuli designed to yield a score based on the test maker's
model of what makes up intelligence. Intelligence tests are often given as a part of a battery
of tests.

ADVANTAGES

In general, intelligence tests measure a wide variety of human behaviors better than
any other measure that has been developed. They allow professionals to have a uniform way
of comparing a person's performance with that of other people who are similar in age. These
tests also provide information on cultural and biological differences among people.

Intelligence tests are excellent predictors of academic achievement and provide an


outline of a person's mental strengths and weaknesses. Many times the scores have revealed
talents in many people, which have led to an improvement in their educational opportunities.
Teachers, parents, and psychologists are able to devise individual curricula that matches a
person's level of development and expectations.

DISADVANTAGES

301
Some researchers argue that intelligence tests have serious shortcomings. For
example, many intelligence tests produce a single intelligence score. This single score is
often inadequate in explaining the multidimensional aspects of intelligence. Another problem
with a single score is the fact that individuals with similar intelligence test scores can vary
greatly in their expression of these talents. It is important to know the person's performance
on the various subtests that make up the overall intelligence test score. Knowing the
performance on these various scales can influence the understanding of a person's abilities
and how these abilities are expressed. For example, two people have identical scores on
intelligence tests. Although both people have the same test score, one person may have
obtained the score because of strong verbal skills while the other may have obtained the score
because of strong skills in perceiving and organizing various tasks.

Furthermore, intelligence tests only measure a sample of behaviors or situations in


which intelligent behavior is revealed. For instance, some intelligence tests do not measure a
person's everyday functioning, social knowledge, mechanical skills, and/or creativity. Along
with this, the formats of many intelligence tests do not capture the complexity and immediacy
of real-life situations. Therefore, intelligence tests have been criticized for their limited ability
to predict non-test or nonacademic intellectual abilities. Since intelligence test scores can be
influenced by a variety of different experiences and behaviors, they should not be considered
a perfect indicator of a person’s intellectual potential.

DESCRIPTION

When taking an intelligence test, a person can expect to do a variety of tasks. These
tasks may include having to answer questions that are asked verbally, doing mathematical
problems, and doing a variety of tasks that require eye-hand coordination. Some tasks may be
timed and require the person to work as quickly as possible. Typically, most questions and
tasks start out easy and progressively get more difficult. It is unusual for anyone to know the
answer to all of the questions or be able to complete all of the tasks. If a person is unsure of
an answer, guessing is usually allowed.

The four most commonly used intelligence tests are:-

 Stanford-Binet Intelligence Scales


 Wechsler-Adult Intelligence Scale
 Wechsler Intelligence Scale for Children
 Wechsler Primary & Preschool Scale of Intelligence

INTERPRETING THE RESULTS

The person's raw scores on an intelligence test are typically converted to standard
scores. The standard scores allow the examiner to compare the individual's score to other
people who have taken the test. Additionally, by converting raw scores to standard scores the
examiner has uniform scores and can more easily compare an individual's performance on
one test with the individual's performance on another test. Depending on the intelligence test
that is used, a variety of scores can be obtained. Most intelligence tests generate an overall
intelligence quotient or IQ. As previously noted, it is valuable to know how a person

302
performs on the various tasks that make up the test. This can influence the interpretation of
the test and what the IQ means. The average of score for most intelligence tests is 100.

PRECAUTIONS
There are many different types of intelligence tests and they all do not measure the
same abilities. Although the tests often have aspects that are related with each other, one
should not expect that scores from one intelligence test, that measures a single factor, will be
similar to scores on another intelligence test, that measures a variety of factors. Also, when
determining whether or not to use an intelligence test, a person should make sure that the test
has been adequately developed and has solid research to show its reliability and validity.
Additionally, psychometric testing requires a clinically trained examiner. Therefore, the test
should only be administered and interpreted by a trained professional.
A central criticism of intelligence tests is that psychologists and educators use these
tests to distribute the limited resources of our society. These test results are used to provide
rewards such as special classes for gifted students, admission to college, and employment.
Those who do not qualify for these resources based on intelligence test scores may feel angry
and as if the tests are denying them opportunities for success. Unfortunately, intelligence test
scores have not only become associated with a person's ability to perform certain tasks, but
with self-worth.
CONCLUSION
Many people are under the false assumption that intelligence tests measure a person's
inborn or biological intelligence. Intelligence tests are based on an individual's interaction
with the environment and never exclusively measure inborn intelligence. Intelligence tests
have been associated with categorizing and stereotyping people. Additionally, knowledge of
one's performance on an intelligence test may affect a person's aspirations and motivation to
obtain goals. Intelligence tests can be culturally biased against certain groups.

303
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

APTITUDE TEST

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:
304
APTITUDE TESTS
INTRODUCTION
Aptitude tests measure or assess the degree or level of one’s special bent or flair much the
same way as intelligence tests are employed or measuring one’s intelligence. They are chiefly
used to estimate the extent to which an individual would profit from a specific course or
training, or to predict the quality of his or her achievement in a given situation.
APTITUDE TESTS
The capacity to learn is known as aptitude. Hence an aptitude test measure probable
accomplishment at some future date, following training. A test of flying aptitude predicts
how well a person will perform as a pilot after he or she has been trained . In contrast,
achievement refers to the individuals current level of accomplishment. A test of flying
achievement indicates a person’s present success as a pilot; it tells how well the person
performs at this moment.
Two types of aptitude tests are usually employed. These are
 Specialized aptitude tests.
 General aptitude tests

SPECIALISED APTITUDE TESTS


These aptitude tests have been devised to measure the aptitudes of individual in various
specific fields or activities. Generally these tests can be divided into
1. mechanical aptitude tests
2. musical aptitude tests.
3. art judgment tests
4. professional aptitude tests
5. scholastic aptitude tests

GENERAL APTITUDE TESTS


The General Aptitude Test Battery (GATB)and the Differential Aptitude Test (DAT)
are two examples of such tests. GATB .developed by the Employment Service Bureau
of USA, contains 12 tests.8 of these are
 Paper – pencil tests, for name comparison, computation, vocabulary,
arithmetic, reasoning, form matching, test matching, and three dimensional

305
space. the other 4 require the use of simple equipment in the shape of movable
pegs on a board, assembling and disassembling rivets and washers. From the
scores obtained by the subject, the experimenter is able to draw inferences
about the nine aptitude factors; intelligence, verbal aptitude, numerical
aptitude, spatial aptitude from perception, clerical perception, motor
coordination, finger dexterity and manual dexterity. The GATB has proved to
be one of the most successful multiple aptitude batteries particularly for the
purposes of job classification.
 The DAT developed by the US Psychological cooperation, has been adapted
in Hindi for use in India by SM. Ojha; by 2 forms. It includes tests for verbal
reasoning, numerical ability, abstract reasoning spatial relation, mechanical
reasoning, clerical speed and accuracy and two tests for language, one for
spelling and other for grammar. DAT has proved very successful in predicting
academic success and has been found speciallyuseful for providing
educational and vocational guidance program to secondary school children.

2Sample Structure of the Nursing Aptitude Tests with SampleQuestions

Nursing career is getting attention all around the world. However, unlike mechanical and
technical professions you need some qualities of heart for nursing jobs. The best in the
nursing services have been generous, loving and compassionate.

Still nursing career is not considered personal because it involves a lot of team work. You
will have to take care of physically or mentally ill people. You have to perform in different
roles such as a disciplined care giver, a counselor, a manager, a teacher etc. Your every action
shall focus upon benevolence of the patients.

Furthermore, you need not only to be responsible and dependable but also capable to accept
truths of death and life.

Main Areas of Nursing Aptitude Tests

Most of the nursing jobs screen you through nursing aptitude tests. The psychologists build
them around the following main areas:

Applied Sciences

1- Physics

The multiple choice questionnaire tries to measure your comprehensions for mechanics,
measurements, laws of thermodynamics, acceleration, momentum etc.

306
2- Organic and Inorganic Chemistry

You have to take care of the patients with certain medicines and chemicals. You are expected
to know basics of solvents, electrons, titration, periodic table etc.

Daly Life Science

You need to learn basics of TCA cycle, ATP, cardiac control, human nervous system,
endocrine glands, ECG basics, cardiovascular system, lungs and respiratory effects, thyroid
hormones, etc. You are expected to hear and use these basic things about the human medical
science for your life long nursing career.

Vocabulary Skills

The nursing career requires you to have correct knowledge of different words. Sometimes,
your wrong perception of words can put lives of the patients in severe danger. That’s why
vocabulary skills are tested with nursing aptitude test.

Mathematics Skills

Though the nursing aptitude tests include only a portion of math to test your mathematical
reasoning but it is still a important to know about real numbers, fractions, trigonometry, area
calculations, logarithmic scale etc.

Reading Comprehension

In your nursing career you will have often to read the instructions issued by the doctors
during their visits. When you fail to comprehend the simple instructions, you can’t help the
patients in any way. So your reading comprehension is also tested before you qualify for
entry level nursing jobs.

Analytical Reasoning

Your analytical reasoning capability helps you to take quick decisions in emergencies and
daily life nursing services. Most of the nursing aptitude tests include this portion understand
you before you are selected for a nursing career.

UTILITY OF APTITUDE TESTS.


1. Aptitude tests are the back-bone of the guidance services.
2. the results of these tests enable us to locate with a reasonable degree of certainty, the field
of activity in which an individual would be most likely to be successful.
3. These tests are found to be very useful for vocational and educational selection,
4. They helps in the systemic selection of suitable candidates for the various educational and
professional courses as well as for specialized job.

307
5. Aptitude tests are thus properly anticipate the future potentials of individual
6. Tests help us in selecting individuals who are likely to benefit most from the pre-
professional training or experiences.

tests can help to a great extent, in avoiding considerable waste of human as well as material
resources by placement of individuals in places and lines ofin which they are most likely to
be productive

KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &


RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

PESONALITY TEST

308
PERSONALITY TESTS
I. INTRODUCTION
Personality has a significant role to play in deciding whether you have the enthusiasm
and motivation that the employer is looking for. It also determines how well you are going to
fit in to the organization, in terms of your personality, attitude and general work style. In
most working situations it’s the personalities of the people involved thataffect the day-to-day
success of the organization. If a manager can’t motivate their staff or the team doesn't work
well together, then quality of service and productivity will suffer.

II. MEANING
The word personality is derived from Greek word “Persona”, which meant for the
mask used by actors in Greek drama. Personality is the total quality of an
individual’sbehavior as it shown in his habits of thinking, in his attitude, interests, his manner
of acting and his personal philosophy of life.
It is the totality of his being. It is more than the sum total of an individual traits and
characteristics. It is expressed through his behavior.

DEFINITION
1. Personality may be defined as “the most characteristic integration of an individual’s
structure, modes of behavior, interests, attitudes, capacities, abilities and aptitudes.
- Munn N. L.

2. “Personality is the dynamic organization within the individual of those psychosocial


systems that determine his unique adjustment to his environment”.
- Gordon Allport (1937).

3. “Personality consists of the distinctive patterns of behavior (including thought and


emotions) that characterize each individual’s adaptation to situations of his or her
life”.

309
- Walter Mischel

III. TYPES OF PERSONALITY


The personality can be classified through type approach and trait approach.
By type approach
a. Types based on temperament
Hippocrates (about 400 BC) the father of medicine, classified people in to four types
as per temperament depending in which one of one’s bodily humors orfluids they
believe to predominate.
 Sanguine – Cheerful, vigorous, confident and optimistic (Blood).
 Phlegmatic – Calm, slow moving, unexcitable, unemotional (Mucus).
 Choleric – Irritable, hot tempered (Yellow bile).
 Melancholic – Depressed, morose (Black bile).

b. Types based on body build


Kretschmer (1925) divided people into 3 types according to the body built.
 Asthenic: introvert, tall, thin, sensitive.
 Athletic: active, aggressive, well developed muscular body.
 Pyknic: extrovert, round and fat.

William Sheldon (1954) divided people into three types according to body build.
 Endomorph: Plumb, soft, fat and round-sociable even tempered
andrelaxed like (Santa Claus)
 Mesomorph: Heavy set and muscular- physically active and noisy.
 Ectomorph: Tall, thin, and flat-chest – self-conscious, shy, fond
ofsolitude and reserved.

By psychological types
On the basis of sociability Dr. Karl G. Jung classified people in to two main groups. Such as
a. Introverts
Introverts are those who are interested in themselves, their own feelings, emotions and
reactions. They are busy in their own thoughts and are self-centered. They are reserved and
like to work alone. They are very sensitive and are unable to adjust easily to social situations.
They are inclined to worry and easily get to social situations. They are inclined to worry and
easily get embarrassed. Poets, philosophers, scientists and artist belong to this group.

310
b. Extroverts
Extroverts are people who take more interest in others and like to move with people
and are skilled in etiquette. They are friendly and sociable and not easilyupset by difficulties.
They are dominated by emotions, whereby they take decisions quickly and act on them
without delay. They are realistic and face the problems of life objectively.
There are few people who are pure extroverts or introverts. Majority of the people are
ambiverts having the qualities of extroverts and introverts in different proportions.

IV. PERSONALITY TRAITS


In trying to understand these behavior patterns, psychologists attempt to identify and
measure individual personality characteristics, often called personality traits.
In 1990, the psychologists Costa & McCrae published details of a '5 trait' model. This
has received significant support from other research and is now widely accepted among
psychologists. These 5 aspects of personality are referred to as the 5-factors or sometimes just
‘the Big 5’.
These 5 traits/factors (OCEAN) are:
 Openness to Experience - Tendency to be speculative and imaginative.
People who score high on this factor are neophile and curious and sometimes
unrealistic. People who score low on this factor are down-to-earth and practical and
sometimes obstructive of change.

 Conscientiousness - How “structured” one is.


People who score high on this factor are usually productive and disciplined and
“single tasking”. People who score low on this factor are often less structured,
lessproductive, but can be more flexible, inventive, and capable of multitasking.

 Extraversion - How “energetic” one is.


People, who score high on this factor like to work in cooperation with others, are
talkative, enthusiastic and seek excitement. People who score low on this factor prefer to
work alone, and can be perceived as cold, difficult to understand, even a bit eccentric.

 Agreeableness - One’s level of orientation towards other people.


Those who score high on this factor are usually co-operative, can be submissive,
and are concerned with the well-being of others. People who score low on this factor may
be challenging, competitive, sometimes even argumentative.

311
 Neuroticism - Tendency to worry.
People who score low on this factor are usually calm, relaxed and rational. They
may sometimes be perceived as lazy and incapable of taking things seriously. People who
score high on this factor are alert, anxious, sometimes worried.

All 5 personality traits exist on a continuum rather than as attributes that a person
does or does not have. Each of these 5 traits is made up 6 facets, which can be measured
independently.

Sl. No Personality Factor Facets


Friendliness
Gregariousness
Assertiveness
1. Extraversion
Activity Level
Excitement-Seeking
Cheerfulness
Trust
Morality
Altruism
2. Agreeableness
Cooperation
Modesty
Sympathy
Self-Efficacy
Orderliness
Dutifulness
3. Conscientiousness Achievement-
Striving
Self-Discipline
Cautiousness
Anxiety
Anger
Depression
4. Neuroticism
Self-Consciousness
Immoderation
Vulnerability
5. Openness to experience Imagination
Artistic Interests
Emotionality
Adventurousness
Intellect

312
Liberalism

When thinking about personality traits it is important to ignore the positive or


negative associations that these words have in everyday language. For example,
Agreeableness is obviously advantageous for achieving and maintaining popularity.
Agreeable people are better liked than disagreeable people. On the other hand,
agreeableness is not useful in situations that require tough or totally
objectivedecisions. Disagreeable people can make excellent scientists, critics, or
soldiers.

V. ASSESSMENT OF PERSONALITY

1. TECHNIQUES OF PERSONALITY ASSESSMENT


Personality testing is done for various reasons. A clinical psychologist often usespersonality
tests to evaluate psychological disorders. Personality tests do not have “right” and “wrong”
answers. Instead they seek answers that will reveal people’s characteristic tendencies or
behavior.
The techniques of personality assessment can be divided into five categories:
1. Where one can see how the individual behaves in actual life situations:
 Observations technique
 Situation technique
2. Where one can find out what an individual says about himself:
 Autobiography
 Questionnaire/personality inventory
 Interview
3. Techniques by which one can find out what others say about the individual whose
personality is under assessment. Case history taking, i.e. extracting information
 Biography
 Rating scales
 Sociometry.
4. Techniques by which one can find how an individual reacts to an imaginativesituation
involving fantasy. For example, projective methods.
5. Techniques by which one can indirectly determine some personality variables in
terms of psychological responses by measuring instruments.

313
2. METHODS OF PERSONALITY ASSESSMENT
The following are some of the tests used for evaluation and measurement of personality traits:

A. PENCIL AND PAPER TESTS


The most convenient kind of measures to use for almost any psychological
purpose is a pencil and paper test in the form of questionnaire or inventory. Such tests
can be given cheaply and quickly to large groups of people, and consequently
psychologists have constructed a wide variety of them.

The following are the types of personality tests.


i. INTERVIEWS
Interview is the most popular method of observation. Appearance, bearing and
speech can be noticed. Questions can be asked about attitudes and interests.
Interviews are used to evaluate a person’s personality for the purpose of employment
and for education as well as for identifying personality trait. An interview may be
informal or unstructured. It can be formal or structured, where specific topics are
selected by the interviews before and the flow of conversation is controlled.
Body language may of the client be able to be observed during an interview.
The body language may be posture, movement of the hands, facial expression or
voice. Howeverinterviews take place under stress and great skill is needed to put the
interviewee at ease.

ii. QUESTIONNAIRES
This is the most common written method of measuring personality. A
personalityinterview is a questionnaire in which the person reports his or her feeling
in certainsituations. They are very easily checked and scored. More often the answers
are scored by machines which eliminate the prejudice of the taster, making the test
more objective.

iii. MINESOTA MULTIPLE PERSONALITY INVENTORY (MMPI)

The Minnesota Multiphasic Personality Inventory (MMPI) is one of the most


frequently used personality tests in mental health. The test is used by trained
professionals to assist in identifying personality structure and psychopathology.

 History
The MMPI was developed in the 1930s at Minnesota University as a serious
and comprehensive personality test that can be used to detect psychiatric problems.
This test asks for answers of “True”, “False” or “cannot say” to 567 statements about

314
different personality traits such as attitudes, emotional reactions, physical and
psychological symptoms and past experiences. The answers are quantitatively
measured and personality assessment is done based on the norm scores.
It was revised in 1989 as MMPI-2 and a version for adolescents developed
(MMPI-A). There is also an abbreviated version (MMPI-3).
Dr HN Murthy of NIMHANS, Bangalore has reduced it to 100 items called
multiphase questionnaire (MQ). Personality questionnaires are used in psychology for
counseling and research. They are used for selection for employment or promotion.

 10 Scales of the MMPI


The MMPI has 10 clinical scales that are used to indicate different psychotic
conditions. Despite the names given to each scale, they are not a pure measure since
many conditions have overlapping symptoms. Because of this, most psychologists
simply refer to each scale by number.

 Scale 1 – Hypochondriasis: This scale was designed to asses a neurotic concern


over bodily functioning. The 32-items on this scale concern somatic symptoms
and physical well being. The scale was originally developed to identify patients
displaying the symptoms of hypochondria.

 Scale 2 – Depression: This scale was originally designed to identify depression,


characterized by poor morale, lack of hope in the future, and a general
dissatisfaction with one's own life situation. Very high scores may indicate
depression, while moderate scores tend to reveal a general dissatisfaction with
one’s life.
 Scale 3 – Hysteria: The third scale was originally designed to identify those who
display hysteria in stressful situations. Those who are well educated and of a high
social class tend to score higher on this scale. Women also tend to score higher
than men on this scale.

 Scale 4 - Psychopathic Deviate: Originally developed to identify psychopathic


patients, this scale measures social deviation, lack of acceptance of authority, and
amorality. This scale can be thought of as a measure of disobedience. High scorers
tend to be more rebellious, while low scorers are more accepting of authority.
Despite the name of this scale, high scorers are usually diagnosed with a
personality disorder rather than a psychotic disorder.

 Scale 5 – Masculinity/Femininity: This scale was designed by the original


author’s to identify homosexual tendencies, but was found to be largely
ineffective. High scores on this scale are related to factors such as intelligence,
socioeconomic status, and education. Women tend to score low on this scale.

315
 Scale 6 – Paranoia: This scale was originally developed to identify patients with
paranoid symptoms such as suspiciousness, feelings of persecution, grandiose
self-concepts, excessive sensitivity, and rigid attitudes. Those who score high on
this scale tend to have paranoid symptoms.

 Scale 7 – Psychasthenia: This diagnostic label is no longer used today and the
symptoms described on this scale are more reflective of obsessive-compulsive
disorder. This scale was originally used to measure excessive doubts,
compulsions, obsessions, and unreasonable fears.

 Scale 8 – Schizophrenia: This scale was originally developed to identify


schizophrenic patients and reflects a wide variety of areas including bizarre
thought processes and peculiar perceptions, social alienation, poor familial
relationships, difficulties in concentration and impulse control, lack of deep
interests, disturbing questions of self-worth and self-identity, and sexual
difficulties. This scale is considered difficult to interpret.

 Scale 9 – Hypomania: This scale was developed to identify characteristics of


hypomania such as elevated mood, accelerated speech and motor activity,
irritability, flight of ideas, and brief periods of depression.

 Scale 0 – Social Introversion: This scale was developed later than the other nine
scales as is designed to assess a person’s tendency to withdraw from social
contacts and responsibilities.

B. PROJECTIVE TESTS
C.
Projective tests focus upon what is inside a person rather than what can be seen in a
person’s behavior. These tests try to find out more about a person’s feelings, unconscious
desires and inner thoughts.
Another projective test is the Thematic Apperception Test developed by Henry
Murray of Harward University in 1943. The Rorschach test uses ten per different kinds of ink
blot which must be described by the person taking the test. The TAT uses twenty sketches
about which the person is asked to make up a story.
These tests make use of people’s tendencies to make up stories about things they see. When
shown an inkbiot, for example, people see butterflies, dancing girls, pictures ofskeletons, or
many other images. When a vague picture is shown despicting two people, a storey can be
made about their relationship to each other, pictures reveal something about their own
personality; they project unto the picture feelings and thoughts to their own.

316
 Projective tests based on the phenomenon of projection

 RIBT-Rorschach’s Ink blot Test


 TAT-Thematic Apperception Test developed by Henry Murray
 CAT-Children’s Apperception Test developed by Leopard Bellarck consisting of
then cards
 Word Association Test
 Sentence Completion Test

i. RORSCHACH’S INK BLOT TEST:


The Rorschach ink blot test was the first projective test and is still widely
used. It was developed by the Swiss psychologist Hermann Rorschach in 1920.
Here the responses differ from person to person based on the individual’s
personal experiences. For example, teen aged college students saw ink blot no 1 as

 A bat
 Two ladies standing back to back
 Face of an owl
 a patch of cloud

Rorschach responses can / reveal the following information


- Degree of intellectual control of the subject on his actions
- Emotional aspects
- Mental approach to give problems
- Creative and imaginative capacities
- Security and anxiety
- Personality growth and development
- Phobias, sex disturbances and sever psychological disorders can be detected
which serve as guide for treatment program.
ii. THEMATIC APPERCEPTION TEST

317
TAT consists of sets of pictures; one set is used with both men and women, and a
second set only for men, and a third set for women. The pictures are shown in a definite
sequence and the subject is asked to make up a story based on what he sees in these
pictures. It is believed that he would project his own experience, biographicaldata, and
major conflicts, interests and problems in to his description of pictures:Findings of TAT
are compared with case history. TAT is more structured unlike the ink blot test which
however is more popular. TAT is also less standardized.
 Procedure
The TAT is popularly known as the picture interpretation technique because it
uses a standard series of provocative yet ambiguous pictures about which the subject
must tell a story. The subject is asked to tell as dramatic a story as they can for each
picture presented, including:
 What has led up to the event shown
 What is happening at the moment
 What the characters are feeling and thinking, and
 What the outcome of the story was.
If these elements are omitted, particularly for children or individuals oflimited
cognitive abilities, the evaluator may ask the subject about them directly.

There are 31 cards in the standard form of the TAT. Some of the cards show
male figures, some female, some both male and female figures, some of ambiguous
gender, some adults, some children, and some show no human figures at all. One is
completely blank. Although the cards were originally designed to be matched to the
subject in terms of age and gender, any card may be used with any subject. Most
practitioners choose a set of approximately ten cards, either using cards that they feel
are generally useful, or that they believe will encourage the subject's expression of
emotional conflicts relevant to their specific history and situation.

318
 Scoring Systems
The TAT is a projective test in that, like the Rorschach test, its assessment of
the subject is based on what he or she projects onto the ambiguous images.Therefore,
to complete the assessment each story created by a subject must be carefully analyzed
to uncover underlying needs, attitudes, and patterns of reaction.Two common
methods that are currently used in research are the:
 Defense Mechanisms Manual DMM. This assesses three defense mechanisms:
denial (least mature), projection (intermediate), and identification (most mature).
A person's thoughts/feelings are projected in stories involved.
 Social Cognition and Object Relations SCOR scale. This assesses four different
dimensions of object relations: Complexity of Representations of People, Affect-
Tone of Relationship Paradigms, and Capacity for Emotional Investment in
Relationships and Moral Standards, and Understanding of Social Causality.

 TAT throws light in the following areas


a. Family relationships
b. Motivation of the subject
c. Inner fantasies
d. Level of aspiration
e. Social relationships
f. Functioning of sex urge
g. Emotional conflicts
h. Attitude to work
i. Outlook towards future
j. Frustrations if any

 Criticisms
 TAT is criticized as false or outdated by many professional psychologists.
Their criticisms are that the TAT is unscientific because it cannot be proved to
be valid or reliable.
 Some critics of the TAT cards have observed that the characters and
environments are dated, even ‘old-fashioned,’ creating a ‘cultural or

319
psychosocial distance’ between the patients and these stimuli that makes
identifying with them less likely.
 Also, in researching the responses of subjects given photographs versus the
TAT, researchers found that the TAT cards evoked more ‘deviant’ stories (i.e.,
more negative) than photographs, leading them to conclude that the difference
was due to the differences in the characteristics of the images used as stimuli.
iii. SENTENCE COMPLETION TEST
When the subject is asked to complete the sentence without giving time
todeliberate on it, it is assumed that his unconscious process will direct his response. The
test will give an insight to his desires, hopes conflicts, frustrations, fears and annoyances.
For e.g.
i. I feel happy when …………….
ii. I tell lies only when ……………
Sentence completion tests are a class of semi-structured projective techniques.
Sentence completion tests typically provide respondents with beginnings of sentences
referred to as “stems,” and respondents then complete the sentences in ways that are
meaningful to them. The responses are believed to provide indications of attitudes,
beliefs, motivations, or other mental states.
There is debate over whether or not sentence completion tests elicit responses
from conscious thought rather than unconscious states. This debate would affect
whether sentence completion tests can be strictly categorized as projective tests.
A sentence completion test form may be relatively short, such as those used to
assess responses to advertisements, or much longer, such as those used to assess
personality.
The structures of sentence completion tests vary according to the length and
relative generality and wording of the sentence stems. Structured tests have longer
stems that lead respondents to more specific types of responses; less structured tests
provide shorter stems, which produce a wider variety of responses.

 Uses
The uses of sentence completion tests include personality analysis, clinical
applications, attitude assessment, achievement motivation, and measurement of other
constructs. They are used in several disciplines, including psychology, management,
education, and marketing.
Sentence completion measures have also been incorporated into non-
projective applications, such as intelligence tests, language comprehension, and
language and cognitive development tests

 Examples of sentence completion tests


320
There are many sentence completion tests available for use by researchers.
Some of the most widely used sentence completion tests include:

 Rotter Incomplete Sentence Blank


The Rotter Sentence Completion Stems are similar to the sentence stems
shownbelow.
1) If only I could…..feel more hopeful about things.
2) People I know…..are usually fair and honest.
3) I can always.....talk things out with someone.
4) I think guys…..are less emotional than girls.
5) What makes me sad is…..not being able to see my kids.
6) I think girls…..were mysterious to me in High School.
7) My father…..would always listen to what I had to say.
8) Where I live.....is quiet and peaceful.
9) My mother was the type …..Who always took care of her family.
10) My health is...generally very good.

 Miner Sentence Completion Test (measures managerial motivations).


 Washington University Sentence Completion Test (measures ego
development).

 Data analysis, validity and reliability


The data collected from sentence completion tests can usually be analyzed
either quantitatively or qualitatively.
Sentence completion tests usually include some formal coding procedure or
manual. The validity of each sentence completion test must be determined
independently and this depends on the instructions laid out in the scoring manual.

iv. WORD ASSOCIATION TEST


When the subject given quick response word, he is taken unaware of and his
unconscious process directs his association. Here the subject has to answer as quickly as
possible with the first word which comes to his mind when he is given a stimulus word.
Projective tests are often used in clinical practice. They are helpful in showing a
person’s inner areas of conflict, anxieties or any problems in relationships because the
person is free to describe anything.
A man who interprets a woman’s smile as a sexual come on, may be projecting his
own sexual feelings on to the woman and thus revealing a good deal about himself.
321
In nursing, suitable pictures can be devised to test attitudes of patients.

VI. PERSONALITY AND THE NURSE


An understanding of personality will help the nurse to predict her behavior as well as
the behavior of others. Major decisions of life depend upon this knowledge, e.g. selection of a
career, spouse, and colleagues. Her relationship with friends and relatives depend upon her
expectations of their behavior from an understanding of their personalities.
A successful nurse will have a strong and pleasing personality. Besides possessing
such professional qualities as integrity, dignity, mental abilities, poise, self confidence, and
dependability, she must have personal qualities like sympathy, understanding, friendliness,
and adaptability. Patients appreciate a nurse who brings physical comfort to them with her
skills and who understands their emotional difficulties, caused by illness. The nurse must also
have good health, fresh and neat appearance, will power, high standards of moral values,
sense of humor, teaching and managerial capabilities, self control and friendly interpersonal
relationships.

VII. CONCLUSION
Personality types are a great way to understand more about yourself and how you
interact with the world. By understanding your personality through a personality test, you are
able to take a more honest look at yourself and determine if that is who you want to be.
Additionally, personality tests can help you understand those around you. By knowing the
personality type of others, either in your family, friends, or coworkers, you will be able to
interact with them better – maybe even change your communication style to match their
personality.

While the personality tests available today are varied, any of them will be able to tell
you something about yourself. Taking a personality test allows you to increase your self-
awareness. These tests, such as the Myers-Briggs and the Big Five, will also allow you to
compare your results to the results of other test takers.

VIII. BIBLIOGRAPHY
1. Jacob Anthikade. Psychology for graduate nurses. 3 rded. New Delhi: Jaypee
brothers; 2005. p. 25-8, 36-43.
2. Morgan CT, Richard AK, John RW, John S. introduction to psychology. 7 thed.
New York: McGraw Hill Book Company; 1986. p. 546-55.
3. Charles G Morris. Psychology: an introduction. 6th ed. London: prentice hall
international ltd. 1988. p. 483-6.
4. James W Kalat. Introduction to psychology. 4th ed. Boston: Brookscole
publishing company; 1996. p. 553-91.

322
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

PHYSICAL & MENTAL DISABILITY


TEST

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

323
SUBMITTED ON:

TESTS FOR SPECIAL ABILITIES


Introduction

Ability may be an achievement or development of the individual in the same sense as we


consider the pupil’s mastery of subject matter to be an achievement. It is necessary to make a
distinction between special abilities and all other aspects of pupils which are predictive of
vocational success. Many studies have been made to show that pupils differ widely in the
degree to which their interests, or emotionally toned tastes, likes, and dislikes, fit them for
various vocations. Similarly, the emotional and social adjustments of pupils, their
personalities, serve to distinguish them from one another in fitness for vocational success in
various fields.

Moreover, the pupil’s socio economic environment and background, his family, and the
community in which he lives may be considered as determiners of his fitness or aptitude for
one vocation as against the others.

It is well known both to psychologists and to laymen that not all individuals possess these
special abilities in the same degree. Two individuals with same general ability score may
differ from each other in the composition of that general ability; one, for example may have a
high mathematical and low verbal ability. While the other has a high verbal ability and a low
mathematical ability. Consequently, in attempting to guide people among the various
curricula and vocations available, some breakdown of general ability into special ability is
required.

GENERAL AND SPECIAL ABILITIES

Mental abilities (sometimes called cognitive abilities) represent a person’s "brain power" in
different areas of competency. Some typical mental abilities include verbal reasoning,
mathematical reasoning, spatial reasoning, and logical reasoning. Sometimes, psychomotor
skills such as reaction time are also considered to be mental abilities. Many researchers now
believe that there is a general underlying factor that explains most mental abilities
(sometimes called "g", for "general factor"), and that people with higher levels of this general
ability tend to be more successful in life, including at work. Other researchers believe that
this general mental ability is important, but that other abilities (e.g., musical, practical,
emotional) also play a key role in a person's success.

General Ability tests are not specific enough to have high levels of predictive validity within
specific circumstances. A personnel test or a procedure provides only part of the picture
about a person. On the other hand, the personnel assessment process combines and evaluates
all the information gathered about a person to make career or employment-related decisions.

324
People differ on many psychological and physical characteristics. These characteristics are
called constructs. For example, people skillful in verbal and mathematical reasoning are
considered high on mental ability. Those who have little physical stamina and strength are
labeled low on endurance and physical strength. The terms mental ability, endurance and
physical strength are constructs. Constructs are used to identify personal characteristics and
to sort people in terms of how much they possess of such characteristics.

Constructs cannot be seen or heard, but we can observe their effects on other variables. For
example, we don't observe physical strength but we can observe people with great strength
lifting heavy objects and people with limited strength attempting, but failing, to lift these
objects. Such differences in characteristics among people have important implications in the
employment context. Employees and applicants vary widely in their knowledge, skills,
abilities, interests, work styles, and other characteristics. These differences systematically
affect the way people perform or behave on the job.

Objectives

Organizations use assessment tools and procedures to help them perform the following
human resource functions:

 Selection. Organizations want to be able to identify and hire the best people for the
job and the organization in a fair and efficient manner. A properly developed assessment tool
may provide a way to select successful sales people, concerned customer service
representatives, and effective workers in many other occupations.
 Placement. Organizations also want to be able to assign people to the appropriate job
level. For example, an organization may have several managerial positions, each having a
different level of responsibility. Assessment may provide information that helps
organizations achieve the best fit between employees and jobs.
 Training and development. Tests are used to find out whether employees have
mastered training materials. They can help identify those applicants and employees who
might benefit from either remedial or advanced training. Information gained from testing can
be used to design or modify training programs. Test results also help individuals identify
areas in which self-development activities would be useful.
 Promotion. Organizations may use tests to identify employees who possess
managerial potential or higher level capabilities, so that these employees can be promoted to
assume greater duties and responsibilities.
 Career exploration and guidance. Tests are sometimes used to help people make
educational and vocational choices. Tests may provide information that helps individuals
choose occupations in which they are likely to be successful and satisfied.
 Program evaluation. Tests may provide information that the organization canuse to
determine whether employees are benefiting from training and development programs

Bandwidth/Fidelity Problem :Cronbach (1970) : The broader the psychological test


(bandwidth), the less precise the measurement will be (fidelity).As bandwidth increases, the
fidelity associated with that bandwidth decreases.

Origins of Vocational Testing

325
The field of scientific management was responsible for the increase in psychological testing
for employment purposes, following the advent of intelligence testing. Schools such as the
University of Minnesota developed tests of specific abilities in an attempt to match a
particular employee to a job in which they would be successful.

They developed test of intellectual ability, spatial and mathematical ability, perceptual
accuracy, and motor/dexterity tests, to name just a few. The theory is that specific abilities are
more representative of separate occupational categories than overall differences in "g".
Vehicle Operators benefit from high Motor skills, and spatial and mechanical skills. Clerks
benefit from high intellect and high levels of perceptual accuracy. By giving tests specific to
occupation, we hope to increase the efficacy of the selection process.

Limitations of personnel tests and procedures-fallibility of test scores

Professionally developed tests and procedures that are used as part of a planned assessment
program may help you select and hire more qualified and productive employees. However, it
is essential to understand that all assessment tools are subject to errors, both in measuring a
characteristic, such as verbal ability, and in predicting performance criteria, such as success
on the job. This is true for all tests and procedures, regardless of how objective or
standardized they might be.

 Do not expect any test or procedure to measure a personal trait or ability with perfect
accuracy for every single person.
 Do not expect any test or procedure to be completely accurate in predicting
performance.

There will be cases where a test score or procedure will predict someone to be a good worker,
who, in fact, is not. There will also be cases where an individual receiving a low score will be
rejected, who, in fact, would actually be capable and a good worker. Such errors in the
assessment context are called selection errors. Selection errors cannot be completely avoided
in any assessment program.

Using a single test or procedure will provide you with a limited view of a person's
employment or career-related qualifications. Moreover, you may reach a mistaken conclusion
by giving too much weight to a single test result. On the other hand, using a variety of
assessment tools enables you to get a more complete picture of the individual. The practice of
using a variety of tests and procedures to more fully assess people is referred to as the whole-
person approach to personnel assessment. This will help reduce the number of selection
errors made and will boost the effectiveness of your decision making. This leads to an
important principle of assessment.

The validity coefficients for these measures are typically only moderate, ranging from 0.14 to
0.40. However, remember that due to differences in base rate and selection ratios, even a test
with a low validity may be useful to a large organization. Also, validity coefficients are
typically higher when compared to job training performance, than when compared to actual
on-the-job ratings. Additionally, these validity coefficients can vary due to gender, ethnicity,
and motivation and personality variables. Remember that for large organizations, diversity as
well as efficiency is a corporate goal in ensuring long term survival.

326
While considering pre-employment mental ability testing,these important points should
bein mind.

 Mental ability tests usually predict performance on the core tasks


of a job, especially in jobs that have high mental demands.

 Mental ability tests are less successful at predicting other


aspects of job performance, such as interpersonal skill or
dependability.

 Mental ability tests frequently demonstrate adverse impact


Against legally protected groups, so they should be implemented
carefully.

 Combining mental ability testing with personality testing helps to


predict more aspects of job performance than either method
used alone, and helps to mitigate adverse impact (compared to
mental ability testing alone).
Present status of factor analysis.

For breakdown of general ability to special abilities, different methods are using. One is in
terms of statistically derived primary mental abilities and the other is in terms of culturally
determined field of endeavor. The formation in terms of primary abilities may be illustrated
by the following factors which have been reported by various factor analysis.

A verbal factor, involved primarily in those tests which depend upon the meaning of words
and the ideas associated with them

2.A space factor ,which appears in tasks requiring reactions to spatial relations ,such as
reading plans or blueprints or telling whether two drawings represent one or more sides of an
asymmetrical figure.

3.A number factor, requiring such simple numerical operations as multiplications, addition,
subtraction, and division, but not the more complex tasks involving numerical reasoning.

4.A memory factor, requiring paired associations or the recognition of recently learned
material.

5.A mental speed factor.

6.A perceptual factor, or readiness to discover and identify perceptual details.

7.Deduction and induction factors, measured ,respectively, by syllogistic reasoning tests and
by tests requiring the subject to find the rules which binds a number items together and from
it to classify or predict other items.

It is evident from the description ofprimary mentalabilities that none of these bears a
direct and obvious relationship to any specific vocations. It would be expected

327
however,thatsome of them would be involved in some vocations than others. Thusspatial
factor is probably involved to a high degree in the work of a draftsman ,whereas lawyers and
writers need moreof the verbal factor.

The general nature of the uses of factor analyses ofprimary mentalabilities in vocational
guidance are

1. Determine the degree to which each ability is predictive of success in each occupation.
This would be in the form of correlation coefficient, from which a weighing of the ability
could be derived.

2. Determine the score in each ability of the individual being counseled.

3. Multiply the ability scores by the weights and add the products. The resulting sum would
be the individual’s predicted success in that occupation.

Test batteries are designed specifically for single occupations or groups of


occupations .That is , different batteries of ability tests predictive of vocational achievement
are necessary, rather than one universally applicable set of testsfor primary abilities

SPECIAL MENTAL ABILITY TESTS.

Vocational guidance presents a problem in which a single individual must choose from many
vocations , while vocational selection requires choosing among many individuals those who
are at fitted for a particular job.

Test for special abilities have been developed, and usually published, forthe use of vocational
guidance workers mainly in the following fields.

1. Mechanical ability

2. Manual dexterity

3. Clerical ability

4. Music ability

5. Art ability

6. Professional abilities: medicine, law, engineering, nursing.

1. Mechanical AbilityTests

Mechanical ability tests may be classified as either

Mechanical assembly tests

Spatial relations tests.

328
Tests of mechanical information

Minnesota Mechanical Assembly Test

Typical of thefirst is the Minnesota Mechanical Assembly Test, a set of three boxes
containing simple mechanical objects, such as a bicycle bell, amonkey wrench, and a metal
pencil. The subject is required to assemble these within given time limits and his product is
scored with partial credit. The test is valuable for predicting the success of junior high school
boys in shop courses but is not applicable to older persons. It may be criticized on the ground
of possible large variation in scores resulting from crude and inadequate materials and used in
the simple mechanical objects.

Performance test of spatial relations may be illustrated by the Minnesota Spatial Test and
Kent-Shakow Form Boards.

The Minnesota test consists of four boards with 58 odd shaped cutouts which the pupil is
instructed to put in their proper places in the board as rapidly as possible. The score, amount
of time required is intended to bean indicator of probable success in high school shop courses
and in such occupations like garage mechanic, manual training teacherand ornamental iron
work.

Kent-Shakow Form Boards contain five holes or recesses into which a graded series of
eight sets of blocks must be fitted. The score ,the time require to fill the five recesses ,is
intended to be useful at all ages above six in determining fitness for mechanical occupations.

A paper and pencil test of spatial relations is the Minnesota Paper Form Board, Revised ,
which consists of diagrams of de arrangedparts of two dimensionalfigures. The tasks is to
select from five alternatives the diagram which indicates how the parts fit together. The
score ,number correct out of 64 items may be interpretedto the scores ofengineering students,
first-year vocational school pupils ,and elementary school boys and girls of different grades
and ages.

Paper and pencil tests of mechanical information are illustrated by the Detroit Mechanical
AptitudeExamination ;the O’Rourke Mechanical Aptitude test: Junior Grade ; and the
StenquistMechanical Aptitude test, I and II.

Detroittest consists of eight subjects: tool recognition , motor speed , size discrimination,
arithmetic fundamentals, disarranged pictures, tool information , bolt and pulleys, and
classifications.

The O’Rourke Mechanical Aptitude test proceeds on the assumption that the amount of
mechanical information possessed by an individual reflects interesting and aptitude for
mechanical activities. Pictorial and verbal material concerning the applicability of tools
andmechanical processes in matching and multiple choice form is presented.

StenquistMechanical Aptitude testrequires the pairing of pictures of parts of common


tools , contrivandes and machines.

2. Manual Dexterity Test

329
Manual dexterity test measure the ability to work skillfully with the fingers, hands, and arms.
Steadiness and eye hand co ordination at various levels of complexity are required by the
different tests. The Minnesota Rate of manipulation test is intended to measure the rapidity of
movement in working at simple task involving hand and fingers. Part 1, Placing, requires
placing 60 cylindrical blocks in 60 regularly arranged holes in a board. The score is the total
time required for four trials after one practice trial.Part II,Turning, requires the subject topick
up each block from its hole turn it over and replace it with the other hand. After each row of
fifteen blocks, the direction and hand functions are reversed. Scoring is the same as for
placing. This test is useful in predicting success as a packer, wrapper, cartoner or similar
routine manipulative worker.

The O’Connor Finger dexterity testrequires picking up three pins at a time from a tray and
inserting them in small holes in metal place. The score is the time taken to fill the too holes in
the plate. The test is useful in occupations involving rapid handling of small objects such as
assembling clocks and radio fixtures or operating keyboard offline machines

The O’Connor Tweezer dexterity testuses the reverse side of the metal plate ;here the holes
are large enough for only one pin at a time. The pins are picked only one pin ata time with
tweezers and inserted in the holes as rapidly as possible. The scores, time required for the too
holes to be filled is related by success in occupations requiring hand steadiness and eye hand
coordination, such as laboratory work, surgery, drafting, and watch repairing.

The I.E.R. Assembly Test for Girls: A bridged form presents seven tasks , such as sewing
apiece of strip on a muslin and a paper cutting and trimming. The tasks are selected for their
interest to girls. The scoring of each task is a product of evaluation with partial credit The test
is intended to predictsuccess at assembling jobs in terms of ability to work with the hands.

3. Clerical Ability Tests

The Minnesota Vocational test for clerical workers consists of two parts, number
comparison and name comparison .Numbers or names are presented in pairs separated by a
line on which a check is to be marked if the number of the pair is exactly the same.

Eg. 147v 147, 3896 3897, 6487161,6489361

James Jimes;John L Crawford.v John L Crawford;C Merriman Lloyd,Inc. C Merriam


Lloyd,Inc.

The score, number correctly marked or left blank minus the number incorrect, is considered
to be related to success in occupations requiring attention to clerical detail, such as book
keeping, work as a bank teller, office machine operating and stenography.

The O’Rourke Clerical Aptitude Tests: Junior grade consists of nine parts: alphabetical
filling, simple computation, classifying individuals according to residence, occupation, age;
and so forth; comparing names and address ,reading, spelling, analogies ,general information,

330
and arithmetic problems. The test has been validated against success as a typist or
stenographer.

The US Civil Service commission has developed a General Test for Stenographers and
Typists which include vocabulary, English usage, spelling, reading comprehension, and
‘practical judgment items’. The battery was found to differentiate fairly well between good
and poor stenographers and typists. Scores are interpretable in terms of those obtained by
working stenographers and typists and of civil service eligible .The tests has been released for
use in schools and industries

4.Music ability

The Seashore Measures of Musical Talent consists of two series of three double faced
phonograph records measuring sense of pitch, sense of intensity, sense of time, tonal memory,
and sense of rhythm and sense of timber. These subtests, based on a psychological analysis of
musical talent, are played to the subjects, who record their answer on special blanks, For
example the first test, sense of pitch, presents a number of paired sounds and requires the
subject to indicate whether the second sound is higher or lower in pitch than the first. The
measures may be used help to predict success in music as an avocation or as a career. Series
A, covering a wide range of difficulty, is used for unselected groups. Series B is intended for
sharp discrimination among musically superior individuals.

The Drake Musical Memory Test consists of 24 original two bar melodies to be played on a
piano by the examiner or an assistant. Following each of the standard melodies two to seven
variations differing from the standard in key, time, or notes are presented. The score, total
number of errors in classifying the variations correctly, is said to correlate with music
teacher’s estimates of “innate musical capacity”.

The Kwalwasser-Dykema Test resembles the seashore tests in using a set of phonograph
records. Ten elements of musical ability are approached on the five double -faced.
Records: tonal memory (recognition), quality discrimination , intensity discrimination ,tonal
memory(completion),time discrimination ,rhythm discrimination , pitch
discrimination ,melodic taste, pitch imagery, and rhythm imagery.

5. Art Ability Tests

The Meier–Seashore Judgment Tests requires the selection of the more artistic picture in
each of the series of 125 pairs. One of each pair is a reproduction of an artistic work of
recognized merit, while the other has altered in some way so as to lower its merit, make it
less pleasing less artistic, less satisfying. The score, number of correct choices, may be
interpreted with respect to norms for various grade levels from the seventh grade through
senior high school. It furnishes a measure of one artistic talent, “the capacity for perceiving
quality in aesthetic situations relatively apart from formal training”.

The Mc Adory Art Test consists of 72 plates presenting four variations of the same theme,

331
each to be ranked in order of merit. Six kinds of test material are included: furniture and
utensils, texture and clothing, architecture, shape and line arrangement, dark and light masses
and color. These materials, although, practical and functional, are subject to becoming
outmoded by fashion changes which will change the standard up on which the test to be
scored. The score, based on agreement with the ranking of 100 competent judges, provides a
functional measure of aesthetic judgment and perhaps an indirect indication of creative art
ability.

The Knauber Art Ability Test requires drawing a design from memory, arranging a
specified composition within a given space, creating and completing designs from supplied
elements, spotting errors in drawn composition using your own symbols for labor. The
scoring is semi subjective, but high reliability coefficients are reported by the author. The test
may be used to indicate progress in art classes and creative ability rather than aesthetic
judgment.

The Lewerenz Test in Fundamentals abilities of visual art consists of nine tests: recognition
of proportions, originality of line drawing, observation of light and shade, knowledge of
subject matter vocabulary, visual memory of proportion, analysis of problems in cylindrical
perspective, analysis of problems in angular perspective, analysis of problems in parallel
perspective, recognition of color .Both judgment or taste andcreative ability seem to be
tapped by this group of tests.

6. Professional Aptitude Tests

Kandel has summarized the attempts and results obtained in the fields of medicine, law and
engineering. The medical aptitude test of the association of American medical colleges is
issued annually in a new form whose use is restricted to medical colleges. The test is given
every year at many universities to applicants for admissions for medical schools. Six subset
test are included; comprehension and retention, visual memory, memory for content, logical
reasoning, scientific vocabulary and understanding of printed material. The Stoddard- Fersol
law aptitude examination consist of 5 parts; capacity of accurate recall, comprehension and
reasoning by analogy, comprehension and reasoning by analysis, skill and symbolic logic,
comprehension of difficult reading. The test has been useful as a supplement to other
evidence, such as college grades in predicting success in last school work.
Engineering aptitude test has been taken the form mainly of mathematical ability or
achievement test or spatial perception test, together with measures of general scholastic
aptitude. Any of the available good tests in these 3 folds together with other data holds
together with all other data concerning the pupil’s scholastic achievement, especially his
vocational interest, provides the best indication possible at present success in an engineering
curriculum.

Nursing aptitude has been approached through the Moss- Hunt Aptitude Test for nursing,
which deals with scientific vocabulary, general information, understanding of printed
material, visual ability, memory for content, comprehension and retention, and ability to
understand and follow directions. While the test material has been selected for its relevance to
nursing work, no previous training in nursing is assumed. The scores on this test have been
found to correlate substantially with ability to handle the scholastic material in the first year
of training.

332
OTHER TESTS FOR SPECIAL ABILITIES

1.Sensory/Perceptual Skills Tests


 

Single Purpose Instruments:


 
Snellen Wall Chart: Used to test visual acuity.Found in every ophthalmologist's office in
some form.
 
Audiometer:Measure of auditory acuity, this machine reproduces tones at different
frequencies within the range of normal human hearing (20 to 20000 Hz) often first
experienced in elementary school.
 
Isihihara Test of Color Blindness:Each pseudo-isochromatic plate in these tests contains a
pattern of colored dots which form a numeral, if someone with normal color vision views the
plate.
 
 
A multipurpose visual testing instrument:
 
Bausch & Lomb Vision Tester : 12 visual tests assess four categories of vision :Muscular
balance of the eyes ;Acuity in each eye, and both used together;depth perception , and color
perception.
2.Testing Computer Related Abilities
 

Since our economy has gone more and more "high-tech”, measures of computer aptitude and
achievement have been developed to ensure hiring of individuals with at least a minimal level
of computer related work skills.
 
One test designed to measure computer programmer aptitude is the:
 
Computer Programmer Aptitude Battery (CPAB) : this 75 minute tests contains the
following sections :
Verbal Meaning ; Reasoning ;Letter Series; Number Ability; and Diagramming.Experienced
Programmers and systems analysts were consulted when these test items were constructed.
Early studies indicate moderate predictive validity for the CPAB.
 
A test to assess whether someone has basic computer skills is the :
 
Computer Operator Aptitude Battery (COAB) :
3 15 minute sections assess Sequence Recognition, Format Checking, and Logical Thinking.
Norms are based on scores from experienced computer operators.

3. Tests of Creativity

333
 
Often try to distinguish between creative and "less creative" people by identifying when these
two group diverge from typical thinking.As a result, many tests of creativity use open ended
sentences, making standardization of grading procedures difficult, thus driving down
reliability and validity.
 
Consequences Test (Guilford, 1954):"Imagine what might happen if all laws were suddenly
abolished?”
 
Remote Associates Test (Mednick, 1962) Find a fourth word which is associated with each
of these three words:A. rat-blue-cottage;B. Wheel-electric-light;C. surprise-line-birthday
 
Unusual Uses Tests (Guilford, 1954) “Find as many uses as you can think of for A.
toothpick; B. brick,
C. paper clip
 
WordAssociationTest.(Getzels & Jackson, 1962) Write as many meanings as you can for the
following A. duck, B. sack, C. pitch
 
TEST FOR DISABILITIES

The eligibility of a child for special education and related services is considered upon
completion of the administration of tests and other evaluation materials. In order for a child to
be declared eligible for special education and related services it must be determined that the
child is a “child with a disability” and is in need of special education and related
services.

The parent of the child and a team of qualified professionals must determine whether the
child is a child with a disability and in need of special education and related services.

(The determination of whether a child suspected of having a specific learning disability is a


child with a disability, must be made by the child’s parents and a team of qualified
professionals which must include the child’s regular teacher; or a regular classroom teacher
qualified to teach a child of his or her age if the child does not have a regular teacher; or, for a
child of less than school age, an individual qualified by the SEA to teach a child of his or her
age; and at least one person qualified to conduct individual diagnostic examinations of
children, such as a school psychologist, speech-language pathologist, or remedial reading
teacher.)

THE TEAM CONSIDERING DISABILITY

In interpreting evaluation data for the purpose of determining if a child is a child with a
disability and in need of special education, each public agency is to draw upon information
from a variety of sources, including aptitude and achievement tests, parent input, teacher
recommendations, physical condition, social or cultural background, and adaptive behavior.

Additional procedures for evaluating children and determining the existence of a


specific learning disability

334
IDEA includes the following additional procedures when evaluating and determining the
existence of a specific learning disability:

1. A team may determine that a child has a specific learning disability if:

 The child does not achieve commensurate with his or her age and ability levels in one
or more of the areas listed below, if provided with learning experiences appropriate for the
child’s age and ability levels; and
 The child has a severe discrepancy between achievement and intellectual ability in
one or more of the following areas: Oral expression; listening comprehension; written
expression; basic reading skill; reading comprehension; mathematics calculation;
mathematics reasoning.

1. The team may not identify a child as having a specific learning disability if the severe
discrepancy between ability and achievement is primarily the result of:

 A visual, hearing, or motor impairment;


 Mental retardation;
 Emotional disturbance; or
 Environmental, cultural or economic disadvantage.

1. Observation:

 At least one team member other than the child’s regular teacher shall observe the
child’s academic performance in the regular classroom setting.
 In the case of a child of less than school age or out of school, a team member shall
observe the child in an environment appropriate for a child of that age.

1. Written report — For a child suspected of having a specific learning disability, the
documentation of the team’s determination of eligibility must include a statement of:

 Whether the child has a specific learning disability.


 The basis for making the determination.
 The relevant behavior noted during the observation of the child.
 The relationship of that behavior to the child’s academic functioning.
 The educationally relevant medical findings, if any.
 Whether there is a severe discrepancy between achievement and ability that is not
correctable without special education and related services.
 The determination of the team concerning the effects of environmental, cultural, or
economic disadvantage.

Each team member shall certify in writing whether the report reflects his or her conclusion. If
it does not reflect his or her conclusion, the team member must submit a separate statement
presenting his or her conclusions.

LAW DEFINES CHILD WITH DISABILITY

335
The term “a child with a disability” means:

 A child evaluated according to IDEA as having mental retardation, a hearing


impairment including deafness, a speech or language impairment, a visual impairment
including blindness, serious emotional disturbance (referred to in IDEA as emotional
disturbance), an orthopedic impairment, autism, traumatic brain injury, and other health
impairment, a specific learning disability, deaf-blindness, or multiple disabilities, and
 Who, by reason thereof, needs special education and related services.
 At the discretion of the State and Local Education Agencies, a “child with a
disability,” aged three through nine, may include a child who is experiencing
developmental delays, as defined by the State and as measured by appropriate diagnostic
instruments and procedures, in one or more of the following areas: physical development,
cognitive development, communication development, social or emotional development, or
adaptive development, and who, by reason thereof, needs special education and related
services.

The possible implications for students with learning disabilities when they are identified
as having a developmental delay

The use of a “developmental delay” category to determine whether a child is eligible for
special education and related services could make it possible to identify some children early
before they experience failure in school and fall behind their peers. Many children with
learning disabilities show delays in one or more of the areas specified. There is, however,
some concern that children with learning disabilities will be included in the “developmental
delay” category without identifying the specific processing disorder/s present and, thus the
specific intervention strategies needed will not be provided.Parents should ensure that:

 Assessment tools and strategies used gather relevant functional and developmental
information.
 Tests and other evaluation materials used include those tailored to assess specific
areas of educational need.
 Assessment tools and strategies provide relevant information that directly assists
persons in determining the education needs of the child.

Since States and Local Education Agencies are not mandated to follow a certain course, but
can make a choice regarding whether to use “developmental delay” for children aged three to
nine, parents need to determine the eligibility criteria used by their State and Local Education
Agencies. Contact special education administrators at the State Department of Education or
the local school district for this information.

TEST FOR PHYSICAL ABILITIES

Physical Abilities Tests: Tests typically test applicants on some physical requirement such as
lifting strength, rope climbing, or obstacle course completion.

336
Advantages Disadvantages

 can identify individuals who are  costly to administer


physically unable to perform the essential  requirements must be shown to be job
functions of a job without risking injury to related through a thorough job analysis.
themselves or others  may have age based disparate impact
 can result in decreased costs related to against older applicants
disability/medical claims, insurance, and
workers compensation
 decreased absenteeism

Important Information About the physical ability test

• The PATs are designed to simulate specific job duties of a Peace Officer.

• The tests are physically demanding and could cause injury to persons who are not
physically fit or have medical conditions which limit their physical ability.

• The tests are administered in a non-medical environment by non-medical staff. Therefore, it


is in your best interest to objectively evaluate your physical fitness status and to prepare
yourself prior to participating in the Physical Abilities Test.

Before taking the PAT, you must undergo a risk assessment to ensure you are fit to proceed.
The risk assessment includes height and weight measurement, blood pressure check, coronary
risk assessment and an overall review of current health status. If you pass the risk assessment,
you will proceed with the PAT. Due to the nature of the PAT, there is some risk of injury to
individuals with existing medical conditions or those who may be in marginal physical
condition.

The test itself consists of five physically demanding performance tests designed to evaluate
overall fitness to perform the specific functions of a Peace Officer. Using
Various pieces of exercise equipment, candidates must demonstrate:

 Overall endurance

 Grip strength

 Trunk strength

 Dynamic arm power

337
 Dynamic leg power
Physical Abilities Test - Page 2
Dynamic
Arm Test
The purpose of this test is to measure the anaerobic power of the arms in order to determine
the candidate’s ability to carry a stretcher containing a person weighing approximately 185
pounds 1/8 mile with the assistance of one other person and an additional 1/8 mile with the
assistance of three other people. You need adequate strength in your abdominal (flexor) and
lower back (extensor) muscles to pass these tests. Using your arms, you must be able to pedal
a stationary bicycle 45 revolutions in one minute with a very challenging amount of
resistance.

Dynamic
Leg Test
The purpose of this test is to measure the anaerobic power of the legs in order to predict the
candidate’s ability to sprint 100 yards in 19 seconds or less. You must pedal a stationary
bicycle 70 revolutions in one minute with a very challenging amount of resistance in order to
pass this test.

Physical Exertion Demand on Legs (PEDOL)

The purpose of this test is to determine the candidate’s ability to complete a 500-yard run in
two minutes and twenty seconds. This test is a measurement of an individual’s cardiovascular
fitness level, so it is essential that you do aerobic activities in order to successfully pass this
test. Riding a stationary bicycle is the most effective type of activity you can do to prepare
yourself for this test. You must pedal a stationary bicycle 56 to 70 revolutions per minute
(RPM), with a very challenging amount of resistance, and complete 112 revolutions in two
minutes in order to pass this test.
Physical Abilities Test - Page 3
Grip Strength Test

The purpose of this test is to measure the strength of the muscles in the fingers, hand and
forearm in order to determine the candidate’s ability to pick up and carry a stretcher
containing a person weighing approximately 185 pounds, with the assistance of one other
person .It is performed using a hand dynamometer. You must be able to squeeze 34 kg (76
lbs.) with a hand grip testing device in order to pass this test. It is essential that you
strengthen your finger flexors and surrounding hand and forearm muscles to be prepared for
this test.

Trunk Strength Test

The purpose of this test is to measure abdominal and back strength in order to determine the
candidate’s ability to drag an unconscious person weighing approximately 165 pounds 20 feet
in 20 seconds or less after running 500 yards. To carry a stretcher containing a person
weighing approximately 185 pounds 1/8 mile with the assistance of one other person and an

338
additional 1/8 mile with the assistance of three other people. You need adequate strength in
your abdominal (flexor) and lower back (extensor) muscles to pass these tests.

BEND, TWIST, AND TOUCHare performed on a flat surface next to a wall. The
candidate stands with his/her back to the wall and far enough from the wall so that the
candidate can bend over without hitting the wall with the buttocks. Directly behind the
middle of the candidate’s back, at shoulder height, an “X” is taped on the wall and another
“X” on the floor between the candidate’s feet. The candidate’s feet are to be placed shoulder-
width apart, and the hands are to be placed together with the palms touching. On the
command “Go”, the candidate
bends and touches the center of the “X” between the feet and rises back to the upright
position, twists to the left and touches the center of the “X” on the wall with both hands, then
twists back to the starting position. The candidate repeats this procedure, except that the next
twist is to the right. The participant alternates sides, turning both left and right in the
completion of each cycle. The candidate must touch the center of each “X” during the test; if
the “X” is not touched, the cycle will not count. Three trials are given. The candidate will
have 20 seconds to complete 11 cycles.

The SIT AND REACH is performed without shoes while sitting on the floor, knees extended
(soft joint), and feet placed squarely against a box and no wider than eight inches apart. The
toes are pointed toward the ceiling and one hand is placed on top of the other with the
fingertips even. The candidate leans forward without lunging or bobbing and reaches as far
down a yardstick as he/she is able. The neck remains in the neutral position, the hands stay
together and even, and the stretch must be held for two seconds. Three trials are allowed. The
candidate must reach the required length of 16 inches to pass this event.

The PUSH-UP begins in the up position with the hands placed on the matt where they are
comfortable for the candidate. The toes and hands remain on the floor. The body and head are
aligned and straight, and the body is raised until the arms are fully extended. On the
command “Go”, the candidate bends his/her elbows and lowers his/her entire body as a single
unit until his/her upper arms are at least parallel to the ground, and then returns to the starting
position by raising his/her entire body until the arms are fully extended. The candidate’s body
must remain rigid in a generally straight line and move as a unit while performing each
repetition. The movement equals one repetition. The candidate has to complete 18 push-ups.

The SIT-UP begins while lying on the back with the legs bent at the knees at
approximately a 90-degree angle and the hands clasped together behind the head. The hands
must remain clasped behind the head for each sit-up. The feet may be together or up to 12
inches apart. On the command “Go” the candidate raises his/her upper body forward to, or
beyond, the vertical position. The vertical position means that the base of the neck is above
the base of the spine. The candidate then lowers his/her body until the bottom of the shoulder
blades touches the ground. The head, hands, arms or elbows do not have to touch the ground.
If the hands break apart, the sit-up will not count. The candidate must complete 27 sit-ups in
one minute.

The VERTICAL JUMP is performed on a VJ Test Mat. The candidate stands on the
mat placing his/her feet on the foot imprints. The belt is put around his/her waist. The tape is

339
pulled through a clip in the belt until taut to adjust for height of the athlete. The measuring
tape at the mat feeder is always set at 0 cm/in. The candidate bends his/her knees and jumps
straight upward. The length of tape pulled through the feeder indicates the height of the jump.
The candidate gets three tries at this event. The candidate must jump 16 inches to pass the
event.

The THREE HUNDRED METER SPRINT is performed in running shoes and


proper
Clothing. This is an exercise to determine explosive and sustained running ability over a short
distance. The candidate must complete the run without any help. On the command “Go”, the
clock will start. The marked distance is approximately ¾ of a lap on a standard high school
track. The candidate must complete the run in 77 seconds to pass the event. After this
exercise the candidate will be given a 15-minute recovery period before continuing on with
the last portion of the test.

The MILE AND ONE-HALF RUN is performed in running shoes and proper
clothing. The candidate may complete this exercise by running or mixing a combination of
running with walking. Although walking is allowed, it is strongly discouraged. Candidates
must complete the run without any physical help. On the command “Go”, the clock will start.
Candidates must complete the run in 15 minutes, 20 seconds to pass the event.

SUMMARY
The special ability tests are very useful in selecting efficient personnel for a suitable
job. Now a day’s these types of aptitude tests are commonly using in European countries. In
our country only certain departments are using these tests. Scores in the upper range on
Abstract Reasoning, Perceptual Speed and Accuracy, Mechanical Reasoning and Space
Relations and in the middle range on Verbal Reasoning, Numerical Reasoning, Spelling and
Language Usage and physical abilities are measured. In deciding on ones future career, they
should concentrate on those ability areas in which they have achieved their best scores.

REFERENCES

 S.R Vashist. Practice of Educational Evaluation. Anmol Publications .1st ed.2002


p.220-247
 www.washoecounty.us/file_push.php?file_choice
 Btetech.com/lit/collateral/BTE-PAT_Cost_Benefit_Summary
 www.cdcr.ca.gov/Career_Opportunities/POR/docs/PAT
 www.ppicentral.com/Pdf/ability
 www.faqs.org/childhood/In-Ke/Intelligence-Testing.html
 www.freshpromotions.com.au/.../white-sliding-tile-puzzle-.html

340
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

SOCIOMETRY

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

341
SOCIOMETRY
MEANING

The word sociometry comes from the latin‘socious’ ,meaning social and the
latin‘metrum’,meaning measure. As these roots imply,sociometry is a way of measuring the
degree of relatedness among people . measurementsofrelatedness can be usefull not only in
the assessment of behavior within groups ,but also for interventions to bring about positive
change and for determining the extend of change. For a work group ,sociometrycan be a
powerfull tool for reducing conflict and improving communication because it allows the
group to see itself objectively and to analyse its owndynamics.it is also a powerfull tool for
assessing dynamics and development in groups devoted to theraphy or training.
Jacob levy Moreno coined the term sociometryand conducted the first long –range
sociometric study from 1932-38 at the new York state training school for girls in
Hudson ,newyork . As part of this study, Moreno used sociometric techniques to assign
residents to various residential cottages.He found that assignments on the basis of sociometry
substantially reduced the number ofrunaways from the facility . many more sociometric
studiessubstantially reduced the number of runaways from the facility . many more
sociometric studies have been conducted since , by Moreno and othersin settings including
other schools the military , theraphy groups , andbusiness cooperations.
A usefull working definition of sociometry is thatit is a methodology for tracking the energy
vectors of interpersonnel relationships in a group . it shows the patterns of how individuals
associate with each other when acting as a group toward a specified end or goal . Moreno
himself defined sociometry as the mathematical study of psychological properties of
populations , the experimental technique of and the results obtained by application of
quantitative methods.
Sociometry is based on the fact that people make choices in interpersonnel
relationships .whenever people gather , they make choices – where to sit or stand ; choices
about who is friendly and who not , who is central to the group , who is rejected , who is
isolated. As Moreno says, ‘ choices are fundamentalfacts in all ongoing human relations ,
choices of people and choices of things .Itis immaterial whether the motivations are known to
the chooser or not; it is immaterial whether are inarticulate or highly expressive , whether
rational or irrational . they do not require any special justification as long as they are
spontaneous and true to the self of the chooser.

342
DEFINITION OF SOCIOMETRIC TECHNIQUES
Methods for quantitatively assessing and measuring interpersonal and group relationships

ADVANTAGES:
 It enables the teacher to get a comprehensive picture of the structure of social
relationship in the entire class by means of certain instruments and method of
interpreting the results obtained.
 It is a special method of obtaining the information through oral questions , written
responses and analyzing the records in studying the group.
 It is a technique whereby each member is asked to state the kind of relationships ,
which he holds towards the other members . these have been recorded graphically
and represented in sociogram.
 It is a method used determine the degree to which individuals are accepted or
rejected in a group and group structure .
 This technique is simple in use and speedy in administration
 The curricular and co- curricular activities formation of groups , choosing
companions , patterns for specific activities.

343
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

Item
Analysis
SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

ITEM ANALYSIS
344
MEANING OF ITEM ANALYSIS
Item analysis is a process which examines student responses to individual test items
(questions) in order to assess the quality of those items and of the test as a whole. Item
analysis is especially valuable inimproving items which will be used again in later tests, but it
can also be used to eliminate ambiguous ormisleading items in a single test administration. In
addition, item analysis is valuable for increasing instructors' skills in test construction, and
identifying specific areas of course content which need greateremphasis or clarity. Separate
item analyses can be requested for each raw score1 created during a givenrun). It is a
statistical technique used for selecting and rejecting the items of a test on the basis of their
difficulty value and discriminative power.
ESTIMATING ITEM DIFFICULTY
According to Frank S. Freeman, the difficulty value of an item may be defined as the
proportion of certain sample of subjects (learners) who actually know the answer of the item.
This statement is most functional and dependable because an item can be answered correctly
by guessing. The difficulty value depends on actually knowing the correct answer of an item
rather than answering an item correctly.
For each item compute the percentage of students who get the item correct. This is called the
Item Difficulty Index. The formula for calculating item difficulty index is:
R
D =x 100
N
where R = Number of pupils who answered the item
correctly; N = Total number of pupils who tried them.
ESTIMATING DISCRIMINATION INDEX
The discriminating power (i.e., the validity index) of an item refers to the degree to
which a given item discriminates among students who differ sharply in the function(s)
measured by the test as a whole.
An estimate of an item's discrimination index may be obtained by the formula:
RU-RL
Discrimination Index = ½N
Where RU = No. of correct responses from the upper group;
RL = No. of correct responses from the lower group;
N = Total number of pupils who tried them.

DIFFICULTY AND DISCRIMINATION DISTRIBUTIONS


At the end of the Item Analysis report, test items are listed according their degrees of
difficulty (easy, medium, hard) and discrimination (good, fair, poor). These distributions
provide a quick overview of the test, and can be used to identify items which are not
performing well and which can perhaps be improved or discarded.
TEST STATISTICS
Two statistics are provided to evaluate the performance of the test as a whole.

345
Reliability Coefficient. The reliability of a test refers to the extent to which the test is likely
to produce consistent scores.
Reliability Interpretation
90 and above - Excellent reliability; at the level of the best standardized tests
80 - .90 - Very good for a classroom test
70 - .80 - Good for a classroom test; in the range of most. There are
probably a few items which could be improved.
60 - .70 - Somewhat low. This test needs to be supplemented by other measures
(e.g.,more tests) to determine grades. There are probably some items which could be
improved.
50 - .60 - Suggests need for revision of test, unless it is quite short (ten or fewer items).
The test definitely needs to be supplemented by other measures (e.g., more tests) for grading.
50 or below - Questionable reliability. This test should not contribute heavily to the course
grade, and it needs revision.

Standard Error of Measurement. The standard error of measurement is directly related to


the reliability of the test. It is an index of the amount of variability in an individual student's
performance due to random measurement error. If it were possible to administer an infinite
number of parallel tests, a student's score would be expected to change from one
administration to the next due to a number of factors. For each student, the scores would form
a "normal" (bell-shaped) distribution. The mean of the distribution is assumed to be the
student's "true score," and reflects what he or she "really" knows about the subject. The
standard deviation of the distribution is called the standard error of measurement and reflects
the amount of change in the student's score which could be expected from one test
administration to another.

THE OBJECTIVES OF ITEM ANALYSIS


The main objectives of item analysis technique are as below:
1. To select the proper items for the final draft of the test and reject the poor items that
are unable to contribute any worth in the functioning of the test.
2. To modify some items to make them functionable.
3. To obtain the difficulty index and discrimination index of each items of preliminary
draft of the test.
4. To increase the functioning of a test by considering difficulty index and
discrimination index simultaneously in selecting and rejecting the test items.
5. To obtain basis for preparing the final draft of the test

STEPS INVOLVED IN ITEM ANALYSIS

346
In conducting an item analysis of a classroom test, one should bear the following points
in mind:
1. Arrange answer books (or answer sheets) from the highest score to the lowest score.
2. From the ordered set of answer books, make two groups. Put those with the highest
scores in one group and those with the lowest scores in the other group. (There are
some statistical reasons why one should place the best 27% of the answer books in one
group and the poorest 27% in the other group. Hut, for classroom tests, it is really not
important what percentage is used. If the class is small, say, of 50 or fewer students, there
would be too few answer books in the top and bottom 27% to yield a very reliable item
analysis indices). In a typical type of classroom situation, it is quite appropriate to divide
the total group into the top and bottom halves.
3. For each item (e.g., true-false type, completion type), count the number of students in
each group who answered the item correctly. For alternate-response type of items, count
the number of students in each group who choose each alternative.
4. Record the count for each item. Assume a total of 40 answer books, 20 in each group.
Below is given a hypothetical illustration:

Item No. 1 2 3 4 5

No. of correct responses of the best 20 12 15 20 3 6

(or upper 27% or top half)

No. of correct responses of the poorest20 3 12 0 3 12

(or lower 27%. or bottom half)

Omits 0 4 0 0 10

INTERPRETING ITEM ANALYSIS DATA


Item analysis data should be interpreted with caution.
Remember that:
(i) Item analysis data are not analogous to item validity;
(it) The discrimination index is not always a measure of item quality;
(iii)Item analysis data are tentative;
(iv) Avoid selecting test items purely on the basis of their statistical properties

USING ITEMS ANALYSIS RESULTS

347
Item analysis data have several values:
(i) They help one judge the worth or quality of a test;
(ii) They can be of aid in subsequent test revisions;
(iii) Theylead to increased skill in test construction;
(iv) They provide diagnostic value and help in planning future learning activities;
(v) They provide a basis for discussing test results;
(vi) If students assist in, or are told the results of, item analysis,
it can be a learning experience for them;
(vii) They help in revising the test or test items.

348
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

ASSIGNMENT ON

CONDUCT CONTINUING EDUCATION


WORKSHOP

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

349
WORKSHOP TECHNIQUE
INTRODUCTION:
The workshop is the name given a novel (refreshing, new) experiment in education.
Close group type of discussion will be held in form of workshop. It consist of series of
meetings, usually four or more, with emphasis of individual work within the group with the
help of consultants and resource personnel. Educational process has two aspects- theoretical
and practical. Learning takes place in a friendly, happy and democratic under experts’
guidance. The workshops are organized to develop the psychomotor aspects of the learner
regarding practices of new innovations in the area of education. Workshop helps to each
participant opportunities to improve his effectiveness as a professional worker.

DEFINITIONS:
1. According to L. Ramachandran: The workshop is a meeting of people to work
together in a small group upon problems which are of concern to them and relevant to
them in their own sphere of activity and to find suitable solutions.
2. According to Lorreta: Workshop refers to a group of individuals who work together
toward the solution of problems in a given subject matter field during a specific
period of time.
3. According to Basavantappa: Workshop is defined as assembled group of 10 to 25
persons who share a common interest or problem. They meet together to improve
their individual skills of a subject through intensive study, research, and discussion.
4. According to Neeraja: A systematic approach to deal in detail about educational
problems by means of a short meeting.

OBJECTIVES:
The workshops are organized to realize the following objectives:
1. Cognitive Objectives
2. Psychomotor Objectives
3. Affective objectives

1. Cognitive Objectives :The workshop is organized to


i. Solve the problems of teaching profession.
ii. Provide the philosophical and sociological background for instructional and
teaching situation.
iii. Develop an understanding regarding the use of a theme and problem.
iv. Identify the educational objectives in the present context.

2. Psychomotor objectives: (Skill development)

350
i. To develop the proficiency for planning and organizing teaching and
instructional activities.
ii. To develop skills to perform a task independently.
iii. To determine and use of teaching strategies effectively.
iv. To train the person for using different approaches of teaching.

3. Affectiveobjectives:(AttitudeDevelopment)
i. To develop professional relationship between participants and resource person.
ii. To permit the extensive study of a situation its background and its social and
philosophical implication.
iii. To take necessary steps to solve the problem of education.

PURPOSES OF WORKSHOP:
1. To put teachers in situations that will break down the barriers between them to
facilitate communication.
2. To give opportunity for personal growth through accepting and working towards a
goal held in common with others.
3. To give teachers an opportunity to work on the problems those are direct, current,
concern to them.
4. Teachers will learn new methods and techniques which they can use in their own
classrooms.
5. To place teachers in a position of responsibility for their own learning
6. To put teacher in situation where they will evaluate their own efforts.
7. To give the teachers an opportunity to improve their own morale.

PRINCIPLES OF WORKSHOP:
1. Workshop should focus on the current issues in the profession to be discussed.
2. Workshop should be conducted with full co-operation within organizers.
3. Giving the participants an active role will make teaching more effective.
4. Every individual has worth, and has a contribution to make to the common goal.

SCOPE OF WORKSHOP TECHNIQUE:


The workshop technique is used mainly in the following areas of education.
1. Action research project for classroom problems.
2. New format of lesson plan.
3. Preparing instructional material or teaching model.
4. Workshop on preparing research synopsis and proposals.
5. Workshop for non formal education.
6. Workshop for designing programme for teacher education at any level.

PLANNING FOR A WORKSHOP:

351
Selection of a theme:
Select the theme on workshop has to be organized.
1. The theme must be based on pre existing problem for which we should identify the
solution.
2. Theme must be useful for the in-service workers for giving awareness and training of
new practice in their working situation and which has a solution.
3. Theme must be directed towards the participants because to motivate their interest.
After selecting a theme for workshop, following have to be planned.
1. Open a file:
Correspondence relating to the planning, running and evaluation of workshop will
soon reach proportions that call for proper filing. A suitable system might be a loose leaf file
with the following subdivisions:
- Budget
- Workshop site
- Selection of participants
- Documentation
- Equipment checklist
- Publicity, press etc
- Evaluation
2. Selection of Resource Person:
In organizing a workshop resource person plays following important roles:
- They should provide theoretical and practical aspects of the theme.
- Resource person must have much more practical and theoretical exposure in
their work field.
- Resource person should able to provide guidance to participants at every stage
of and train them to perform the task effectively.
- Resource person should be able to supervise and also control the trainees.
3.Selection of the Participants: Criteria for selecting the participants:
a. Type of Participants: Homogeneity: Participants should be homogeneous
(same group).
b. Select the p participants who will benefit by the theme of workshop and
objectives.
c. Number of participants: It can be found from experience that as many as 35
participants (seven groups of five) can be handled by one organizer.
d. Select the participants 60 days before the workshop.
e. 45 days before confirm the participants who are going to participate who are
going to participate in the workshop.
f. Voluntary participation and willingness to innovate. Select the participants
those who attend the workshop voluntarily
g. Each participant should already have demonstrated his desire for change by
having adopted new methods of his own.

4. Selection of the Dates for the workshop:

352
i. Date of workshop should not coincide with public or religious holidays, sports
events.
ii. At least one working day will preside the open of the workshop.
iii. It should be planned prior to prevent inconvenience in conducting workshop.

5. Selection of the place for workshop:


1. Select the place where the Participants can stay and attend total activities
of workshop on a full time basis.
2. Place should be far away from where theParticipants live to enable them to
participate in activities without interruption.
3. The place should be pleasurable one (Quiet, adequate seating, well
ventilated, good lighting, etc.)
4. Booking a meeting room and hotel accommodation
i. Book the room for conduction workshop and accommodation 6 months
priorly to the day.
ii. Take it in writing and insist in writing confirmation detailing the
conditions you have specified, particularly as regards to meeting room.
6. Selection of Language:
In workshop national Language must be the working language. It must be
known by all Participants.

7. Selection of Committees:
While organizing a workshop Committees must be formulated such as:
1. Organizer Committee:
 Should plan for programme
 They should schedule the programme
 They must select the days, dates, venue of workshop
 They should plan for budgeting
2. Assistant organizers Committee:
 selection must be done 4 months before the day
 organizer should select assistant organizers from another school or faculty
 Select each assistant organizer for every 10 participants.
 The assistant organizers will have the task of finding answers to questions
put forward by the participants.
3. Sponsors Committees:
 Sponsoring Committee should be found by organizers to share the
expenses of workshop
 Sponsors can extend their helping hand to provide place for workshop,
sound media, food and snacks, printing material etc

4. Volunteers Committee: Serves the following

353
 Receiving the guests
 Orienting the place to the participants and experts
 Seating arrangement
 Serving food
They have to formulate Committees for- registration, transportation, food,
stage, reception, publicity Committee etc.

8. Budget for Workshop:


Organizers should plan the budget according to their plan of conducting workshop.
Following simple formula is suggested to estimate the expenditure:
E = (T+S) NX 1.25
E- Estimate
T- Cost of return travel
S- Living expenses (accommodation, food)
N- Number of participants

9. Invitation of the participants:


The main points to be covered in the invitation are:
- Aim of the workshop
- Theme of the workshop
- Working method of the workshop
- Get a deadline for application

Preparing Workshop Pamphlet / Booklet:


Print pamphlets / booklets- chart specifying the
- Aim of the workshop
- Registration fees for the workshop
- Activities of programme in workshop
- Facilities arranged for the workshop
These all help the participants to prepare physically and mentally before
coming to the workshop.
Content which the experts are going to present must be given at the time of
documentation. This helps them to have reference copy of content for their future.

IMMEDIATE PREPARATION FOR WORKSHOP (ie 2-3 days before):

1. Review of the list of participants and resource persons:


- After getting the application we should prepare the finalizing the number of
participants, list of participants should be prepared.
- Resource persons also must be properly reminded.

2.Arrangement of room:

354
- Two days before the workshop it should be arranged
- The meeting room should be arranged so as to allow participants to sit at tables in
small groups of three to five.
- Allow the use of overhead projector it would be preferable in order to allow two
documents to be compared together.
- Make sure that everyone has a good view of the projection screen and discussion
leader.
- Room must be quite and that is arrangement is preferable to separate groups in
different rooms.
- Make sure that the room is away from the source of noise.
- Room must be adequately darkened to project the overhead projector.
- Make sure that electric power point that works and have an electrical extension flex
and spare projector lamp available.
- In addition have a stock of transparent cellulose sheets and marker crayons available
that may be used to illustrate any remarks that may be in plenary (An intensive
examination testing a student's proficiency in some special field of knowledge)
sessions.

3. Arrangement of Staff and Equipment- needed for document reproduction during


workshop:
Staff and equipment needed for documentation must be arrangement one month
before the day.
Staffs: such as typist for typing the documents resulting from group work.
Equipment: one month before itself should be arranged with all the needed
equipment and prior to the workshop it should be checked that the things by using
checklist.
EquipmentChecklist:
1. Note Pads(One for each Participants)
2. Pencils and sharpener (One for each Participants)
3. Rubber (One for each Table)
4. Two hold punch (1)
5. Adhesive tape (2 rolls)
6. Stapler (1)
7. Waste paper basket (One for each Table)
8. Drawing pins (2 packets)
9. File
10. Overhead projector (2)
11. Sharp projectors (2)
12. Electric extension flex (6 meter)
13. Electric adapter plugs (2)
14. Transparent cellulose sheets (50)
15. Crayon markers
16. Black board for flip charts
17. Dictionary

355
9. Arranging for press relations:
Depending on the local situation, it may be worth deciding to inform the press.

10. Coordinating the Assistant organizers:


All the assistant organizers should arrive at the site of the workshop without fail at
least two whole days before the workshop and should have been told how important
this coordination period is.
11. Time Table of Work:
a. It is not recommended to arrange more than five hours of structured sessions a
day.
b. There should be provision of Teas break and lunch break at appropriate time
interval and it should be planned through out the workshop.
c.Last day don’t forget to have a group photo snaps taken during the break.

ROLES IN WORKSHOP TECHNIQUE:

In organizing workshop the following four roles are performed.

1. Organizers of the workshop:


Whole programme and schedule is prepared by the organizer. He has to arrange
boarding lodging facilities for participants as well as the experts. The date, days, and
venue of workshop are decided by him. The workshops are also organized by the
institutions such as NCERT, DGHS sponsored workshop on nursing development.

2. Convener or chairman in first stage:


At first stage of the workshop theoretical aspects are discussed by the experts
on the theme of the workshop. Therefore a convener (the member of a group whose duty
it is to bring together) is nominated or invited who is well acquainted with theme of the
workshop to observe the work of the participants along with the expert and has to
carryout the formalities and keynote of the workshop.

3. Experts or Resource Person:


In organizing a workshop resource person plays following important roles:
a. They should provide theoretical and practical aspects of the theme.
b. Resource person must have much more practical and theoretical exposure in
their work field.
c. Resource person should able to provide guidance to participants at every stage
of and train them to perform the task effectively.
d. Resource person should be able to supervise and also control the trainees.

4. Role of Participant or Trainees:


The participant should be interested or keen in theme of the workshop. At the
first stage they have acquire understanding of the theme and at second stage have to
practice and perform the task with great interest and seek proper guidance from the
experts. They should carry the concept to their classroom to evaluate its workability in

356
actual situation. They may suggest some modification in using the concept in
classroom. The effectiveness of any workshop technique depends upon the
involvement of the participants in the task.

STAGES IN CONDUCTING WORKSHOP:


Generally workshops are organized for 3 to 10 days duration. The period of workshop
may be 40 days. It depends on the nature of task assigned to the workshop. It is organized in
four stages:
i. First Stageii. Second stageiii. Third stageiv. Fourth stage

i. First stage programmes:


1.Registration: Participants will pay their fees and they will register their names in
registration counter. After that they will be given a identity card and workshop content
handwork.
2. Inauguration: it is starting function of the workshop. In this all committee members,
participants, resource persons will be gathered along with the chief guest. Chief guest
will start the function with lighting the lamp and gives his guest speech regarding the
theme. After to him organizer delivers his speech.
3. Preliminary introductory session:Organizer will give brief introduction about the
workshop, which they are going to conduct. He will give orientation towards theme of
the workshop and objectives.
4. Pretest: pretest will be given to the participants, which will be based in the theme of the
workshop ie background knowledge about theme of the workshop. And it will be
evaluated.
5.Break: Tea break and Lunch break in between the sessions.
6.Presentation of the theme of providing awareness: the resource person or experts are
invited to provide the awareness and understanding of the topic. This stage is like a
seminar.
The paper reading is also done to discuss the different aspects of the theme.
The trainees or participants are given opportunity to seek clarification. The experts
provide the suitable illustration steps for using it in practice such as classroom teaching
in education.
ii. Second stage:
1. Formation of the Groups: in the second stage the total group is divided in to small
groups.
2. Assignment sessions and practical exercise: Groups will be given assignment related
to the theme. Practical exercise also will be given.
3. Guidance and Supervision: A resource person is assigned to provide guidance to the
work to perform. Along with guidance the expert also supervises each participants
work. Every participant has to work individually and independently and has to complete
the task within given time limit.
4. Clarifying session: The participant while doing his work if finds any difficulty or doubt
can be clarified with the help of expert.
5. Group discussion: If group members have completed their assignment at the end they
meet together and discuss their task within their group.

357
6. Preview of the next day: At the end of the each day all group members will join
together and discuss the programmes of the next day.
iii. Third stage:
There are four phases:
1. Presentation: at this phase all group meet at one place and present their report of work
done at second stage.
2. Evaluation: - Post test: It will be given to the participants based on the content which
was given by the experts during the presentation phase. That will be evaluated.
a. Open suggestions: the participants are given opportunity to comment and give
suggestions for further improvement.
b. Expert Suggestion: the experts also provide suggestion on different aspects of
the reports.
3. Validation: it is the end phase of the workshop. In this organizer will conclude the
workshop after providing certificates to the experts and participants and also
distribute the prizes to those perform well in their group activities. Chief organizer or
assistant organizer will give vote of thanks and programme will end with National
anthem.

iv. Fourth stage:


In fourth stage means after the actual programme, organizers as well as participants
have to do their part of work.
Organizers Part:
1. Letter of thanks: Within 15 days after the programmeit is time to thank everybody
who has helped, the organizers including those who have provided funds for the
workshop, the members of the committee for sponsors and the assistant organizers.
Inform theme in the letter that they will shortly be sent the report on the workshop.
2. Report on the workshop: report regarding the workshop must be printed and sent to
the assistant organizers and other persons who helped to successful conduct of the
workshop. The report will contain the following:
a. An introduction giving a brief description of the focal context which led to the
organization of the workshop.
b. The general aims of the workshop
c. Description of the progress of the workshop
d. Selected samples of the work donein group
e. List of documents used during the workshop
f. The evaluation
g. List of participants
Part of Participants: They should get ready for the follow-up programme that will be
conducted as a long term evaluation process at least one year after the day.
Follow up:
a.The trainer has to go back to their institution. They asked to continue their task and
examine the workability and usability in their institution.
b. The participants are invited to meet again and present their experience regarding
applicability of the topic or new practice.

358
c. During follow up meeting participants will also be assessed to which level they
reached their objectives by using questionnaire and individual interview.

ADVANTAGES OF WORKSHOP:
1. Workshop is used to realize the higher cognitive and psychomotor objectives.
2. It is a technique which can be effectively used for developing understanding and
proficiency for the approaches and practices in education.
3. It is used for developing and improving professional efficiency. Eg, Nursing, Medical,
Dental etc
4. Teaching proficiencies can be developed by the workshop technique for nursing in-
service teachers.
5. It provides the opportunity and situations to develop the individual capacities of a
teacher.
6. It develops the feeling of co-operation and group work.
7. It provides the situation to study the vocational problems.
8. The new practices and innovation are introduced to in-service teachers.

LIMITATIONS OF WORKSHOP:

1. The in-service teacher may not take interest to understand and use the new practices
in their classroom.
2. The workshop cannot be organized to large number of groups, so the large number of
persons can be trained.
3. The teacher may not take interest in practical work or to do something in productive
form.
4. The effectiveness of the workshop technique depends on the follow-up programme.
Generally follow-up programmes are not organized in workshop technique.

CONCLUSION:

In the workshop the total members may be divided in to small groups and each group
will choose a chairman and a recorder. Learning takes place in a friendly, happy, and
democratic atmosphere, under expert guidance. The workshop provides each participant the
opportunity to improve his effectiveness as a professional worker.

BIBLIOGRAPHY:

1. Basavantappa B T; Nursing Education; 1st edition; Jaypee Brothers Medical


Publications (P) Ltd, New Delhi.
2. Barabara A M & Ruth A W-Price, “Nursing education: Foundation for Practice
Excellence”; Jaypee Brothers Medical Publications (P) Ltd, New Delhi.
3. Aggraval.J.C. “Principles Methods and Techniques of Teaching”, Vikas Publishig
house Pvt Ltd, 1996, New Delhi.

359
KRISHNA INSTITUTE OF NURSING SCIENCE &
RESEARCH

Critical evaluation
Of an Institutional
Nursing education
programme
SUBJECT : NURSING EDUCATION

SUBMITTED TO SUBMITTED BY
Mr. Shyam Nagar Ms. Priyanka singh
Assistant Professor of M.Sc. Nsg Ist year
Mental health nursing Community
KINSR Kanpur KINSR Kanpur

SUBMITTED ON:

360
NURSING PROGRAMMES
INTRODUCTION

Diversity is the major characteristic of nursing education today.

Influenced by a variety of factors-social change efforts to achieve full

professional status, woman issues, historical factors, public expectations,

expectations of nurses themselves, legislation, national studies and constant

change in the health care systems-many different types of nursing education

programs exit.

Meaning and definition:

Nursing educational programmes may be defined as in large part that

influencing of one group of human beings, the pupils to grow towards defined

objectives; utilizing a second group of human beings, the teacher as agents and

operating in a setting of third group of human being, the public variously

concerned both with objectives and with means used to achieve them.

Nursing Educational Programmes

At present the various nursing educational programmes are there. We can

classify these programmes in to following courses:

1. Certificate courses ANM course / HW(F) course /

HA(F)

course / LHV

361
2. Diploma GNM Course

3. Degree (UG) 1. B.Sc Nursing

2. B.Sc Nursing (Post Certificates)

3. PB B.Sc Nursing (IGNOU)

4. Post Basic Diploma courses

5. Masters Education (PG) 1. MN (Master of Nursing)

2. M.Sc. Nursing

3.M.Phil Nursing

6.Doctoral ProgrammesPhD in Nursing

Certificate Courses:

Multipurpose Health Worker Training

The training grew out of the earlier auxiliary nursing and midwifery

(ANM) Course. The ANM training was for two years and mainly covered a

maternal and child care and family welfare. In keeping with the policies of the

government of India to have multipurpose health workers, the Indian nursing

Council revised the ANM's syllabus in 1977 and reduced the duration to 18

months. The focus of training is on community health nursing. At the end of the

course the candidates are eligible to work in health sub centers. There are about

500 schools in India offering this course in India at present. The MPHA (M)

training course is also conducted in some states of India with 18 months

duration.

362
363
Female health Supervisor training

This course was initially meant as a health visitor training course. It went

through several modifications in course of time and finally metamorphosed into

the present 6 months promotional training. The female health supervisor or

MPHA(F) course is currently conducted in 21 centers in India. Besides this

basic course, several states have their own promotional courses as requirement

for ANMs to be qualified for promotion to supervisors.

General Nursing and Midwifery

The general nursing and midwifery course is conducted in more than

1000 centers in the country. The syllabus has undergone many revisions

according to the changes in health plans and policies of the government and

changing trends and advancements in education, nursing, health sciences and

medical technology. The latest revision of the course from 3.6 years to 3 years.

The basic entrance qualification has become intermediate or class XII instead of

the earlier 10th class. Both science and arts students are eligible. The focus of

general nursing education is care of the sick in the hospital. On passing the

candidates are registered as nurses (RN) and as midwives (RM) by the

respective state nursing councils.

364
Degree (Under Graduate)

There are 2 types of graduate nursing education in India - one of 4 year

basic course for fresh entrance and the second is condensed post basic course

for those who have undergone the GNM course.

Four year B.Sc.(N)

Graduate nursing education started in India in the year of 1946 in CMC,

vellore and in the RAK college of nursing Delhi university. At present several

universities in India offer the course. The entry qualification is intermediate

with biological sciences, physics and chemistry. The course focuses on

preparation of professional nurses for working at the bedside and for taking

leadership roles in public health nursing. The course also includes managerial

and teaching subjects to prepare graduates to take up first level teaching and

administrative jobs in the hospital. Overall, the graduate nursing course in the

country offers a broad base in both arts and sciences and lays the foundation for

a holistic perspective to health and caring.

Post Basic B.Sc(N)

A two year degree course in nursing is offered in several universities in

India. This course was specially designed to provide higher educational

opportunities for practicing nurses. The entry requirement is that they should

365
have completed the general nursing course and XII (Usually with science). Most

places also ask for 1 year after completing the diploma (GNM) course.

366
B.Sc Nursing (IGNOU)

Distance education in the post basic nursing has also been started by

Indira Gandhi National Open University (IGNOU) in 1994. This has provided

an operating for diploma nurses all over the country to undertake higher

education. The IGNOU offers courses through it's study centers throughout the

country.

Postgraduate Nursing Education

M.Sc (N) course is presently being offered in several universities in the

country. The 2 year course is designed to prepare clinical and community health

nursing specialists. Besides clinical specialization the students are thought to

conduct research in nursing. A thesis is submitted by each student in partial

fulfillment of the requirements for the degree. Courses in education and

administration are given to prepare the students to take up responsibility in

education and administration in nursing and allied health areas. The entance

requirement is B.Sc (N) and 1 year experience as a clinical nurse or instructor.

Conclusion

Nursing education had evolved in time imparting diverse knowledge and

handy skill sets. Institutes offering basic to advanced courses in nursing had

matured in our land. Diversity is the major characteristic of nursing education

today. Influenced by variety of factors-social change efforts to achieve full

professional status, Woman issues, historical factors, public expectations,

expectations of nurses themselves, legislation, national studies and constant

367
changes in the health care systems many different types of nursing education

programs exist.

368
BIBLIOGRAPHY

1. Dr. BasavanthappaBT, Nursing education, 1st edition, jaypee publication,

page no . 389 - 391.

1) Neeraja K.P, Text book of nursing education, Jaypee publication, page

no: 263 - 266 .

2) CR Kothari. Research Methodology: Methods and Techniques. 2nd

edition.

3) P.S.Ssunder Rao, J.Richard, Introduction to Biostatics and Research

Methodology, 4lh edition.

4) B.K Mahajan, Methods in Biostatics : For Medical Student and Research

workers, 6th edition.

369

You might also like